Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
Apple® iOS
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Android™
Please note that the Mercedes-Benz Guides
App may not yet be available in your country.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all of
the documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
You can also use the C‑Class Guide smartphone App:
2055844501Z102 É2055844501Z102ÁËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 31
Introduction ......................................... 24
Safety ................................................... 41
Opening and closing ........................... 89
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .. 117
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 133
Climate control ................................. 149
Driving and parking .......................... 179
On-board computer and displays .... 291
Stowing and features ....................... 367
Maintenance and care ...................... 389
Breakdown assistance ..................... 405
Wheels and tyres .............................. 427
Technical data ................................... 465
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) ..................................................
4MATIC off-road system ...................
12 V socket
see Sockets
230 V power socket ..........................
360° camera
Cleaning .........................................
Function/notes .............................
235
235
382
401
249
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 315
Function/notes ................................ 74
Important safety notes .................... 75
Warning lamp ................................. 355
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 63
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 165
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 157
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 309
Display message ............................ 339
Function/notes ............................. 263
Towing a trailer .............................. 266
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 309
Display message ............................ 338
Function/notes ............................. 266
Towing a trailer .............................. 269
Active light function ......................... 138
Active Light System
Display message ............................ 331
Active Parking Assist
Detecting parking spaces .............. 240
Display message ............................ 339
Exiting a parking space .................. 243
Function/notes ............................. 239
Important safety notes .................. 239
Parking .......................................... 241
Towing a trailer .............................. 239
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 82
Adaptive Brake Assist
Function/notes ................................ 79
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 80
Adaptive Damping System (ADS) ..... 235
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS
Display messages .......................... 332
Function/notes ............................. 139
Switching on/off ........................... 140
AdBlue®
Additive ......................................... 473
Display message ............................ 336
Displaying level and range ............. 307
Filling capacity ............................... 473
Important safety notes .................. 472
Low outside temperatures ............. 473
Purity ............................................. 473
Topping up ..................................... 204
Additional speedometer ................... 312
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 474
Adjusting the headlamp range ......... 136
AGILITY SELECT switch
Automatic transmission ................. 197
Climate control (THERMATIC) ........ 153
Climate control
(THERMOTRONIC) .......................... 156
Hybrid operation ............................ 277
Manual transmission ...................... 191
Air filter (white display message) .... 336
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Important safety notes .................. 177
Rear ............................................... 178
Setting ........................................... 177
Setting the centre air vents ........... 178
Setting the side air vents ............... 178
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Introduction ..................................... 51
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps ............................................... 46
Index
Airbags
Display message ............................ 328
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 52
Important safety guidelines ............. 51
Kneebag ........................................... 53
Sidebag ............................................ 53
Triggering ......................................... 60
Windowbag ...................................... 53
AIRMATIC
Display message ............................ 337
Function/notes ............................. 234
AIRPANEL (cleaning instructions) .... 400
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 85
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 85
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 85
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Anti-glare film .................................... 387
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 214
Armrest
Stowage compartment .................. 370
Ashtray ............................................... 379
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 306
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 307
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 395
Hiding a service message .............. 395
Notes ............................................. 395
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 395
Service message ............................ 395
Special service requirements ......... 396
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 85
Function ........................................... 85
Switching off the alarm .................... 85
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 309
Display message ............................ 337
Function/notes ............................. 255
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 332
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 187
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 186
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 328
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 54
Problems ......................................... 59
System self-test ............................... 57
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 135
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position ............. 196
AGILITY SELECT switch .................. 197
Changing gear ............................... 196
DIRECT SELECT lever ..................... 193
Display message ............................ 345
Drive program display .................... 195
Drive programs .............................. 197
Driving tips .................................... 196
Emergency running mode .............. 200
Engaging drive position .................. 195
Engaging neutral ............................ 194
Engaging park position automatically ............................................... 194
Engaging reverse gear ................... 194
Engaging the park position ............ 193
Kickdown ....................................... 196
Manual shifting .............................. 198
Overview ........................................ 193
Problem (fault) ............................... 200
Pulling away ................................... 184
Starting the engine ........................ 183
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ... 198
Trailer towing ................................. 196
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ................... 195
Transmission positions .................. 195
5
6
Index
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Auxiliary heating/ventilation
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Setting the departure time .............
Switching on/off (on the centre
console) .........................................
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ......................................................
200
172
177
173
175
173
480
B
Bag hook ............................................ 374
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 286
Folding out ..................................... 285
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 75
BAS PLUS with Cross-Traffic Assist
(Brake Assist PLUS with CrossTraffic Assist)
Function/notes ................................ 75
Important safety notes .................... 76
Battery (high-voltage)
see High-voltage battery
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 94
Important safety notes .................... 93
Replacing ......................................... 94
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 416
Display message ............................ 334
Important safety notes .................. 412
Jump starting ................................. 418
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 60
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 309
Display message ............................ 339
Notes/function .............................. 259
Trailer towing ................................. 261
see Active Blind Spot Assist
BlueTEC (AdBlue®) ............................. 472
BlueTEC®
Topping up AdBlue® ....................... 204
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 390
Closing ........................................... 392
Display message ............................ 347
Important safety notes .................. 390
Opening ......................................... 391
Boot
Emergency release ........................ 105
Important safety notes .................. 101
Locking separately ......................... 105
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ................................... 104
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................. 102
Opening/closing (from the outside, HANDS-FREE ACCESS) .......... 103
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ......................................... 102
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 347
Obstacle recognition ...................... 101
Opening dimensions ...................... 476
Opening/closing ............................ 101
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 476
Box (boot) ........................................... 374
Brake
EBD .................................................. 82
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 322
Notes ............................................. 475
Brake force distribution, electronic
see EBD (electronic brake force
distribution)
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 80
Display message ............................ 330
Brake pedal
Pedal resistance/pedal travel .......... 44
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 74
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 79
Index
BAS .................................................. 75
BAS PLUS with Cross-Traffic
Assist ............................................... 75
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 475
Display message ............................ 315
Driving tips .................................... 213
Hill start assist ............................... 185
HOLD function ............................... 232
Important safety notes .................. 213
Parking brake ................................ 209
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) ................................................. 44
RBS warning lamp .......................... 362
Warning lamp ................................. 353
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away
Brightness control (instrument
cluster lighting) ................................... 32
Bulbs
see Replacing bulbs
Buttons on the steering column ...... 294
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Camera
see 360° camera
Car
see Vehicle
Car key
see Key
Car wash (care) .................................
Care
360° camera .................................
AIRPANEL ......................................
Automatic car wash .......................
Carpets ..........................................
Display ...........................................
Exhaust pipe ..................................
Exterior lighting .............................
Gear or selector lever ....................
High-pressure cleaner ....................
Interior ...........................................
Matt paintwork ..............................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
396
401
400
396
404
402
402
400
403
398
402
399
396
398
Plastic trim .................................... 403
Reversing camera .......................... 401
Roof lining ...................................... 404
Seat belt ........................................ 404
Seat cover ..................................... 403
Sensors ......................................... 401
Steering wheel ............................... 403
Trim pieces .................................... 403
Washing by hand ........................... 398
Wheels ........................................... 399
Windows ........................................ 399
Wiper blades .................................. 400
Wooden trim .................................. 403
CD player/CD changer(on-board
computer) .......................................... 303
Central locking
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 91
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 38
Upper section .................................. 37
Changing bulbs
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 143
Main-beam headlamps ................... 143
Reversing lamps ............................ 144
Turn signals (front) ......................... 144
Turn signals (rear) .......................... 144
Charge status of high-voltage battery ..................................................... 273
Child seat
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 68
ISOFIX .............................................. 65
On the front-passenger seat ............ 66
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 67
Recommendations ........................... 71
Suitable positions ............................ 68
Top Tether ....................................... 65
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 72
Rear doors ....................................... 73
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 63
Restraint systems ............................ 64
Cigarette lighter ................................ 380
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 400
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 402
Climate control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 172
7
8
Index
Controlling automatically ...............
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) .................
Cooling with air dehumidification ..
Demisting the windows ..................
Demisting the windscreen .............
ECO start/stop function ................
ECO start/stop function
(THERMATIC) .................................
Hybrid vehicle (THERMOTRONIC) ..
Hybrid vehicles (THERMATIC) ........
Important safety notes ..................
Indicator lamp ................................
Information about using
THERMATIC automatic climate
control ...........................................
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control ..................................
Ionisation .......................................
Overview of systems ......................
Perfume atomizer ..........................
Pre-entry climate control ...............
Problem with the rear window
heating ..........................................
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................
Rear control panel .........................
Remote activation of heating/
ventilation systems ........................
Setting the air distribution .............
Setting the air vents ......................
Setting the airflow .........................
Setting the climate mode ...............
Setting the temperature ................
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................
Switching on/off ...........................
Switching residual heat on/off ......
Switching the rear window heating on/off ......................................
Switching the synchronisation
function on and off ........................
THERMATIC automatic climate
control (2-zone) .............................
THERMOTRONIC (3-zone) automatic climate control .....................
159
165
157
163
163
155
152
155
152
150
159
152
155
169
150
167
169
165
159
154
171
161
177
162
160
160
165
156
166
164
162
151
154
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 32
Collapsible emergency spare
wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS
Activating/deactivating ................. 308
Display message ............................ 322
Operation/notes .............................. 77
COMAND display
Cleaning ......................................... 402
Combination switch .......................... 137
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 299
Convenience box ............................... 374
Convenience closing feature ............ 107
Convenience opening feature .......... 107
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 165
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 393
Display message ............................ 333
Important safety notes .................. 475
Temperature display in the instrument cluster .................................. 293
Temperature display in the onboard computer ............................. 307
Warning lamp ................................. 360
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright ............................................. 29
Cornering light function
Display message ............................ 329
Function/notes ............................. 138
Crash-responsive emergency lighting ....................................................... 141
Crosswind Assist ................................. 82
Cruise control
Cruise control lever ....................... 216
Deactivating ................................... 218
Display message ............................ 342
Driving system ............................... 216
Important safety notes .................. 216
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 216
Selecting ........................................ 217
Setting a speed .............................. 218
Index
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear compartment .........................
217
377
376
378
D
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 331
Function/notes ............................. 135
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declarations of conformity ................. 27
Diagnostics connection ...................... 27
Diesel .................................................. 471
Digital speedometer ......................... 299
Dipped-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 143
Display message ............................ 329
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 134
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 311
Switching on/off ........................... 135
DIRECT SELECT lever
Automatic transmission ................. 193
Display
Charge status of the high-voltage
battery ........................................... 273
see Display message
see Warning and indicator lamps
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 337
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 395
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 314
Engine ............................................ 333
General information ....................... 314
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 314
Hybrid system ................................ 337
Introduction ................................... 314
Key ................................................ 350
Lights ............................................. 329
Safety systems .............................. 315
Tyres .............................................. 343
Vehicle ........................................... 345
Distance warning function
Function/notes ................................ 77
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 363
DISTRONIC PLUS
Activating ....................................... 224
Activation conditions ..................... 224
Cruise control lever ....................... 223
Deactivating ................................... 228
Display message ............................ 340
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 228
Driving tips .................................... 229
Function/notes ............................. 222
Important safety notes .................. 222
Selecting ........................................ 223
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 227
Door
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 98
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 91
Control panel ................................... 40
Display message ............................ 347
Emergency locking ........................ 100
Emergency unlocking ....................... 98
Important safety notes .................... 96
Opening (from the inside) ................ 97
Drive program
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 195
Manual transmission ...................... 192
Drive programs
Automatic transmission ................. 197
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 396
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 134
Driving Assistance package ............. 263
Driving on flooded roads .................. 215
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS with Cross-Traffic
Assist ............................................... 75
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS ................................................ 77
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 82
9
10
Index
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 74
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 82
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 79
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 80
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 75
Distance warning function ............... 77
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 80
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 80
Important safety guidelines ............. 74
Overview .......................................... 74
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................. 82
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) ................................................. 44
STEER CONTROL ............................. 85
Driving system
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering
Assist and Stop&Go Pilot ............... 230
Driving systems
360°camera .................................. 249
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 263
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 266
Active Parking Assist ..................... 239
AIRMATIC ...................................... 234
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 255
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 259
Cruise control ................................ 216
Display message ............................ 337
Distronic Plus ................................ 222
Driving Assistance package ........... 263
HOLD function ............................... 232
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 261
Lane package ................................ 259
PARKTRONIC ................................. 236
Reversing camera .......................... 244
SPEEDTRONIC ............................... 219
Traffic Sign Assist .......................... 256
Driving tips
Aquaplaning ................................... 214
Automatic transmission ................. 196
Brakes ........................................... 213
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 229
Downhill gradient ........................... 213
Driving abroad ............................... 134
Driving in winter ............................. 215
Driving on flooded roads ................ 215
Driving on wet roads ......................
Fuel ................................................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake disks ............................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
The first 1500 km ..........................
Towing a trailer ..............................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
214
211
211
215
214
214
214
180
431
134
180
284
214
303
E
EASY-ENTRY feature
Function/notes ............................. 126
EASY-EXIT feature
Function/notes ............................. 126
EASY-PACK convenience box ........... 374
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 318
Function/notes ................................ 82
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 211
On-board computer ....................... 298
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 187
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 186
Climate control (THERMATIC) ........ 153
Climate control
(THERMOTRONIC) .......................... 156
Deactivating/activating ................. 187
General information ....................... 186
Important safety notes .................. 186
Introduction ................................... 186
Electric motor
Power display ................................ 272
see Hybrid operation
Electric motor power display ........... 272
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 27
Index
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 63
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 98
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 93
Inserting .......................................... 93
Locking vehicle .............................. 100
Removing ......................................... 93
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 98
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 461
Important safety notes .................. 461
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 462
Technical data ............................... 464
Emergency unlocking
Vehicle ............................................. 98
Energy flow display ........................... 273
Engine
Display message ............................ 333
ECO start/stop function ................ 186
Engine number ............................... 468
Jump-starting ................................. 418
Running irregularly ......................... 189
Starting problems .......................... 189
Starting the engine with the key .... 183
Starting with the Start/Stop button ................................................. 184
Stopping ........................................ 208
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 424
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 360
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 466
Problem (fault) ............................... 189
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 474
Checking the oil level ..................... 392
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 392
Display message ............................ 335
Filling capacity ............................... 474
Notes about oil grades ................... 473
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 392
Topping up ..................................... 392
Viscosity ........................................ 474
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 24
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Activating/deactivating ................... 81
Characteristics ................................. 81
Deactivating/activating ................. 307
Display message ............................ 315
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 80
Function/notes ................................ 80
General notes .................................. 80
Important safety guidelines ............. 80
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 82
Warning lamp ................................. 357
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 80
Exhaust
see Exhaust pipe
Exhaust pipe
Cleaning ......................................... 402
Exhaustive discharging (high-voltage battery) ....................................... 415
Extended overrun mode ................... 280
Exterior lighting
Cleaning ......................................... 400
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 128
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 129
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 128
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 128
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 129
Parking position ............................. 129
Resetting ....................................... 128
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 131
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Features ............................................. 376
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 407
11
12
Index
First-aid kit ......................................... 406
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ............................... 442
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 443
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 438
Raising the vehicle ......................... 439
Removing a wheel .......................... 442
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 439
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the
spare wheel ................................... 437
MOExtended tyres ......................... 408
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 408
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 409
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat ............................................. 387
Foglamps (extended range) .............. 139
Fording
On flooded roads ........................... 215
Frequencies
Mobile phone ................................. 466
Two-way radio ................................ 466
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 328
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 54
Problems ......................................... 59
System self-test ............................... 57
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 471
Consumption information .............. 472
Consumption statistics .................. 299
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 298
Displaying the range ...................... 298
Driving tips .................................... 211
E10 ................................................ 470
Fuel gauge ....................................... 34
Grade (petrol) ................................ 470
Important safety notes .................. 469
Low outside temperatures ............. 472
Problem (malfunction) ................... 203
Quality (diesel) ............................... 471
Refuelling ....................................... 200
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 470
Fuel consumption (Audio 20) ........... 276
Fuel consumption (COMAND
Online) ................................................ 276
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 202
Fuel filter (white display message) .. 336
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 298
Gauge .............................................. 34
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 470
Problem (malfunction) ................... 203
Fuses
Allocation chart ............................. 426
Before changing ............................. 425
Dashboard fuse box ....................... 425
Fuse box in the boot ...................... 426
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 426
Fuse box in the front-passenger
footwell .......................................... 425
Important safety notes .................. 424
G
Generated electrical energy (Audio
20) ......................................................
Generated electrical energy
(COMAND Online) ..............................
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ...........
Glove compartment ..........................
276
276
24
369
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
HANDS-FREE ACCESS .......................
Hazard warning lamps ......................
Head restraints
Adjusting .......................................
Adjusting (electrically) ...................
Adjusting (manually) ......................
Adjusting (rear) ..............................
Fitting/removing (rear) ..................
Head-up display
Adjusting the brightness ................
Function/notes .............................
103
137
121
122
122
122
122
310
295
Index
Important safety notes .................. 295
Setting the position ....................... 310
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 131
Switching on or off ......................... 296
Switching the display on/off ......... 310
Headlamp
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 476
Headlamp flasher .............................. 137
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 140
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 398
High-voltage battery
Charge level ................................... 273
Charging ........................................ 416
Charging (on-board computer) ....... 274
General notes .................................. 43
Vehicle fire ....................................... 43
Hill start assist .................................. 185
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 233
Deactivating ................................... 233
Display message ............................ 340
Function/notes ............................. 232
Horn ...................................................... 32
Hybrid drive
Displaying the total range .............. 276
Generated electrical energy ........... 276
Hybrid operation
AGILITY SELECT switch .................. 277
Automatic engine start (ECO
Start/Stop function) ...................... 280
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) ....................... 280
Driving tips .................................... 278
ECO start/stop function ................ 279
Energy flow display ........................ 273
Extended overrun mode ................. 280
Fuel consumption .......................... 276
General notes ................................ 269
Important safety notes .................. 269
Manual gearshifting ....................... 278
Noiseless start ............................... 277
Operating (on-board computer) ..... 273
Overrun mode ................................ 280
Overview (instrument cluster) ........ 272
Power display (electric motor) ....... 272
Problems ....................................... 282
Pulling away ................................... 277
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) ............................................... 269
Resetting values (Audio 20) ........... 276
Resetting values (COMAND
Online) ........................................... 276
Starting the engine ........................ 276
Hybrid system
Automatic deactivation .................... 42
Danger of electric shock .................. 42
Display message ............................ 337
High-voltage battery ........................ 43
Important safety notes .................... 42
Manual deactivation ......................... 43
Opening the bonnet ......................... 44
Overview ........................................ 271
Problems (malfunctions) ................ 282
READY indicator ............................. 276
Warning lamp ................................. 362
Hybrid vehicle
Climate control (THERMATIC) ........ 153
Climate control
(THERMOTRONIC) .......................... 156
Hybrid vehicles
Important safety notes .................... 42
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 85
Indicator and warning lamp
Restraint system ............................ 359
Indicator and warning lamps
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS .............................................. 363
Coolant .......................................... 360
Engine diagnostics ......................... 360
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 330
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Insect protection on the radiator .... 392
13
14
Index
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 34
Power display ................................ 272
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 35
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 292
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 311
Display message ............................ 331
Overview ........................................ 138
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 311
Interior lighting
Control ........................................... 141
Emergency lighting ........................ 141
Overview ........................................ 140
Reading lamp ................................. 140
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 87
Function ........................................... 86
Priming ............................................ 86
Switching off .................................... 87
Internal combustion engine
Malfunction .................................... 282
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 65
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 407
Using ............................................. 439
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 418
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 94
Checking the battery ....................... 94
Convenience closing feature .......... 108
Convenience opening feature ........ 107
Display message ............................ 350
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 91
Emergency key element ................... 93
Important safety notes .................... 90
KEYLESS-GO start function .............. 92
Loss ................................................. 95
Modifying the programming ............. 92
Overview .......................................... 90
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 181
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 95
Starting the engine ........................ 183
Key positions
Key ................................................ 181
Start/Stop button .......................... 181
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ...................... 108
Deactivation ..................................... 91
Locking ............................................ 91
Removing the Start/Stop button ... 182
Unlocking ......................................... 91
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 196
Kneebag ............................................... 53
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................
Display message ............................
Function/information ....................
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
Lane package .....................................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Active light function .......................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS ....
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Headlamp range ............................
Intelligent Light System (function) ...............................................
Light switch ...................................
309
338
261
259
373
331
332
311
138
139
135
138
135
134
139
137
137
136
138
134
Index
Main-beam headlamps ................... 137
Misted up headlamps .................... 140
Motorway mode ............................. 138
Parking lamps ................................ 136
Rear foglamp ................................. 135
Setting exterior lighting ................. 134
Side lamps ..................................... 136
Turn signals ................................... 137
see Interior lighting
see Replacing bulbs
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 216
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 223
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 219
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 368
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 98
Emergency locking ........................ 100
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 97
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 123
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS ....
Changing bulbs ..............................
Display message ............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Manual transmission
AGILITY SELECT switch ..................
Drive program ................................
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Gear lever ......................................
Pulling away ...................................
Shift recommendation ...................
Shifting to neutral ..........................
Starting the engine ........................
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) ..
430
139
143
331
137
191
192
191
190
184
191
191
183
399
Memory card (audio) ......................... 303
Memory function
Seats, steering wheel, exterior
mirrors ........................................... 130
Mercedes-Benz Contact
Info call button .............................. 385
Roadside Assistance call button .... 385
Mercedes-Benz emergency call
system
Switch in the overhead control
panel .............................................. 384
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive
360°camera .................................. 249
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 263
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 266
Active Parking Assist ..................... 239
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 255
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 259
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 222
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering
Assist and Stop&Go Pilot ............... 230
General notes ................................ 216
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 261
PARKTRONIC ................................. 236
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 62
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection PLUS) .............. 62
Reversing camera .......................... 244
Traffic Sign Assist .......................... 256
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 314
Messages
see Display messages
see Warning and indicator lamps
Mirror turn signal
Cleaning ......................................... 400
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone
Frequencies ................................... 466
Installation ..................................... 466
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 304
15
16
Index
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 386
Transmission output (maximum) .... 466
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 92
MOExtended tyres ............................. 408
Motorway mode ................................ 138
MP3
Operating ....................................... 303
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 295
Permanent display ......................... 312
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 294
Overview .......................................... 36
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 300
Notes on running in a new vehicle .. 180
O
Occupant safety
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 63
Children in the vehicle ..................... 63
Important safety notes .................... 45
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 74
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 62
Seat belts ........................................ 47
Odometer ........................................... 298
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
Assistance graphic menu ............... 306
Assistance menu ........................... 307
Display messages .......................... 314
Displaying a service message ........ 395
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 228
Factory settings ............................. 313
Head-up display ............................. 295
Important safety notes .................. 292
Instrument cluster menu ............... 312
Light menu ..................................... 311
Media menu ................................... 302
Menu overview .............................. 297
Message memory .......................... 314
Navigation menu ............................ 300
Operating the TV ............................ 304
Operating video DVD ..................... 303
Operation ....................................... 294
Radio menu ................................... 302
Service menu ................................. 306
Settings menu ............................... 307
Standard display ............................ 298
Telephone menu ............................ 304
Trip menu ...................................... 298
Vehicle menu ................................. 313
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 144
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 25
Operating mode
Overrun mode ................................ 279
Stationary vehicle .......................... 278
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 27
Important safety note ...................... 25
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 293
Overhead control panel ...................... 39
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 73
Overrun mode .................................... 280
Overrun mode, extended .................. 280
Owner's Manual
Overview .......................................... 25
P
Paint code .......................................... 468
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 398
Panic alarm .......................................... 44
Panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety information ......... 110
Opening/closing ............................ 112
Problem (malfunction) ................... 115
Rain closing feature ....................... 113
Resetting ....................................... 114
Parking
Hybrid vehicles .............................. 281
Important safety notes .................. 207
Parking brake ................................ 209
Index
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 129
Reversing camera .......................... 244
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 239
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 318
Electric parking brake .................... 209
Warning lamp ................................. 359
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 331
Switching on/off ........................... 136
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 238
Driving system ............................... 236
Function/notes ............................. 236
Important safety notes .................. 236
Problem (fault) ............................... 239
Sensor range ................................. 236
Trailer towing ................................. 236
Warning display ............................. 237
PASSENGER AIR BAG
Indicator lamps ................................ 46
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamp
Problem (malfunction) ................... 328
Perfume atomizer
Operating ....................................... 167
Perfume vial ................................... 167
Problem (malfunction) ................... 169
Petrol .................................................. 470
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 74
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 403
Power windows
see Side windows
Pre-entry climate control
Problem (Malfunction) ................... 171
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 62
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 323
PRE-SAFE® Brake
Activating/deactivating ................. 309
Display message ............................ 323
Function/notes ................................ 82
Important safety notes .................... 83
Warning lamp ................................. 363
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection PLUS)
Operation ......................................... 62
Protection against theft
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 85
Immobiliser ...................................... 85
Interior motion sensor ..................... 86
Tow-away protection ........................ 86
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 24
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 184
Hill start assist ............................... 185
Hybrid operation ............................ 277
Manual transmission ...................... 184
Trailer ............................................ 185
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 27
R
Radiator cover ................................... 392
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 302
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 27
Rain closing feature
Panorama sliding sunroof .............. 113
Sliding sunroof ............................... 112
RBS (Recuperative Brake System)
Driving safety systems ..................... 44
Important safety notes .................... 44
Warning lamp ................................. 362
Reading lamp ..................................... 140
READY indicator ................................ 276
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 178
17
18
Index
Setting the airflow ......................... 162
Setting the temperature ................ 160
Rear foglamp
Display message ............................ 331
Switching on/off ........................... 135
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear seat
Display message ............................ 347
Rear seat (folding the backrest forwards/back) ...................................... 372
Rear window blind ............................ 379
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 165
Switching on/off ........................... 164
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 50
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 129
Dipping (manual) ........................... 127
Recuperation display ........................ 298
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 34
Important safety notes .................. 200
Refuelling process ......................... 201
see Fuel
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 173
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 175
Replacing bulbs
General notes ................................ 141
Important safety notes .................. 142
Overview of bulb types .................. 142
Removing/replacing the cover
(front wheel arch) .......................... 143
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 175
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 335
Warning lamp ................................. 360
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 166
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 325
Introduction ..................................... 44
Warning lamp ................................. 359
Warning lamp (function) ................... 45
Rev counter ........................................ 293
Reverse gear
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 191
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 401
Function/notes ............................. 244
Switching on/off ........................... 245
Reversing feature
Panorama sliding sunroof .............. 111
Roller sunblinds ............................. 113
Side windows ................................. 106
Sliding sunroof ............................... 111
Reversing function
Boot lid .......................................... 101
Reversing lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 144
Reversing lamp (display message) .. 331
Roller sunblind
Panorama sliding sunroof .............. 113
Rear window .................................. 379
Roller sunblinds (panorama sliding
sunroof)
Operating ....................................... 114
Roof carrier ........................................ 376
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 404
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 476
S
Safety
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system ..............
Child restraint systems ....................
Children in the vehicle .....................
see Operating safety
Safety notes
Hybrid vehicles ................................
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Seat belt
Centre rear-compartment seat ........
Correct usage ..................................
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt .........................
54
64
63
42
49
48
50
Index
Adjusting the height ......................... 49
Cleaning ......................................... 404
Display message ............................ 324
Fastening ......................................... 49
Important safety guidelines ............. 47
Introduction ..................................... 47
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 50
Releasing ......................................... 49
Warning lamp ................................. 351
Warning lamp (function) ................... 50
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 121
Adjusting (manually and electrically) .............................................. 120
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 123
Adjusting the head restraint .......... 121
Cleaning the cover ......................... 403
Correct driver's seat position ........ 118
Important safety notes .................. 119
Seat heating .................................. 123
Seat heating problem .................... 124
Seat ventilation .............................. 124
Seat ventilation problem ................ 125
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 131
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 123
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................. 124
Selector lever
Cleaning ......................................... 403
see Automatic transmission
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 401
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 306
Service products
AdBlue® special additives .............. 472
Brake fluid ..................................... 475
Coolant (engine) ............................ 475
Engine oil ....................................... 473
Fuel ................................................ 468
Important safety notes .................. 468
Washer fluid ................................... 476
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 313
On-board computer ....................... 307
Shifting to neutral (manual transmission) ............................................. 191
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 136
Side windows
Convenience closing ...................... 107
Convenience opening .................... 107
Important safety notes .................. 106
Opening/closing ............................ 106
Problem (malfunction) ................... 110
Resetting ....................................... 108
Sidebag ................................................ 53
Sliding sunroof
Opening/closing ............................ 111
Rain closing feature ....................... 112
Resetting ....................................... 112
see Panorama sliding sunroof
Snow chains ...................................... 431
Sockets
Centre console .............................. 381
General notes ................................ 381
Rear compartment ......................... 382
Specialist workshop ............................ 27
Spectacles compartment ................. 369
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 312
Digital ............................................ 299
In the Instrument cluster ................. 34
Segments ...................................... 293
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 312
see Instrument cluster
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 221
Display message ............................ 341
Function/notes ............................. 219
Important safety notes .................. 219
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 219
Permanent ..................................... 221
Selecting ........................................ 220
Storing the current speed .............. 220
19
20
Index
Variable ......................................... 219
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Warning lamp ................................. 282
Start/Stop button
Starting the engine ........................ 184
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 183
Stationary vehicle ............................. 278
STEER CONTROL .................................. 85
Steering
Warning lamps ............................... 365
Steering (display message) .............. 349
Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot
(DISTRONIC PLUS)
Display message ............................ 342
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL
see STEER CONTROL
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 126
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 125
Button overview ............................... 36
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 294
Cleaning ......................................... 403
EASY ENTRY/EXIT feature ............. 126
Gearshift paddles ........................... 198
Important safety notes .................. 125
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 131
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 198
Stowage areas ................................... 368
Stowage compartment
Map pockets .................................. 370
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 370
Centre console .............................. 369
Cup holder ..................................... 376
Door ............................................... 370
Glove compartment ....................... 369
Important safety information ......... 368
Rear ............................................... 370
Spectacles compartment ............... 369
Stowage net ....................................... 370
Stowage space
Stowage net ................................... 370
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor ....................................................
Summer tyres
In winter ........................................
Sun blind
Rear side windows .........................
Sun visor ............................................
Suspension tuning
AIRMATIC ......................................
Switching the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
On/off ...........................................
375
430
378
378
235
173
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 330
see Lights
Technical data
Capacities ...................................... 468
Emergency spare wheel ................. 464
Information .................................... 466
Trailer loads ................................... 478
Tyres/wheels ................................. 444
Vehicle data ................................... 476
Telephone
Accepting a call (multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 305
Display message ............................ 349
Introduction ................................... 304
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 304
Number from the phone book ........ 305
Redialling ....................................... 306
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 305
Telephone compartment ................ 370
Temperature
Coolant (display in the instrument
cluster) .......................................... 293
Coolant (display in the on-board
computer) ...................................... 307
Outside temperature ...................... 293
Setting (climate control) ................ 160
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 216
Through-loading feature ................... 371
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 409
Top Tether ............................................ 65
Total distance recorder .................... 298
Index
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 86
Deactivating ..................................... 86
Function ........................................... 86
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 424
Important safety notes .................. 420
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 420
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles ............ 423
With the rear axle raised ................ 422
Towing a trailer
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 266
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 269
Active Parking Assist ..................... 239
Axle load, permissible .................... 480
Bulb failure indicator for LED
lamps ............................................. 287
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 82
General notes ................................ 284
Pulling away with a trailer .............. 185
Trailer tow hitch display message .. 347
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 422
Removing the towing eye ............... 422
With both axles on the ground ....... 422
Towing eye ......................................... 407
Traffic Sign Assist
Activating ....................................... 257
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 308
Display message ............................ 340
Function/notes ............................. 256
Important safety notes .................. 257
Instrument cluster display ............. 257
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 287
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 261
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 402
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 286
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 286
Driving tips .................................... 284
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 286
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 285
Important safety notes .................. 283
Lights display message ..................
Mounting dimensions ....................
Parktronic ......................................
Power supply .................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Trailer loads ...................................
Transfer case .....................................
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
see Manual transmission
Transmission position display .........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ......................
Transporting the vehicle ..................
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signals
Changing bulbs (front) ...................
Changing bulbs (rear) ....................
Switching on/off ...........................
TV
Operating (on-board computer) .....
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
329
477
236
287
289
478
200
195
195
423
403
299
298
299
144
144
137
304
466
466
466
433
343
433
411
411
432
436
436
437
434
21
22
Index
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Summer tyres in winter .................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
Wheel and tyre combinations ........
see Flat tyre
433
433
434
436
435
364
435
437
429
438
343
428
430
438
429
438
430
444
429
445
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 98
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 97
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 378
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 28
Data acquisition ............................... 28
Display message ............................ 345
Electronics ..................................... 466
Equipment ....................................... 25
Implied warranty .............................. 28
Individual settings .......................... 307
Leaving parked up ......................... 211
Locking (in an emergency) ............. 100
Locking (key) ................................... 91
Lowering ........................................ 443
Operating safety .............................. 25
Pulling away ................................... 184
Raising ........................................... 439
Registration ..................................... 28
Securing from rolling away ............ 439
Towing away .................................. 420
Transporting .................................. 423
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 98
Unlocking (key) ................................ 91
Vehicle data ................................... 476
Vehicle data
Boot load (maximum) ..................... 476
Roof load (maximum) ..................... 476
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 476
Vehicle emergency locking .............. 100
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 468
Vehicle level
AIRMATIC ...................................... 234
Display message ............................ 337
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 407
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 303
VIN ...................................................... 468
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 355
Brakes ........................................... 353
Distance warning signal ................. 363
ESP® .............................................. 357
ESP® OFF ....................................... 358
Hybrid system ................................ 362
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 216
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 223
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 219
Overview .......................................... 35
Parking brake ................................ 359
PASSENGER AIR BAG ...................... 46
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) ............................................... 362
Reserve fuel ................................... 360
Seat belt ........................................ 351
SRS ................................................ 282
Steering ......................................... 365
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 364
Warning triangle ................................ 406
Index
Warnings
Stickers ........................................... 42
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 349
Wheel and tyre combinations
see Tyres
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 443
Wheel chock ...................................... 439
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 437
Changing/replacing ....................... 438
Checking ........................................ 429
Cleaning ......................................... 399
Emergency spare wheel ................. 461
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 442
Fitting a wheel ............................... 438
Important safety notes .................. 428
Removing a wheel .......................... 442
Storing ........................................... 438
Tightening torque ........................... 443
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 444
Windowbag
Display message ............................ 326
Operation ......................................... 53
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 399
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 163
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Notes ............................................. 476
Topping up ..................................... 394
Windscreen wipers
Problem (malfunction) ................... 148
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 145
Switching on/off ........................... 145
Winter operation
Important safety notes .................. 430
Radiator cover ............................... 392
Slippery road surfaces ................... 215
Snow chains .................................. 431
Summer tyres ................................ 430
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 313
M+S tyres ...................................... 430
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Replacing (windscreen) ..................
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
400
145
145
146
403
23
24
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ravoid
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
H Environmental note
Have defective high-voltage batteries disposed of in an environmentally responsible
manner. Consult a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for
this purpose.
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle
to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner in accordance with the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return
your vehicle to these plants free of charge.
This makes a valuable contribution to the
recycling process and the conservation of
resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy,
visit the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
Introduction
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Rdoor
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by Mercedes.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use
only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of
equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels and
accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
therefore accepts no responsibility for the
use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles,
even if they have been officially approved or
independently approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine MercedesBenz parts (Y page 468).
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs car-
Z
25
26
Introduction
ried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could affect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly anymore and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
Ra
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could
be damaged without the damage being visible. Components damaged in this way can
unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed for.
If the underbody panelling is damaged,
combustible materials such as leaves,
grass or twigs can gather between the
underbody and the underbody panelling. If
these materials come in contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system, they can catch
fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If, upon continuing your journey, you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hybrid vehicles have a combustion engine
and an electric motor. The voltage supply for
operating the vehicle electrically is provided
by the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system.
G DANGER
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage. If you modify components
in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
or touch damaged components, you may be
electrocuted. The components in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may be
damaged in an accident, although the damage
is not visible. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Do not touch any high-voltage components
after an accident and never modify the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system. Have the
vehicle towed away after an accident and the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
The components of the vehicle's high-voltage
electrical system are marked with yellow
Introduction
warning stickers. The cables of the vehicle's
high-voltage electrical system are orange.
Vehicles with an electric motor generate significantly less noise than vehicles with internal combustion engines. As a result, in certain
situations your vehicle may not be heard by
other road users. This can happen, for example, when you are parking and your vehicle is
not seen by other road users. This requires
you to adopt a particularly anticipatory driving
style, as it is necessary to allow for the possibility that other road users may behave
unpredictably.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information
systems and communication devices integrated into the vehicle which receive and/or
transmit radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and all other relevant conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Regulation ECE-R 10.
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it can affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. This may
affect the operating safety of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
Rservice and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Rmodifications, installations and conversions
Z
27
28
Introduction
Rwork
on electronic components
on the hybrid system
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Rwork
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
technical data in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist in detecting and rectifying faults and
defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an acci-
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
dent
Roptimise
vehicle functions
Introduction
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
It is read by employees of the service network
(including manufacturers) using special diagnostic testers. More detailed information is
obtained from it, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necessary, under consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Rservice
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
Rdamage
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
Z
29
30
31
Cockpit ................................................. 32
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 36
Centre console .................................... 37
Overhead control panel ...................... 39
Door control panel .............................. 40
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 34
32
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
198
;
Combination switch
137
=
Horn
?
Instrument cluster
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
193
B
Climate control systems
150
C
Overhead control panel
39
D
Control panel for COMAND
Online and vehicle functions
37
34
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
181
181
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
125
G
Cruise control lever
216
Function
Page
H
Electric parking brake
I
Diagnostics connection
J
Opens the bonnet
391
K
Light switch
134
L
Control panel for:
Activating Steering Assist
Activating Active Lane
Keeping Assist
Deactivating PARKTRONIC
Switching on 360° camera
Switching on the head-up
display
Vehicles without a driver
assistance system: map/
coin holder
209
27
230
266
236
249
295
33
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
39
E
Light switch
134
;
Climate control systems
150
F
Opens the bonnet
391
=
Combination switch
137
G
Diagnostics connection
?
Instrument cluster
34
H
Electric parking brake
209
A
Horn
I
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
181
181
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
J
Adjusts the steering wheel
125
K
Cruise control lever
216
L
Control panel for COMAND
Online and vehicle functions
D
Control panel for:
Activating Steering Assist
Activating Active Lane
Keeping Assist
Deactivating PARKTRONIC
Switching on 360° camera
Switching on the head-up
display
Vehicles without a driver
assistance systems: map/
coin holder
193
198
230
266
236
249
295
27
37
34
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
:
Speedometer
;
Multifunction display
Function
Page
295
i Information on the energy flow display
and power display for electric motors in
hybrid vehicles can be found in the "Hybrid
drive" section (Y page 272).
Page
=
Rev counter
293
?
Coolant temperature gauge
293
A
Fuel gauge
Instrument cluster
35
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
å ESP® OFF
357
I
J Brakes (yellow)
;
÷ ESP®
357
J
6 Restraint system
=
· Distance warning
363
K
ü Seat belt
351
?
Ð Power steering
365
L
A
#! Turn signals
137
K Main-beam headlamps
137
B
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
M
359
L Dipped-beam headlamps
135
C
! ABS
355
N
8 Reserve fuel
360
D
; Engine diagnostics
360
O
E
% Diesel engine: preglow
T Side lamps, licence
plate and instrument cluster lighting
136
183
P
! Electric parking brake
(red)
N This lamp has no function
359
Q
R Rear foglamp
135
G
J Brakes (red)
353
R
h Tyre pressure monitor
364
H
? Coolant
360
F
i Information on warning and indicator
lamps in hybrid vehicles can be found in the
"Hybrid drive" section (Y page 272).
353
44
36
Multifunction steering wheel
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio 20/COMAND Online
display; see the separate
operating instructions
=
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
ó
Switches on LINGUATRONIC, see the separate
operating instructions
Page
295
304
Function
?
ò
Calls up a main menu
9:
Selects a menu/submenu
or scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
ñ
Switches off LINGUATRONIC, see the separate
operating instructions
Page
294
294
314
294
Centre console
37
Centre console
Function
At a glance
Centre console, upper section
Page
:
Climate control systems
150
;
£ Hazard warning
lamps
137
=
Vehicle functions/system
settings button (see the
separate operating instructions)
?
Telephone button (see the
separate operating instructions)
A
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamp
ATA indicator lamp
46
85
Function
B
Analogue clock
C
Media button (see the separate operating instructions)
D
Radio button (see the separate operating instructions)
E
Navigation button (see the
separate operating instructions)
F
þ Inserts/ejects a
CD/DVD (see the separate
operating instructions)
Page
38
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
i Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
Function
:
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Cup holders
;
Adjusts/mutes the volume
(see the separate operating
instructions)
=
Switches audio/COMAND
Online on/off (see the separate operating instructions)
?
è ECO start/stop function
A
Touchpad (see the separate
operating instructions)
Function
Page
Page
B
Stowage compartment
368
368
379
380
381
376
C
u Rear window roller
sunblind
379
D
É Sets the vehicle level
234
E
AGILITY SELECT switch
197
F
Back button (see the separate operating instructions)
G
Audio 20/COMAND controller (see the separate
operating instructions)
H
g Switches to the
favourites button (see the
separate operating instructions)
186
Overhead control panel
39
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
;
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
141
G SOS button
(Mercedes-Benz emergency call system)
384
?
c Switches the front
interior lighting on/off
141
A
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
141
B
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
140
=
140
Function
Page
C
ï MB Info call button
(Mercedes-Benz Contact)
385
D
Spectacles compartment
369
E
3 Opens/closes the
panorama sliding sunroof
Opens/closes the roller
sunblinds
112
113
F
Rear-view mirror
127
G
F Breakdown assistance call button
(Mercedes-Benz Contact)
385
40
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
:
Page
Function
E
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel
130
;
Adjusts the seats electrically
121
=
c Seat heating
123
?
s Seat ventilation
124
A
Opens the door
97
B
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
97
C
W Opens/closes the
rear left side window
106
D
W Opens/closes the left
side window
106
Page
7Zª\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
128
F
W Opens/closes the
right side window
106
G
W Opens/closes the
rear right side window
106
H
n Override feature for
the controls in the rear
compartment
I
p Opens/closes the
boot lid
73
104
41
Useful information .............................. 42
Hybrid vehicles ................................... 42
Panic alarm .......................................... 44
Children in the vehicle ........................ 63
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 74
Driving safety systems ....................... 74
Protection against theft ..................... 85
Safety
Occupant safety .................................. 44
42
Hybrid vehicles
Useful information
Safety
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
When towing a vehicle after an accident, be
sure to observe the following sections:
RTransporting
the vehicle (Y page 423)
RTowing the vehicle with the rear axle raised
(Y page 422)
the vehicle with both axles on the
ground (Y page 422)
Read the safety instructions on towing and
tow-starting (Y page 420).
RTowing
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Hybrid vehicles
General notes
Hybrid technology combines a fuel-efficient
internal combustion engine with a powerful
electric motor.
Important safety notes
Danger of electric shock
G DANGER
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage. If you modify components
in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
or touch damaged components, you may be
electrocuted. The components in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may be
damaged in an accident, although the damage
is not visible. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Do not touch any high-voltage components
after an accident and never modify the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system. Have the
vehicle towed away after an accident and the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
All components of the hybrid system are
marked with yellow warning stickers that
warn you of the danger of high voltage. The
cables of the vehicle's high-voltage electrical
system are orange in colour.
The ignition must be switched off when carrying out general tasks, such as changing
bulbs or checking the coolant level.
Automatic deactivation of the hybrid
system
G DANGER
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This can
effect belt tensioners or airbags, for example.
In addition, the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may not be deactivated as intended in the event of an accident. Touching
damaged components of the vehicle's highvoltage electrical system could result in an
electric shock. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Hybrid vehicles
If components of the restraint system are
activated during an accident, the hybrid system is automatically deactivated.
The hybrid system is not activated when the
vehicle is started if:
Ra short circuit is detected in the hybrid sys-
tem.
hybrid system electrical connection is
disconnected.
This ensures that you do not come into contact with high voltage.
Ra
Get assistance from others if necessary.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning. There is therefore a risk of being
locked out if the vehicle is being pushed or
tested on a dynamometer.
X Switch the ignition off.
X Shift the automatic transmission to park
position P.
Apply the electric parking brake
(Y page 209).
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away (Y page 439).
X To use the high-voltage switch-off
device: open the bonnet.
Manual deactivation of the hybrid system
The hybrid system can be deactivated manually using the high voltage switch-off device.
! To prevent damage to the hybrid system
please observe the following instructions:
Ronly
deactivate the hybrid system manually in the following situations.
Rwork on the hybrid system may only be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop, even when it has been deactivated
manually.
Rif
the 6 restraint system warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up after an
accident.
Rif the vehicle is badly damaged, e.g. after an
accident, and the restraint system components were not activated.
Rif the vehicle is badly damaged and has to
be towed or transported.
X If possible, move the vehicle out of the
danger zone: shift the automatic transmission into position N.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Roll the vehicle to a safe place and park it
safely.
Press release clip : in the direction of the
arrow and pull it out.
X Pull high voltage switch-off device ; apart
until it engages in the stop position.
X
High-voltage battery
G WARNING
In the event of a vehicle fire, the internal pressure of the high-voltage battery could exceed
a critical value. In this case, flammable gas
escapes through a vent valve in the vehicle's
underbody. The gas can ignite. There is a risk
of injury.
Leave the danger area immediately. Secure
the danger area at a suitable distance, whilst
observing legal requirements.
Z
Safety
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop. After an accident, immediately
switch the ignition off and remove the key
from the ignition lock.
43
Occupant safety
44
Safety
G WARNING
If the housing of the high-voltage battery has
been damaged, electrolyte and gases may
leak out. These are poisonous and caustic.
There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Immediately rinse electrolyte splashes off
with water and seek medical attention
straight away.
enables the recovery of kinetic energy (recuperation).
For further information on the RBS system
(Y page 269).
Panic alarm
! Exhaustive discharge caused by the vehicle standing idle for lengthy periods can
damage the high-voltage battery.
If the vehicle is idle for lengthy periods, run
it for a few minutes once every six weeks to
charge up the high-voltage battery.
During the charging process, switch off all
electrical consumers, e.g. the automatic
climate control or the seat heating.
Information on charging the high-voltage battery (Y page 416).
Engine compartment
Before opening the bonnet:
Apply the electric parking brake.
Shift the automatic transmission to park
position P.
X Switch the ignition off.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X Observe the warning notes on the risk of
electric shock (Y page 42).
X Observe the warning notes about the bonnet (Y page 391).
X
X
RBS driving safety system (Recuperative Brake System)
RBS supports you when braking with an electronically-controlled brake boost mode and
To activate: press ! button : for
approximately one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or, in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
X
The panic alarm function is only available in
certain countries.
Occupant safety
Introduction to the restraint system
The restraint system reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts
of the vehicle's interior in the event of an
accident. The restraint system can also
reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants
are subjected during an accident.
Occupant safety
Rseat
belt system
Rairbags
Rchild restraint system
Rchild seat securing system
The components of the restraint system work
in conjunction with each other. They can only
offer protection if all vehicle occupants
always:
Rhave
the seat belt correctly fastened
(Y page 48)
Rhave the seat and head restraint adjusted
properly (Y page 119)
As the driver, you must also make sure that
the steering wheel is also adjusted properly.
Observe the information on the correct driver's seat position (Y page 118).
In addition, you must make sure that the airbags can inflate properly if they are deployed
(Y page 51).
An airbag supplements a correctly worn seat
belt and, as an additional safety device,
increases protection for vehicle occupants in
applicable accident situations. The airbags
are not deployed, for example, in the event of
an accident in which sufficient protection is
offered by the seat belt. In addition, only
those airbags, which in the applicable accident situations offer additional protection,
are deployed in the event of an accident.
However, the seat belt and airbag generally
do not protect against objects penetrating
the vehicle from the outside.
Information on how the restraint system
operates can be found under "Deployment of
belt tensioners and airbags" (Y page 60).
See "Children in the vehicle" for further information on children travelling in the vehicle as
well as on child restraint systems
(Y page 63).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the restraint system is modified, it may no
longer work as intended. The restraint system
may then not perform its intended protective
function by failing in an accident or triggering
unexpectedly, for example. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify parts of the restraint system. Do
not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
If it is necessary to modify an airbag system to
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact an authorised Mercedes-Benz Centre.
Restraint system warning lamp
The functions of the restraint system are
checked after the ignition is switched on and
at regular intervals while the engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in good time.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a
few seconds after the engine is started. The
components of the restraint system are in
operational readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6
restraint system warning lamp:
Rdoes
not light up after the ignition is
switched on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds with
the engine running
Rlights up again while the engine is running
All vehicles, except hybrid vehicles:
G WARNING
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This can
effect belt tensioners or airbags, for example.
Z
Safety
The restraint system includes the:
45
Safety
46
Occupant safety
There is an increased risk of serious or even
fatal injuries.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Hybrid vehicles:
G DANGER
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This can
effect belt tensioners or airbags, for example.
In addition, the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may not be deactivated as intended in the event of an accident. Touching
damaged components of the vehicle's highvoltage electrical system could result in an
electric shock. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop. After an accident, immediately
switch the ignition off and remove the key
from the ignition lock.
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamp
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp :
and PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp ; are part of the deactivation system of
the front-passenger front airbag.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag.
RPASSENGER
AIR BAG ON : lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. If,
in the case of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
airbag is deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF ; lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident.
Depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front airbag must either be disabled or enabled; see
the following points. You must make sure of
this both before and during a journey.
RChildren
in a rearward-facing child
restraint system: the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit. The
front-passenger front airbag is disabled.
Always observe the information on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 54) and on
"Children in the vehicle" (Y page 63).
RChildren in a forward-facing child
restraint system: depending on the installed child restraint system, the age and size
of the child the front-passenger front airbag
is either disabled or enabled. Therefore,
always observe the information on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 54) and on
"Children in the vehicle" (Y page 63).
RAll other persons: the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp must be lit. The
front-passenger front airbag is enabled.
Depending on the build of the person on the
front-passenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp may light up. The
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident. In this case, the front-passenger
seat should not be used.
Always observe the information on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 54) as well
Occupant safety
Seat belts
Introduction
A correctly fastened seatbelt is the most
effective means of restraining the movement
of vehicle occupants in the event of a collision
or if the vehicle overturns. This reduces the
risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact
with parts of the vehicle interior or being
thrown from the vehicle. Additionally, the
seat belt helps to keep the vehicle occupant
in the best position in relation to the airbag.
The seat belt system consists of:
Rseat
belts
tensioners for the front seat belts and
the outer seat belts in the rear
Rbelt force limiters for the front seat belts
and the outer seat belts in the rear
If the seat belt is pulled too quickly or suddenly from the belt outlet, the inertia reel will
lock. The belt strap cannot be pulled out further.
In an impact, the belt tensioner tightens the
belt to pull it close to the body. It does not pull
the vehicle occupants back in the direction of
the seat backrest.
The belt tensioner cannot compensate for the
seat position being incorrect or for a seat belt
being routed or worn incorrectly.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which
take on a part of the deceleration force. This
reduces the forces to which vehicle occupants are subjected during an accident.
Rbelt
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do
not engage the seat belt tongue in the
buckle on the co-driver's seat. Otherwise,
the belt tensioner could be triggered in the
event of an accident and would have to be
replaced.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The seat belt cannot perform its intended protective function if it is not fastened correctly.
Also, an improperly fastened seat belt can
cause additional injuries in the event of an
accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes
of direction. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Always make sure that all vehicle occupants
are wearing their seat belt properly and are
seated correctly.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly without a suitable, additional restraint system. The seat belt cannot
perform its intended protective function if it is
not fastened correctly. Also, an improperly
fastened seat belt can cause additional injuries in the event of an accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes of direction. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in a suitable restraint system.
Z
Safety
as on "Seat belts" (Y page 47) and "Airbags" (Y page 51). There you can also find
information on the correct seat position.
47
48
Occupant safety
If a child younger than 12 years old and under
1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Safety
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz
vehicle. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes on the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 54)
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on "Children in the vehicle" in this
Owner's Manual (Y page 63) in addition
to the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot protect as intended, if:
Rthey are damaged, have been modified, are
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or inertia reels
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters. Modified or damaged seat belts can tear or fail, for
example in the event of an accident. Modified
seat belt tensioners may be deployed unintentionally or fail to be deployed when
required. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never modify safety belts, seat belt tensioners, seat belt anchorages and inertia reels.
Ensure that seat belts are not damaged or
worn and are clean. After an accident, have
the seat belts checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use seat belts which have been approved
specifically for your vehicle by MercedesBenz. Any such modifications could invalidate
the vehicle's general operating permit.
Correct seat belt use
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 47).
All vehicle occupants must be wearing the
seat belt correctly before beginning the journey. Also make sure that all vehicle occupants are always wearing the seat belt correctly while the vehicle is in motion.
When fastening the seat belt, always make
sure that:
Rthe
seat belt tongue is only inserted to the
belt buckle belonging to that seat.
Rthe seat belt is tight across your body.
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted.
Only then can forces which occur be distributed across the surface of the seat belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the centre of your shoulder.
The shoulder section of the seat belt should
not touch your neck nor be routed under
your arm. If possible, adjust the seat belt to
the appropriate height.
Rthe lap belt passes across your lap as
tightly and as low down as possible.
The lap must always be routed across your
hip joints and never across your abdomen.
This applies particularly to pregnant
women. If necessary, press the lap belt
down into your hip joints and pull tight with
the shoulder section of the belt.
Rthe seat belt is not routed across sharp,
pointed or fragile objects.
If you have such items located on or in your
clothing, e.g. pens, keys or spectacles,
store these in a suitable place.
Ronly one person is using a seat belt.
Infants and children must never travel sitting on the lap of a vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat
belt.
Robjects are never secured with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants.
Seat belts are only intended to secure and
restrain vehicle occupants. Always observe
the "Loading guidelines" for securing objects,
luggage or loads (Y page 368).
automatically; see "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 50).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 47) and the notes on correct use of
seat belts (Y page 48).
If the centre rear seat belt is being used, also
observe the information about the seat belt
for the centre rear seat (Y page 49).
The shoulder section of the seat belt must
always be routed across the centre of the
shoulder. Adjust the belt sash guide if necessary.
To raise: slide the belt guide upwards.
The belt guide will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt guide release : and
slide the belt guide downwards.
X Let go of belt guide release : in the
desired position and make sure that the
belt guide engages.
X
Seat belt for the centre rear seat
Adjust the seat (Y page 118).
The seat backrest must be in an almost
vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from belt sash
guide = and engage belt tongue ; into
belt buckle :.
The seat belt on the driver’s seat and the
front-passenger seat may be tightened
X
If the left-hand rear seat backrest is folded
down and back up again, the rear centre seat
belt may lock. The seat belt can then not be
pulled out.
X To release the rear centre seat belt: pull
the seat belt out approximately 20 mm at
the belt outlet on the backrest and then
release it again.
The seat belt is retracted and released.
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
Occupant safety
50
Safety
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
separate COMAND Online or Audio 20 operating instructions.
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all vehicle occupants to fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. A warning tone may
also sound.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone switches off as soon as the
driver and co-driver have fastened their seat
belts.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see the "Warning and
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster,
seat belt" section (Y page 351).
Rear seat belt status indicator
X
Press release button :, hold belt
tongue ; firmly and guide it back towards
belt outlet =.
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. This
function adjusts the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt to the upper body of the
occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Rthe
belt tongue is engaged in the buckle
and
Rthe ignition is switched on
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the vehicle occupant and the seat
belt. Do not hold on to the seat belt tightly
while it is adjusting.
You can switch the seat-belt adjustment on
and off using COMAND Online or Audio 20.
Information on activating and deactivating
the seat-belt adjustment function can be
found in the Digital Owner's Manual or in the
The rear seat belt status indicator is only
available for certain countries.
For approximately 30 seconds, the rear seat
belt status indicator informs you which rear
seat belt is not fastened.
The rear seat belt status indicator appears if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
you pull away again.
If a rear seat passenger unfastens their seat
belt when travelling at a speed above
25 km/h, a short warning tone also sounds.
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 314).
Airbags
Introduction
The installation location of an airbag is identified by the AIRBAG symbol.
An airbag supplements a correctly worn seat
belt. It is not a replacement for the seat belt.
The airbag offers additional protection in
applicable accident situations.
Not all airbags are deployed in an accident.
The different airbag systems work independently of each other (Y page 60).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
It is also not possible to completely rule out a
risk of injury caused by an airbag due to the
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended protective function and can even cause additional injuries when deployed. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
In order to avoid such risks, always ensure
that all vehicle occupants:
Rfasten
their seatbelts correctly, including
pregnant women
Rare seated correctly and maintain the furthest possible distance from the airbags
Robserve the following notes
Always ensure that there are no objects located between the airbag and the vehicle occupant.
RAdjust
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the
seat is in an almost upright position. The
centre of the head restraint must support
the head at about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger
seats as far back as possible. The driver's
seat position must allow the vehicle to be
driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside. This allows the airbag to be fully
deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against
the door or side window. You may otherwise be in the deployment area of the airbags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in
front of the seat. Do not put your feet on the
dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise be in the deployment area of the
airbag.
RFor this reason, always secure persons less
than 1.50 m tall in suitable restraint systems. Up to this height, the seat belt cannot
be worn correctly.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
RAlways
secure children under 12 years of
age and less than 1.50 m tall in suitable
child restraint systems.
RChild restraint systems should be fitted to
the rear seats.
ROnly secure a child to the front-passenger
seat when the front-passenger front airbag
is disabled, and only then in a rearwardfacing child restraint system. If the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
permanently lit, the front-passenger front
airbag is disabled (Y page 46).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 54) and on "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 63) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Z
51
Safety
Occupant safety
52
Occupant safety
Safety
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent the airbag from functioning correctly. Before starting your journey and to
avoid risks resulting from the speed of the
airbag as it deploys, make sure that:
Rthere
are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an airbag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, hang on
the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment area of an airbag, e.g. to doors, side
windows, rear side trim or side walls.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects
are in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
G WARNING
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an airbag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied.
In the event of an accident, the restraint
systems on the front-passenger side may
be triggered and have to be replaced.
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
When deployed on the front seats, the front
airbags offer additional protection for the
head and thorax.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
inform you about the status of the frontpassenger front airbag (Y page 46).
Front-passenger front airbag ; will only
deploy if:
Rthe
automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system has detected that the
front-passenger seat is occupied
(Y page 54). The PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON indicator lamp lights up (Y page 54)
Rthe restraint system predicts a high
severity of an accident
Driver's kneebag
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer bolster of the seat
backrest.
When deployed, the sidebag offers additional
thorax protection. However, it does not protect the:
Rhead
Rneck
Driver's kneebag : deploys under the steering column. The driver's kneebag is triggered
together with the front airbag.
The driver's kneebag on the driver's seat
offers additional protection for the thighs,
knee and lower leg.
Sidebags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers can obstruct or prevent the deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. Consequently, the airbags cannot protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. In addition, the function of the
automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system could be restricted. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for the corresponding seats by
Mercedes-Benz.
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the sidebag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: the sidebag
on the front-passenger side (front) deploys
under the following conditions:
Ran
occupant is detected on the frontpassenger seat or
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
If the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle, the sidebag on the front-passenger
side deploys if an appropriate accident situation occurs. In this case, deployment is independent of whether the front-passenger seat
is occupied or not.
Windowbags
Windowbags : are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deployed in the area
from the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
When deployed, the windowbag enhances the
level of protection for the head. However, it
does not protect the chest or arms.
Z
53
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
54
Occupant safety
In the event of a side impact, the windowbag
is deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
If the system determines that they can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt, a windowbag may be deployed in
other accident situations (Y page 60).
Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Introduction
In order to recognise a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat, the automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system categorises the person in the frontpassenger seat. Depending on that result, the
front-passenger front airbag is either enabled
or disabled. If a rearward-facing child
restraint system is fitted to the frontpassenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up after the
system self-test and remain lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
The system does not disable:
Rthe
sidebag
windowbag
Rthe seat belt tensioner
Make sure that your vehicle is equipped with
the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system (Y page 66). If this is
not the case, always fit the child restraint system on a suitable rear seat (Y page 68).
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
be sure to observe the correct positioning of
the child restraint system. Never place
objects under or behind the child restraint
system, e.g. cushions. Fully retract the seat
cushion length. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion of the front-passenger seat. The
backrest of the forwards-facing child restraint
system must, as far as possible, be resting on
the backrest of the front-passenger seat. The
Rthe
child restraint system must not touch the roof
or be put under strain by the head restraint.
Adjust the angle of the seat backrest and the
head restraint position accordingly. Only then
is the correct function of the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
guaranteed. Always observe the information
on suitable positioning of the child restraint
system (Y page 68) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Operation of automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation
: PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
The indicator lamps inform you whether the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled or
enabled.
X
Press the Start/Stop button once or twice,
or turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
The system carries out a self-diagnosis.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag.
RPASSENGER
AIR BAG ON : lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. If,
in the case of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
airbag is deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF ; lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident.
If the status of the front-passenger front airbag changes while the vehicle is in motion, an
airbag display message appears in the instrument cluster (Y page 328). When the frontpassenger seat is occupied, always pay attention to the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamps. Be
aware of the status of the front-passenger
front airbag both before and during the journey.
If there is no child restraint system fitted to
the front-passenger seat, the front-passenger
must sit:
Rwith
the seat belt fastened correctly
Rin an almost upright position with their
back against the seat backrest
Rwith their feet resting on the floor, if possible
If the front passenger does not observe these
conditions, the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system may be influenced, e.g. because the front passenger:
Rtransfers
their weight by supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest
Rsits in such a way that their weight is raised
from the seat cushion
The front-passenger front airbag may be disabled by mistake as a result of these or similar
actions. In this case, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up permanently. The front-passenger front airbag does
not then deploy during an accident.
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always make sure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and that the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible.
Rthe person is seated correctly.
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front-passenger
front airbag is correct.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains off and/or the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install
a rearward-facing child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat. Further information
can be found under "Problems with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 59).
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of an
accident and cannot perform its intended protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
Z
55
Safety
Occupant safety
56
Occupant safety
Safety
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is lit
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Always move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible and fully retract the seat
cushion length. Always make sure that the
shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the vehicle belt outlet. If
necessary, adjust the vehicle belt outlet and
the front-passenger seat accordingly. Always
observe the information about suitable positioning of the child restraint system in this
Owner's Manual as well as the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system detects that:
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a rearward-facing child restraint
system, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up after the system selftest and remains lit. This indicates that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled.
But in the case of a child in a rearwardfacing child restraint, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp can light up after
the system self-test and remain lit. This
indicates that the front-passenger front airbag is enabled. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors,
the child restraint system and the child's
build. It is recommended that you fit the
restraint system to a suitable rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a forward-facing child restraint system, either the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON or
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up and remains lit after the system
self-test depending on the result of the
classification. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors,
the child restraint system and the child's
build.
Move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. Always observe the information in "Child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 66) and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system" (Y page 68). Alternatively, you can
fit the child restraint system to a suitable
rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
person with a smaller build (e.g. a teenager
or small adult), either the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON or PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up and remains lit after
the system self-test depending on the
result of the classification.
- if the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp lights up, move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. Alternatively, a person with a small build can sit
on a rear seat.
- if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, a person with a smaller build
should not use the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person with a build corresponding to that of an adult, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up after the
system self-test and remains lit. This indicates that the front-passenger front airbag
is enabled.
If children are travelling in the vehicle, be sure
to observe the notes on "Children in the Vehicle" (Y page 63).
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system is malfunctioning, the
red 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster and the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp light up simultaneously. The front-passenger front airbag is
disabled in this case and does not deploy during an accident. Have the system checked as
soon as possible by qualified technicians.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. The
front-passenger seat should only be repaired
at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
If the front-passenger seat, the seat cover or
the seat cushion is damaged, have the necessary repair work carried out at a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system which has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz in combination with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system.
System self-test
G DANGER
If both the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps do
not light up during the system self-test, the
system is malfunctioning. The frontpassenger front airbag might be triggered
unintentionally or might not be triggered at all
in the event of an accident with high deceleration. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Do not install a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat. Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
remains lit after the system self-test, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger front airbag
cannot perform its intended protective function, e.g. when a person is seated in the frontpassenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle's interior, especially
if the person is sitting too close to the dashboard. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe person is seated properly with a correctly fastened seat belt.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit when it should not, the frontpassenger seat may not be used. Do not
install a child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. Have the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects between the seat surface and the
child restraint system could affect the function of the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system. This could result
in the front-passenger front airbag not functioning as intended during an accident. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Do not place any objects between the seat
surface and the child restraint system. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
Z
57
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
58
Occupant safety
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the forwardsfacing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, be resting on the backrest of the
rear reclining seat. Always comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
After the system self-test, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF or PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp display the status of the frontpassenger front airbag (Y page 54).
Further information can be found under
"Problems with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 59).
Occupant safety
59
Problems with automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Be sure to observe the notes on "System self-test" (Y page 57).
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
The classification of the person on the front-passenger seat is
BAG OFF indicator
incorrect.
lamp lights up and
X Make sure the conditions for a correct classification of the perremains lit, even
son on the front-passenger seat are met (Y page 54).
though the frontX If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the
passenger seat is occufront-passenger seat may not be used.
pied by an adult or a
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
person with a build corsystem checked as soon as possible at a Mercedes-Benz Serresponding to that of an
vice Centre.
adult.
The PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator
lamp does not light up
and/or does not stay
on.
The front-passenger
seat is:
The automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system is
malfunctioning.
X Make sure there is nothing between the seat and the child
restraint system.
X Make sure that the entire base of the child restraint system rests
on the seat cushion.
X Make sure that the seat cushion length is fully retracted.
Rempty
X When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the
Roccupied with a rearseat belt is tight. Do not pull the seat belt tight with the frontward-facing child
passenger seat adjustment. This could result in the seat belt and
restraint system
the child restraint system being pulled too tightly.
X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly.
X Make sure that no objects are applying additional weight to the
seat.
X If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains off and/
or the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not
install a rearward-facing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. It is recommended that you fit the restraint
system to a suitable rear seat.
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system checked as soon as possible at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
Safety
Problem
60
Occupant safety
Deployment of belt tensioners and airbags
Safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
After the airbag deploys, the airbag parts are
hot. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have a
deployed airbag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners that have
been deployed are no longer operational and
are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic belt tensioners
which have been triggered immediately
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the vehicle towed to a qualified specialist
workshop after an accident. Take this into
account, particularly if a seat belt tensioner
was triggered or an airbag was deployed.
An electric motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to
trigger the tightening of the seat belt in hazardous situations. This procedure is reversible.
If the belt tensioners are triggered or an airbag is deployed, you will hear a bang, and a
small amount of powder may also be
released. The 6 restraint system warning
lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your
hearing. In general, the powder released is
not hazardous to health but may cause shortterm breathing difficulties to persons suffering from asthma or other pulmonary conditions. Provided it is safe to do so, you should
leave the vehicle immediately or open the
window in order to prevent breathing difficulties.
Operation
During the first stage of a collision, the
restraint system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the
restraint system control unit triggers the seat
belt tensioners in the event of a head-on or
rear collision.
A seat belt tensioner can only be triggered if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational; see "Restraint system warning
lamp" (Y page 45)
Rthe belt tongue has engaged in the belt
buckle of the respective front seat
The seat belt tensioners in the rear compartment are triggered independently of the lock
status of the seat belts.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
high severity of an accident, in certain headon collisions, additional components of the
restraint system are deployed independently
of each another:
Rfront
airbags and driver's kneebag
if the system determines that
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
On vehicles with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system:
depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front airbag is either disabled or enabled. The frontpassenger front airbag can only be deployed
in an accident if the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp is lit. Observe the information
on the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps
(Y page 46).
Your vehicle has two-stage front airbags. In
the first deployment stage, the front airbag is
filled with propellant gas to reduce the risk of
Rwindowbag,
injuries. The front airbag is fully deployed if
the second deployment stage is activated
within a few milliseconds.
The activation threshold for the seat belt tensioners and airbags is determined based on
the evaluation of the vehicle's rate of deceleration or acceleration at various points in the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering/deployment process should
take place in good time at the start of the
collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly
without an airbag being deployed. This is the
case if only parts which are relatively easily
deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high. Conversely, an airbag may
be deployed even though the vehicle suffers
only minor deformation. This is the case if, for
example, very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are hit, and sufficient
deceleration occurs as a result.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
side impact or if the vehicle overturns, the
applicable components of the restraint system are activated independently of each
other depending on the apparent type of accident. If the system determines that, in this
situation, triggering can offer additional protection, the seat belt tensioners are also triggered.
RSidebags
on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent from the seat belt tensioner and seat belt usage
Vehicles with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system: the sidebag on the front-passenger
side (front) deploys under the following
conditions:
- an occupant is detected on the frontpassenger seat or
- the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
RWindowbag on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent of seat belt usage and
regardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
RWindowbags on the driver's and frontpassenger side in certain situations if the
vehicle overturns and if the system determines that deployment can offer additional
protection to that provided by the seat belt
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal
collision
impact
Roverturn
Rside
Z
61
Safety
Occupant safety
62
Occupant safety
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Safety
Introduction
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
Although your vehicle is equipped with a PRESAFE® system, the possibility of injury in the
event of an accident cannot be ruled out.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions and
maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in
front. Drive carefully.
Function
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
BAS is activated
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when phys-
ical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely
Rvehicles with the Driving Assistance package: when a driver assistance system intervenes powerfully or the radar sensor system detects an imminent danger of collision in certain situations
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
Rif the vehicle skids, the sliding sunroof and
the side windows are closed so that only a
small gap remains. The panorama sliding
sunroof is completely closed.
Rvehicles with the memory function for the
front-passenger seat: the front-passenger
seat is adjusted if it is in an unfavourable
position.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pre-tensioning. All settings made by
PRE-SAFE® can then be reversed.
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced:
X
Move the seat backrest or seat back
slightly when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. You
will find information on the convenience function under "Belt adjustment" (Y page 50).
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory occupant protection PLUS)
Introduction
PRE-SAFE® PLUS is only available in vehicles
with the Driving Assistance package.
Using the radar sensor system, PRE-SAFE®
PLUS is able to detect that a head-on or rearend collision is imminent. In certain hazardous situations, PRE-SAFE® PLUS takes preemptive measures to protect the vehicle
occupants.
Important safety notes
The intervention of PRE-SAFE® PLUS cannot
prevent an imminent collision.
The driver is not warned when PRE-SAFE®
PLUS intervenes.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS does not intervene:
Rif
the vehicle is reversing
the vehicle is towing a trailer and
there is a risk of a rear-end collision
PRE-SAFE® PLUS does not perform braking
actions while the vehicle is in motion or when
Parking Guidance is active.
Rwhen
Children in the vehicle
PRE-SAFE® PLUS intervenes in certain situations if the radar sensor system detects an
imminent head-on or rear-end collision.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS takes the following measures depending on the hazardous situation
detected:
RIf
the radar sensor system detects that a
head-on collision is imminent, the seat
belts are pre-tensioned.
RIf the radar sensor system detects that a
rear-end collision is imminent:
- the rear hazard warning lamps are activated and flash at a higher frequency.
- the brake pressure is increased if the
driver applies the brakes when the vehicle is stationary.
- the seat belts are pre-tensioned.
The PRE-SAFE® PLUS braking application is
cancelled:
Rif
the accelerator pedal is depressed when
a gear is engaged
Rif the risk of a collision passes or is no longer detected
Rif DISTRONIC PLUS indicates an intention
to pull away
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, the original settings
are restored.
Automatic measures after an accident
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures are implemented, depending on
the type and severity of the impact:
Rthe
hazard warning lamps are activated
emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rvehicles with a memory function: the electrically adjustable steering wheel is raised
Rthe engine is switched off
Rthe
Rvehicles
with the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system: automatic emergency
call
Rvehicles with the hybrid drive system: the
hybrid system is deactivated
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat. Children are generally better protected there.
If a child younger than 12 years old and under
1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes in this section in addition to
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions
Ralways pay attention to the instructions
and safety notes on the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 54)
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
Z
Safety
Function
63
64
Children in the vehicle
Safety
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly. Particular attention must be
paid to children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 47) and the information on the correct use of the seat belt (Y page 48).
Child restraint system
Observe the instructions for correct use of
the child restraint system (Y page 68).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(Y page 71).
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
You will find further information on stowing
objects, luggage and loads securely under
"Loading guidelines" (Y page 368).
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
Children in the vehicle
Securing systems for the child restraint system are:
Rthe
seat belt system
ISOFIX securing rings
Rthe Top Tether anchorages
If it is absolutely necessary to carry a child on
the front-passenger seat, be sure to observe
the information on "Child restraint systems
on the front-passenger seat" (Y page 66).
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
Before every trip, make sure that the ISOFIX
child restraint system is engaged correctly in
both ISOFIX securing rings.
! When fitting the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the centre
seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the
seat belt could be damaged.
Rthe
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. You can
obtain information about this at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
ISOFIX child seat securing system
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems do not offer
sufficient protective effect for children whose
weight is greater than 22 kg who are secured
using the safety belt integrated in the child
restraint system. The child could, for example,
not be restrained correctly in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems with which the
child is also secured with the vehicle seat belt.
Also secure the child restraint system with the
Top Tether belt, if available.
When fitting a child restraint system, be sure
to observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the instructions for correct
use of the child restraint system
(Y page 68).
: ISOFIX securing rings
Vehicles with rear seat armrest: adjust the
rear seat armrest so that ISOFIX securing
rings : for the ISOFIX child restraint system
are accessible.
X Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings :.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. ISOFIX securing rings : for
two ISOFIX child restraint systems are fitted
on the left and right of the rear seats.
Secure child restraint systems without an
ISOFIX child seat securing system using the
seat belts in the vehicle. When fitting a child
restraint system, be sure to observe the manufacturer's installation and operating instructions and the instructions for correct use of
the child restraint system (Y page 68).
Top Tether
Introduction
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the vehicle. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further. If the child
Z
Safety
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
65
66
Children in the vehicle
restraint system is fitted with a Top Tether
belt, this should always be used.
Safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear seat backrests are not locked, they
could fold forwards in the event of an accident, heavy braking or sudden changes of
direction. As a result, child restraint systems
cannot perform their intended protective
function. Rear seat backrests that are not
locked can also cause additional injuries, e.g.
in the event of an accident. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always lock rear seat backrests after fitting a
Top Tether belt. Observe the lock verification
indicator. Adjust the rear seat backrests so
that they are in an upright position.
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged and
locked, this will be shown in the multifunction
display in the instrument cluster. A warning
tone also sounds.
Top Tether anchorages
Top Tether anchorage points = are fitted in
the rear compartment behind the outer head
restraints on the parcel shelf.
Move head restraint : upwards.
Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Always comply with the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Route Top Tether belt A under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? of Top Tether belt
A into Top Tether anchorage =.
Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Tension Top Tether belt A. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =.
X If necessary, move head restraint : back
down again slightly (Y page 121).
Make sure that you do not interfere with the
correct routing of Top Tether belt A.
X
X
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
General notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat.
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: if it is absolutely necessary to fit a child restraint system
to the front-passenger seat, always observe
the information on "Automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 54).
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise
as a result of:
front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is enabled (Y page 46).
Vehicles without the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation
system
Ra child restraint system that is not detected
by the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Rthe unintentional disabling of the frontpassenger front airbag
Rthe unsuitable positioning of the child
restraint system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Please observe the warning notice on the
front-passenger sun visor, see the illustration.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is
not equipped with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system,
this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. The sticker is
visible when you open the front-passenger
door.
In this case, always fit the rearward-facing
child restraint system to a suitable rear seat
(Y page 68).
Observe the following information under
"Rearward-facing child restraint system" and
"Forward-facing child restraint system" as
well as information on the suitable positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 68).
Rearward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a rearwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always make sure that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. Only
if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is permanently lit (Y page 46) is the
front-passenger front airbag disabled.
Z
67
Safety
Children in the vehicle
68
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 68) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
of the child restraint system is not possible
due to possible contact with the roof.
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label and the text "Universal".
Forward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a forwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible. Fully
retract the seat cushion length. The entire
base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the child
restraint system must, as far as possible, be
resting on the backrest of the frontpassenger seat. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof or be put under strain
by the head restraint. Adjust the angle of the
seat backrest and the head restraint position
accordingly. Always make sure that the shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from the
vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt guide
on the child restraint system. The shoulder
belt strap must be routed forwards and downwards from the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary, adjust the vehicle belt outlet and the
front-passenger seat accordingly.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 68) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint system
Introduction
Only child restraint systems which are
approved in accordance with the ECE standard ECE R44 are permitted for use in the vehicle.
For certain child restraint systems in weight
categories II or III, this can mean that the area
of use is restricted. The maximum size setting
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be used on the seats indicated with U, UF
or IUF according to the tables "Suitability of
the seats for attaching belt-secured child
restraint systems" or "Suitability of the seats
for attaching an ISOFIX child restraint system".
Semi-universal child restraint systems are
indicated by the text "Semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For
more information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat – if it is absolutely necessary
to secure a child in a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat:
X
Always pay attention to the instructions
under "Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 66).
There you will find instructions on how to
correctly route the shoulder belt strap from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
Children in the vehicle
Suitability of the seats for attaching
belt-secured child restraint systems
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+
or a rearward-facing child restraint system of
category I on a rear seat, you must adjust the
driver's or front-passenger seat so that the
seat does not touch the child restraint system.
If you use a forward-facing child restraint system from category I, you must, where possible, dismantle the head restraint of the
respective seat (Y page 122). The backrest of
the child restraint system must, as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Always observe the notes in the "Child
restraint system" section (Y page 64) and the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system,
you must immediately replace the head
restraint (Y page 121). All vehicle occupants
must adjust their head restraints correctly
before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X
Seat which is unsuitable for children in
this weight category
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the
"Universal" category that are approved
for use in this weight category
UF Suitable for forward-facing child
restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category and are approved for
use in this weight category
L Suitable for child restraint systems as
recommended; see the table "Recommended child restraint systems"
(Y page 71). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint systems if the vehicle
and the seat are listed in the child
restraint system manufacturer's vehicle
model list.
(▲) The vehicle is equipped with automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
(♦) Child restraint systems with a supporting
bracket are not suitable for this seat.
Front-passenger seat
Weight categories
The frontpassenger
front airbag is enabled.
The frontpassenger
front airbag is disabled. (▲)
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
X
U, L
Category I:
9 to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
Category II: U, L
15 to 25 kg
U, L
Category
III: 22 to
36 kg
U, L
U, L
Z
Safety
guide on the child restraint system
(Y page 68).
X Move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible and fully retract the seat cushion length.
X Move the backrest to an almost vertical
position.
The entire base of the child restraint system must always rest on the seat cushion of
the front-passenger seat. The backrest of
the forward-facing child restraint system
must, as far as possible, be resting on the
backrest of the front-passenger seat. The
child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraint. Adjust the angle of the seat backrest and the head restraint position accordingly. Also observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
X Move the seat cushion angle to the highest,
most vertical position.
69
70
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Rear seats
Legend for the table:
Weight categories
Left, right
Centre
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
U, L
U (♦), L (♦)
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
U, L
U (♦), L (♦)
Category I:
9 to 18 kg
U, L
U (♦), L (♦)
Category II: U, L
15 to 25 kg
X
Category
III: 22 to
36 kg
X
U, L
Suitability of the seats for attaching
ISOFIX child restraint systems
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+
or a rearward-facing child restraint system of
category I on a rear seat, you must adjust the
driver's or front-passenger seat so that the
seat does not touch the child restraint system.
If you use a forward-facing child restraint system from category I, you must, where possible, dismantle the head restraint of the
respective seat (Y page 122). The backrest of
the child restraint system must, as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Always observe the notes in the "Child
restraint system" section (Y page 64) and the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system,
you must immediately replace the head
restraint (Y page 121). All vehicle occupants
must adjust their head restraints correctly
before beginning the journey.
X
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for
ISOFIX child restraint systems in this
weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child
seat securing systems that belong to the
"universal" category which are approved
for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of "Recommended child
restraint systems" (Y page 71).
The manufacturer will also recommend a
suitable ISOFIX child restraint system.
For this, your vehicle and the seat must
be listed in the child restraint system
manufacturer's model list. For more
information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
(♦) If you are using a child restraint system
of size category C (ISO/R3), move the
front seat to the highest position and the
front-seat backrest to an upright position. Make sure that the seat backrest of
the front seat does not rest against the
child restraint system.
Carry-cot weight category
Size category
Equipment Rear seat,
left and right
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg up to
approximately 6 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
Children in the vehicle
Recommended child restraint systems
for attaching with the vehicle seat belt
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg; up to
approximately 6 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
D
ISO/R2
IL
Type
C
ISO/R3
IL (♦)
BABY SAFE
plus
BABY SAFE
plus II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
970 20 00
Colour code: Colour code:
9H95
9H95
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg approximately 9 months to 4 years
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL (♦)
B
ISO/F2
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
The child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraint. Adjust the head restraint position
accordingly. Also observe the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Recommended child restraint systems
General notes
Always observe the information on "Child
restraint systems on the front-passenger
seat" (Y page 66) and on "Suitable positioning
of the child restraint system" (Y page 68).
You can obtain further information about the
correct child restraint system from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg; up to
approximately 15 months
Manufacturer
Britax
Römer
Britax Römer
Type
BABY
SAFE plus
BABY SAFE plus
II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 30114
6
04 30114
6
04 301146
Order
970 10 00 970 20 00
number
Colour
Colour code:
(A 000 ...) code:
9H95
9H95
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg; approximately 9 months to 4 years
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
Approval number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 16 00
Colour code: 9H95
Z
Safety
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg up to
approximately 15 months
71
72
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Weight category II/III: 15 to 36 kg;
approximately 4 to 12 years
Type
BABY SAFE plus
–
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Approval number (E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
–
Type
KIDFIX
Order number
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
B6 6 86 8224
Colour code:
9H95
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 19 00
Colour code: 9H95
Before fitting the KIDFIX child restraint system in the vehicle, always observe the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation
instructions. These will also include notes on
fixing options.
Recommended "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint
systems
Carry-cot weight category
Category I: 9 to 18 kg
Size categories
D, C, B, A
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Order number
–
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Size categories
F, G
Type
DUO plus
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Order number
(A 000 ...)
Order number
–
970 16 00
Colour code: 9H95
Child-proof locks
Category 0: up to 10 kg
Size category
E
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Order number
–
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are travelling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Category 0+: up to 13 kg
Size categories
E
D, C
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
–
Roperate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Children in the vehicle
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
Safety
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are travelling in the
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for:
Rthe
Rthe
rear doors (Y page 73)
rear side windows (Y page 73)
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side windows
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
73
X
To activate/deactivate: press button ;.
If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the drivZ
74
Driving safety systems
Safety
er's door. If indicator lamp : is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
Pets in the vehicle
G WARNING
If you leave animals unsupervised or unsecured in the vehicle, they may push a button
or a switch, for example.
They could:
Ractivate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Rswitch vehicle systems on or off, thus
endangering other road users
In the event of an accident, sudden braking or
abrupt changes of direction, unsecured animals could be flung around the vehicle, injuring the vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals correctly during a
journey, e.g. in an animal transport box.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 74)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 75)
RBAS PLUS with Cross-Traffic Assist (Brake
Assist System PLUS with Cross-Traffic
Assist) (Y page 75)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(distance warning function and adaptive
Brake Assist) (Y page 77)
RAdaptive brake lamps (Y page 80)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 80)
REBD
(electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 82)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 82)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 82)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 85)
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. Driving safety
systems are merely aids designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the distance
to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and
for braking in good time. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road,
weather and traffic conditions and maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there is
adequate contact between the tyres and the
road surface. Please pay special attention to
the notes on tyres, recommended minimum
tyre tread depths etc. (Y page 428).
In wintry driving conditions, always use winter
tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary, snow
chains. Only in this way will the driving safety
systems described in this section work as
effectively as possible.
RABS
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
Driving safety systems
Important safety notes
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 355) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 315).
ABS works from a speed of about
8 km/hupwards, regardless of road-surface
conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces,
even when you only brake gently.
Braking
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions, and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
tion (Y page 74).
Braking
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist PLUS) with
Cross-Traffic Assist
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
BAS PLUS is only available on vehicles with
the Driving Assistance package.
For BAS PLUS to assist you when driving, the
radar sensor system and the camera system
must be operational.
With the help of a sensor system and a camera system, BAS PLUS can detect obstacles:
Rthat
are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time
Rthat cross the path of your vehicle
In addition, pedestrians in the path of your
vehicle can be detected.
BAS PLUS detects pedestrians using typical
characteristics such as the body contours
and posture of a person standing upright.
If the radar sensor system or the camera system is malfunctioning, BAS PLUS functions
are restricted or no longer available. The
Z
Safety
tion (Y page 74).
75
76
Driving safety systems
brake system is still available with complete
brake boosting effect and BAS.
Safety
i Observe the restrictions described in the
"Important safety notes" section
(Y page 76).
BAS PLUS can help you to minimise the risk of
a collision with a vehicle or a pedestrian and
reduce the effects of such a collision. If BAS
PLUS detects a danger of collision, you are
assisted when braking.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
BAS PLUS cannot always clearly identify
objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, BAS PLUS may:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
BAS PLUS does not react:
Rto
small people, e.g. children
animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rwhen cornering
As a result, BAS PLUS may not intervene in all
critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Rinterference
Ra
narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rvehicles quickly moving into the radar sensor system detection range
Detection by the camera system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the camera or if the camera is covered
Rglare on the camera system, e.g. from the
sun being low in the sky
Rdarkness
Rif:
- pedestrians move quickly, e.g. into the
path of the vehicle
- the camera system no longer detects a
pedestrian as a person due to special
clothing or other objects
- a pedestrian is concealed by other
objects
- the typical outline of a person is not distinguishable from the background
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Following damage to the windscreen, have
the configuration and operation of the camera system checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Function
To avoid a collision, BAS PLUS calculates the
brake force necessary if:
Ryou
approach an obstacle and
PLUS has detected a risk of collision
When driving at a speed under 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal, BAS PLUS is
activated. Braking assistance from BAS PLUS
is carried out at the last possible moment.
RBAS
When driving at a speed above 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal sharply, BAS
PLUS automatically increases the brake pressure to a degree suited to the traffic situation.
BAS PLUS provides braking assistance in hazardous situations with vehicles in front within
a speed range between 7 km/h and
250 km/h.
At speeds of up to approximately 70 km/h,
BAS PLUS can react to:
Rstationary
objects in the path of your vehicle, e.g. stopped or parked vehicles
Rpedestrians in the path of your vehicle
Robstacles crossing your path, which move
in the detection range of the sensors and
are recognised by them
i If BAS PLUS demands particularly high
braking force, preventative passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
BAS PLUS is deactivated and the brakes function as usual again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
is no longer a risk of collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou activate kickdown
Rthere
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS
General notes
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS consists of a distance warning function with an
autonomous emergency braking function and
adaptive Brake Assist.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can
help you to minimise the risk of a collision
with the vehicle in front or reduce the effects
of such a collision.
If COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
detects that there is a risk of a collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically. If you
do not react to the visual and audible collision
warning, autonomous braking can be initiated
in critical situations. If you apply the brake
yourself in a critical situation, the COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS adaptive Brake
Assist assists you.
Important safety notes
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rnew vehicles or after a service on the COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS system
Please observe the information in the section on running-in the vehicle
(Y page 180).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rsnow
Distance warning function
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 74).
Z
77
Safety
Driving safety systems
78
Driving safety systems
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Safety
Rto
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation; do not rely on the distance warning
function alone.
Rnot
Function
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate the distance warning function in the
on-board computer (Y page 308).
If the distance warning function is deactivated, the æ symbol appears in the assistance graphics display.
The distance warning function can help you to
minimise the risk of a collision with the vehicle in front or reduce the effects of such a
collision. If the distance warning function
detects that there is a risk of a collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically.
The distance warning function issues a warning at speeds:
Rof approximately 30 km/h or more, if, over
several seconds, the distance maintained
to the vehicle travelling in front is insuffi-
cient. The · distance warning lamp
then lights up in the instrument cluster.
Rof approximately 7 km/h or more, if you
rapidly approach a vehicle in front. An intermittent warning tone will then sound and
the · distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause the system to display a
warning.
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, the
distance warning function can also react to
stationary obstacles, such as stopped or
parked vehicles.
If you approach an obstacle and the distance
warning function detects a risk of a collision,
the system will alert you both visually and
acoustically.
Autonomous braking function
If the driver does not react to the distance
warning signal in a critical situation, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can assist
with the autonomous braking function.
The autonomous braking function:
Rgives
the driver more time to react to critical driving situations
Rcan help the driver to avoid an accident or
Rreduces the effects of an accident
Vehicles without DISTRONIC PLUS: the
autonomous braking function is available in
the following speed ranges:
R7
- 105 km/h for moving objects
R7 - 50 km/h for stationary objects
Vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: the autonomous braking function is available in the following speed ranges:
R7
- 200 km/h for moving objects
- 50 km/h for stationary objects
If the autonomous braking function demands
particularly high braking force, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated simultaneously.
R7
Adaptive Brake Assist
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
Adaptive Brake Assist provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds
above 7 km/h. It uses radar sensor technology to assess the traffic situation.
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist can:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, the Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
tions may also cause Brake Assist to intervene.
If adaptive Brake Assist is not available due to
a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system remains available with full
brake boosting effect and BAS.
With the help of adaptive Brake Assist, the
distance warning signal can detect obstacles
that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
If adaptive Brake Assist detects a risk of collision with the vehicle in front, it calculates
the braking force necessary to avoid a collision. If you apply the brakes forcefully, adaptive Brake Assist will automatically increase
the braking force to a level suitable for the
traffic conditions.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
is no longer any danger of a collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Adaptive Brake Assist is then deactivated.
If adaptive Brake Assist demands particularly
high braking force, preventative passenger
protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
Up to a speed of approximately 250 km/h,
adaptive Brake Assist is capable of reacting to
moving objects that have already been detected as such at least once over the period of
observation.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h
adaptive Brake Assist reacts to stationary
obstacles.
Rthere
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving condiZ
79
Safety
Driving safety systems
80
Driving safety systems
Adaptive brake lamps
The adaptive brake lights warn following traffic in an emergency braking situation:
Safety
Rby
flashing brake lamps
activating the hazard warning lamps
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In
this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 137).
Rby
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tyres
and the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
ETS traction control is part of ESP®. On vehicles with 4MATIC, 4ETS is a component of
ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! If you test the parking brake using a brake
dynamometer, switch the ignition off.
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 422).
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up and:
Rthe
vehicle is moving
ECO start/stop function is activated
If the ÷ warning lamp lights up continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 357) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 315).
Only use wheels with the recommended tyre
sizes. Only then will ESP® function properly.
Rthe
Driving safety systems
General notes
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP®
was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to
spin.
Rin
Deactivating/activating ESP®
You can deactivate or activate ESP® via the
on-board computer.
X To deactivate: (Y page 307).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X
To activate: (Y page 307).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
driven wheels can spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; nor is it
activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available; it
is also not activated if you brake firmly with
assistance from ESP®
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
Rthe
Z
Safety
Characteristics of ESP®
81
82
Driving safety systems
Safety
ESP® trailer stabilisation
General notes
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, ESP® assists you in this situation. ESP®
slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting the engine output until the vehicle/trailer
combination has stabilised.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can
tip over before ESP® can detect this. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, you can only stabilise the vehicle/
trailer combination by depressing the brake
firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation is active above
speeds of approximately 65 km/h.
ESP® trailer stabilisation does not work if
ESP® is deactivated or disabled because of a
malfunction.
Important safety notes
Crosswind Assist does not work if ESP® is
deactivated or disabled because of a malfunction.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
G WARNING
If EBD is malfunctioning, the rear wheels can
lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the
risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 355) as well as display messages (Y page 318).
Crosswind Assist
General notes
Strong crosswind gusts can impair the roadholding of your vehicle when driving straight
ahead. The crosswind driving assistance
function integrated in ESP® noticeably
reduces these impairments.
Depending on the direction and intensity of
the side wind, ESP® is activated automatically.
ESP intervenes with stabilising braking to
assist you in keeping the vehicle in the lane.
Crosswind Assist is active at vehicle speeds
above 80 km/h when driving straight ahead
or cornering gently.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 232) and
hill start assist (Y page 185).
PRE-SAFE® Brake
General notes
i Pay attention to the important safety
notes in the "Driving safety systems" section (Y page 74).
Driving safety systems
Important safety notes
In these cases, PRE-SAFE® Brake may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be ready to brake, especially if
PRE-SAFE® Brake warns you. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
The PRE-SAFE® Brake function can also brake
the vehicle automatically under the following
conditions:
Rthe
driver and front passenger have their
seat belts fastened
and
Rthe vehicle speed is between approximately 7 km/h and 200 km/h
At a speed of up to approximately 70 km/h,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can also detect:
Rstationary
objects in the path of your vehicle, e.g. stopped or parked vehicles
Rpedestrians in the path of your vehicle
G WARNING
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake will initially brake your vehi-
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react:
cle by a partial application of the brakes if a
danger of collision is detected. There may be
a collision unless you brake yourself. Even
after subsequent full application of the brakes
a collision cannot always be avoided, particularly when approaching at too high a speed.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself and try to
take evasive action, provided it is safe to do
so.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic conditions.
Rto
small people, e.g. children
Rto animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, PRE-SAFE® Brake may neither
give warnings nor intervene in all critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Z
Safety
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is only available for vehicles with the Driving Assistance package.
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system and the camera
system must be switched on and operational.
With the help of the radar sensor system and
the camera system, PRE-SAFE® Brake can
detect obstacles that are in front of your vehicle for an extended period of time.
In addition, pedestrians in the path of your
vehicle can be detected.
PRE-SAFE® Brake detects pedestrians using
typical characteristics such as the body contours and posture of a person standing
upright.
Observe the restrictions described in the
"Important safety notes" section“ (Y page 83).
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a collision with a vehicle ahead or a
pedestrian, and reduce the effects of such a
collision. If PRE-SAFE® Brake has detected a
risk of collision, you will be warned visually
and acoustically as well as by automatic braking.
83
84
Driving safety systems
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Safety
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Detection by the camera system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the camera or if the camera is covered
Rglare on the camera system, e.g. from the
sun being low in the sky
Rdarkness
Rif:
- pedestrians move quickly, e.g. into the
path of the vehicle
- the camera system no longer detects a
pedestrian as a person due to special
clothing or other objects
- a pedestrian is concealed by other
objects
- the typical outline of a person is not distinguishable from the background
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Following damage to the windscreen, have
the configuration and operation of the camera system checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Function
X
To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 309).
If the PRE-SAFE® Brake is not activated, the
æ symbol appears in the multifunction
display.
This function will issue a warning if:
Rat a speed of around 30 km/h or more, the
distance maintained to the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient for several seconds.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rat a speed of approximately 7 km/h or
higher, you very quickly approach a vehicle
in front or a pedestrian.
An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the · distance warning lamp
lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately to defuse the situation.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
If there is an increased risk of collision, preventive passenger protection measures (PRESAFE®) are activated.
If the risk of collision with the vehicle in front
remains and you do not brake, take evasive
action or accelerate significantly, the vehicle
may perform automatic emergency braking,
up to the point of full brake application. Automatic emergency braking is not performed
until immediately prior to an imminent accident.
You can prevent the intervention of PRESAFE® Brake at any time by:
Rdepressing
the accelerator pedal further
kickdown
Rreleasing the brake pedal
Ractivating
Protection against theft
Ryou
manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle
is no longer a risk of collision
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle
Rthere
STEER CONTROL
General notes
STEER CONTROL is only available in vehicles
without 4MATIC.
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering
wheel in the direction required for vehicle
stabilisation.
This steering support is provided in particular
if:
To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO startfunction or KEYLESS-GO: switch the ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid key has been left
inside the vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake
Rthe vehicle starts to skid
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 74).
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if:
RESP®
is malfunctioning
steering is faulty
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electrical power steering.
Rthe
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X
Protection against theft
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Immobiliser
Ra
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
Rthe
Z
Safety
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
85
Protection against theft
86
Safety
X
To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
or
Priming
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/
Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 181).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
Make sure that:
doors are closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the tow-away protection
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 60 seconds.
X
X
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
X
Rthe
Switching off
X
or
X
i If the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, the Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system automatically sends a
message to the Customer Assistance
Centre. This is done by means of a text
message or a data connection. The emergency call system sends a message or
establishes a data connection provided
that:
Ryou
have subscribed to the
Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system
Rthe Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system has been activated properly
Rthe necessary mobile phone network is
available
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
You can deactivate the tow-away protection
using COMAND Online or Audio 20. You can
find information about deactivating the towaway protection in the separate COMAND
Online or Audio 20 operating instructions.
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Priming
X
Make sure that:
Protection against theft
side windows are closed
sliding sunroof or the panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe sliding sunroof or the panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
87
Rthe
Safety
Rthe
Switching off
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
deactivated.
Deactivating
You can deactivate the interior motion sensor
using COMAND Online or Audio 20. You can
find information about deactivating the interior motion sensor in the separate COMAND
Online or Audio 20 operating instructions.
Z
88
89
Useful information .............................. 90
Key ........................................................ 90
Doors .................................................... 96
Boot .................................................... 101
Side windows .................................... 106
Opening and closing
Sliding sunroof .................................. 110
90
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Key
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor . The doors can
then be opened from the inside after the vehicle has been locked from the outside. The
anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door
is opened from the inside. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 85).
All countries:
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Do not keep the key:
Rwith
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function:
do not keep the key on the parcel shelf or in
the boot. Otherwise, the key may not be
detected, e.g. when starting the engine using
the Start/Stop button.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example:
Rwhen
starting the engine
driving
Rwhen the external door handles are
touched
Rduring convenience closing
Rwhilst
Key functions
When the locator lighting is activated via
COMAND Online or Audio 20, it lights up
when it is dark after the vehicle is unlocked
with the remote control (see the separate
operating instructions).
X To open the boot lid automatically from
outside the vehicle: press and hold button ; until the boot lid opens.
X To open the boot lid automatically from
outside the vehicle: if the key is located in
the immediate vicinity of the vehicle: press
the F button on the key.
You can release the button as soon as the
boot lid starts to close.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key
in the vehicle.
: & Locks the vehicle
; F Opens/closes the boot lid
= % Unlocks the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press button =.
If you do not open the vehicle within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
vehicle is locked again
against theft is reactivated.
Rprotection
X
To lock centrally: press button :.
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
Rthe boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated and deactivated via
COMAND Online or Audio 20 (see the separate operating instructions).
Locking and unlocking centrally
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO functions with the functions of a
conventional key. Unlock the vehicle by using
KEYLESS-GO, for instance, and lock it using
the & button on the key.
The driver's door and the door at which the
handle is used, must both be closed. The key
must be outside the vehicle. When locking or
unlocking with KEYLESS-GO, the distance
between the key and the corresponding door
handle must not be greater than 1 m.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example:
Rwhen
starting the engine
Rwhilst driving
Z
91
Opening and closing
Key
Key
92
the external door handles are
touched
Rduring convenience closing
Opening and closing
Rwhen
KEYLESS-GO start function
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key
in the vehicle.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface : or ;.
Make sure that you do not touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period.
For further information on the convenience
closing feature (Y page 107).
X To unlock the boot lid: pull the boot lid
handle.
X
Deactivating
If you do not intend to use the vehicle for a
longer period of time, you can deactivate KEYLESS-GO. The key will then use very little
power, thereby conserving battery power. For
the purposes of activation/deactivation, the
vehicle must not be nearby.
X To deactivate: press the & button on
the key twice in rapid succession.
The battery check lamp of the key lights up
twice briefly and KEYLESS-GO is deactivated.
X To activate: press any button on the key or
insert the key into the ignition lock.
KEYLESS-GO and all of its associated features are available again.
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means that only the driver's door
and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the
vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel alone.
X To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons simultaneously for about six seconds until the battery indicator lamp flashes twice
(Y page 94).
If the setting of the locking system is changed
within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
X
To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six sec-
Key
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key or KEYLESS-GO, use
the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered. Switch
off the alarm (Y page 85).
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
Removing the emergency key element
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
release catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Further information about:
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 98)
the boot (Y page 105)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 100)
Runlocking
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely into the key until it engages and
Z
Opening and closing
onds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 94).
93
Key
94
Opening and closing
Checking the battery
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 94).
If the key battery is checked within the signal
reception range of the vehicle, pressing the
& or % button:
opens. When doing so, do not hold battery
compartment cover : shut.
X Remove battery compartment cover :.
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X
X
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 93).
X
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery compartment cover :
Insert the front tabs of battery compartment cover : into the housing and then
press to close it.
Insert emergency key element ; into the
key.
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
95
Problems with the key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If this does not work:
X Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
The key is faulty.
Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
You can no longer lock KEYLESS-GO was deactivated.
or unlock the vehicle
X Reactivate KEYLESS-GO (Y page 91).
using KEYLESS-GO.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Check the key battery (Y page 94) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 94).
If this does not work:
X Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
If the vehicle can also not be locked/unlocked using the remote
control function:
X Unlock (Y page 98) or lock (Y page 100) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Opening and closing
You can no longer lock The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
or unlock the vehicle
X Check the key battery (Y page 94) and replace it if necessary
using the key.
(Y page 94).
Opening and closing
96
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
X
The on-board voltage is too low.
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 416).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 418).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The engine cannot be
The vehicle is locked.
started using the Start/ X Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
Stop button. The key is
in the vehicle.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Check the key battery (Y page 94) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 94).
If this does not work:
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
X
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 86).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 85).
All countries:
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
proof locks (Y page 73). The anti-theft alarm
system is triggered if the door is opened from
the inside. Switch off the alarm (Y page 85).
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked. You can only open
the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they
are not secured by the child-proof locks
(Y page 73). If the vehicle has previously been
locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO,
opening a door from the inside will trigger the
anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 85).
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368).
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO, the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open
the doors from inside the vehicle. You can
deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor . The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside. You
can only open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the child-
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and opens.
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock and unlock the vehicle
from the inside. The switches are on the
driver’s door.
Z
97
Opening and closing
Doors
Doors
98
To unlock: press button :.
X To lock: press button ;.
If the front-passenger door is closed, the
vehicle locks.
Opening and closing
X
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
The doors can be opened from the inside. You
can only open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the childproof locks (Y page 73).
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key or with KEYLESS-GO, opening a door
from the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm
system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 85).
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key or with KEYLESSGO, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 86). It
is then possible to operate the doors as follows. The doors can be opened from the
inside. You can only open the rear doors from
inside the vehicle if they are not secured by
the child-proof locks (Y page 73).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will
be observed if the vehicle has been:
Rlocked
with the locking button for the central locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door
which has been opened form the inside is
unlocked if only the driver's door had been
previously unlocked.
Automatic locking feature
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X
If you press one of the two buttons and do not
hear a tone, the relevant setting has already
been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
Therefore, you could be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
Rthe
i You can also activate and deactivate the
automatic locking function via COMAND
Online or Audio 20 (see the separate operating instructions).
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key or KEYLESS-GO, use
the emergency key element.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 93).
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
Doors
Insert the tip of the emergency key element
into the slit on the cover of the driver's door
lock and turn it until the cover is released.
Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
The locking knob pops up and the door
unlocks.
Insert the emergency key element into
opening : in the protective cap.
X Pull and hold the door handle.
X Pull the protective cap on the emergency
key as straight as possible away from the
vehicle until it releases.
X Release the door handle.
X
Opening and closing
X
X
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element clockwise.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X Hold the cover over the lock of the driver's
door with the thicker end towards the front
of the vehicle and press to secure. Then
make sure that the slit of the cover is horizontal.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO:
99
Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
The locking knob pops up and the door
unlocks.
X
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element clockwise.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 93).
X Carefully press the protective cap onto the
lock cylinder until it engages and is seated
firmly. Do not pull the door handle when
doing so.
All vehicles:
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered. Switch
off the alarm (Y page 85).
Z
Doors
100
Opening and closing
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key
element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 97).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 93).
Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Hold the cover over the lock of the driver's
door with the thicker end towards the front
of the vehicle and press to secure. Then
make sure that the slit of the cover is horizontal.
X
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO:
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
X
Insert the tip of the emergency key element
into the slit on the cover of the driver's door
lock and turn it until the cover is released.
Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
The locking knob drops down and the driver's door is locked.
Insert the emergency key element into
opening : in the protective cap.
X Pull and hold the door handle.
X Pull the protective cap on the emergency
key as straight as possible away from the
vehicle until it releases.
X Release the door handle.
X
X
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
The locking knob drops down and the driver's door is locked.
X
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the emergency key element anti-clockwise.
Boot
All vehicles:
If you lock the vehicle as described above, the
fuel filler flap is not locked. The anti-theft
alarm system is not primed.
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions on the boot lid can
be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 476).
i You can limit the opening angle of the
boot lid in COMAND Online or Audio 20
(see the separate operating instructions).
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368).
Obstacle detection with boot lid
reversing feature
Vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature: the boot lid is equipped with automatic
obstacle detection with reversing function. If
a solid object blocks or restricts the boot lid
when automatically opening, this procedure
is stopped. If a solid object blocks or restricts
the boot lid when automatically closing, the
boot lid opens again automatically. The automatic obstacle recognition with reversing
function is only an aid. It is not a substitute for
your attentiveness when opening and closing
the boot lid.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover
the last 8 mm of the closing path
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
the F button on the key, or
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door, or
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid, or
Rpull the boot lid handle
Rpress
Z
Opening and closing
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 93).
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Carefully press the protective cap onto the
lock cylinder until it engages and is seated
firmly. Do not pull the door handle when
doing so.
X
101
Boot
102
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: it is
also possible to stop the closing process by
performing a kicking movement under the
rear bumper.
Opening and closing
Opening/closing from the outside
Opening
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
RPress
the F button on the key.
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door.
RPress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid.
RPull the boot lid handle.
RPress
X
Press the F button on the key.
or
X
Pull handle :.
The boot lid opens.
Closing
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: it is
also possible to stop the closing process by
performing a kicking movement under the
rear bumper.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 476).
Opening
Pull the boot lid down using recess : and
push it closed.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO
(Y page 91).
X
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X If the boot is unlocked, pull the boot lid
handle and release it again immediately.
Boot
Closing
103
! If the key is within the rear detection
range of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for example, could lead to the boot lid
opening unintentionally:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 3 m away
from the vehicle.
General notes
X
Press closing button : on the boot lid.
Vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature and KEYLESS-GO: when the driver's
door is closed you can simultaneously close
the boot lid and lock the vehicle. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the rear detection
range of the vehicle.
X
Press locking button ; in the boot lid.
If KEYLESS-GO detects a key outside the
vehicle, the boot lid closes and the vehicle
is locked.
If KEYLESS-GO detects a key in the boot, the
boot lid opens again after it is closed.
If KEYLESS-GO detects a second key outside
the vehicle, the boot lid remains closed.
With KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE
ACCESS, you can open or close the boot lid or
stop the procedure without using your hands.
This is useful if you have your hands full. To do
this, make a kicking movement under the
bumper with your foot.
Observe the following points:
RCarry
your KEYLESS-GO key about your
person. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in
the rear detection range of the vehicle.
RWhen making the kicking movement, make
sure that you are standing firmly on the
ground and that there is sufficient clearance to the rear of the vehicle. You could
otherwise lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
HANDS-FREE ACCESS
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system. There is a risk of injury. Always
ensure that you only make a leg movement
within the detection range of sensors.
RAlways ensure that you only make a kicking
movement within the detection range of
sensors :.
RStand at least 30 cm away from the rear
area while doing so.
RDo not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement. Oth-
Z
Opening and closing
Rusing
Boot
Opening and closing
104
erwise, the sensors may not function correctly.
RHANDS-FREE ACCESS does not function
when the engine is started.
RIf a KEYLESS-GO key is within the rear
detection range of KEYLESS-GO, HANDSFREE ACCESS could be triggered. The boot
lid could thus be opened or closed unintentionally, for example, if you:
- set down or lift up an object behind the
vehicle
- polish the rear of the vehicle
Do not carry the KEYLESS-GO key about
your person in such situations. This will
prevent the unintentional opening/closing
of the boot.
RDirt caused by road salt around sensors :
may restrict functionality.
RUsing HANDS-FREE ACCESS with a prosthetic leg may restrict functionality.
Operation
To stop the opening or closing procedure:
Rmove
your foot in sensor detection
range : under the bumper, or
Rpull the handle on the outside of the boot lid
or
Rpress the closing button in the boot lid or
Rpress the F button on the key
If the boot lid closing procedure has been
stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will open
If the boot lid opening procedure has been
stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will close
Opening/closing automatically from
the inside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
X
X
To open/close: kick into sensor detection
range : under the bumper with your leg.
You will hear a warning tone while the boot
lid is opening or closing.
If the boot lid does not open after several attempts: wait at least ten seconds
then kick under the bumper once again.
If you hold your foot under the bumper for too
long, the boot lid does not open or close.
Repeat the kicking movement more quickly if
this occurs.
RPress
the F button on the key.
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door.
RPress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid.
RPull the boot lid handle.
RPress
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: it is
also possible to stop the closing process by
performing a kicking movement under the
rear bumper.
Boot
105
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
Opening and closing
Activating the function to lock the boot separately:
Close the boot lid.
Open the glove compartment.
X Push the switch to position :.
If the vehicle is unlocked centrally, the boot
remains locked.
i You can also lock the glove compartment
(Y page 369).
Deactivating the function to lock the boot
separately:
X
X
You can open and close the boot lid from the
driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary
and unlocked.
X To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
X To close: press remote operating switch
for boot lid : until the boot lid is completely closed.
Locking the boot separately
The separate boot locking function is only
available in certain countries.
You can lock the boot separately. If you then
unlock the vehicle centrally, the boot remains
locked and cannot be opened.
X
X
Open the glove compartment.
Push the switch to position ;.
If the vehicle is unlocked centrally, the boot
will also be unlocked.
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key,
KEYLESS-GO or HANDS-FREE ACCESS, use
the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the boot lid, the anti-theft
alarm system will be triggered. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 85).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 93).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
Z
Opening and closing
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 476).
Side windows
Opening and closing
106
G WARNING
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the key with you and lock the vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise from position 1 as far as it will
go to position 2.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to
position 1 and remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 93).
X
When you lock the vehicle (Y page 100), the
boot is also locked.
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
Side window reversing feature
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts a side window from travelling upwards during the automatic closing
process, the side window opens again automatically. During the manual closing process,
the side window only opens again automatically after the corresponding switch is
released. The automatic reversing feature is
only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing a side window.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rwhile
resetting
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing, make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
Side windows
107
Convenience opening feature
:
;
=
?
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation:
press/pull the corresponding switch again.
X
If you press/pull the switch beyond the point
of resistance and release, automatic operation is started in the corresponding direction.
You can stop automatic operation by pressing/pulling again.
You can continue to operate the side windows
after switching off the engine or removing the
key. This function remains active for five
minutes or until you open a front door.
The side windows cannot be operated from
the rear when the override feature for the side
windows is activated (Y page 73).
i Information on opening and closing the
roller sunblinds on the rear side windows
(Y page 378).
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESSGO start function: you can ventilate the vehicle before you start driving.
If the key is in the immediate vicinity to the
vehicle, the convenience opening function is
available.
To do this, the key is used to carry out the
following functions simultaneously:
Runlock
the vehicle
the side windows
Ropen the sliding sunroof or the panorama
sliding sunroof and the roller sunblind
Rswitch on the seat ventilation for the driver's seat
Ropen
Convenience opening feature
Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof or the
panorama sliding sunroof are in the desired
position.
If the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding sunroof are closed, the roller sunblinds
are opened first.
X Press and hold the % button again until
the panorama sliding sunroof is in the
desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
Convenience closing feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is oper-
Z
Opening and closing
General notes
Side windows
108
Opening and closing
ating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESSGO start function: if the key is in the immediate vicinity to the vehicle, the convenience
closing function is available.
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
the side windows
the sliding sunroof or the panorama
sliding sunroof
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof,
you can then close the roller sunblinds.
Notes on the automatic reversing feature for:
Rclose
Rthe
side windows (Y page 106)
Rthe sliding sunroof or the panorama sliding
sunroof (Y page 111)
Using the key
Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof or the
panorama sliding sunroof are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof
are closed.
X
X
X
Vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof: press and hold the & button until
the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding
sunroof close.
To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The driver's door and the door at which the
handle is used, must both be closed. The key
must be outside the vehicle. The gap between
the key and the corresponding door handle
should not be greater than 1 m.
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
sliding sunroof or the panorama sliding
sunroof are fully closed.
Make sure you only touch recessed sensor
surface :.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof
are closed.
X Vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof: touch recessed sensor surface : on
the door handle again until the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding sunroof
close.
X To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
X
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 106).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
Side windows
109
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 106).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly. If
this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
Opening and closing
X
Z
110
Sliding sunroof
Problems with the side windows
Opening and closing
G WARNING
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Sliding sunroof
If somebody becomes trapped:
Important safety notes
Rrelease
Your vehicle may be fitted with a sliding sunroof or a panorama sliding sunroof. In this
section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to
both types of sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
While opening and closing the sliding sunroof,
body parts in close proximity could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the opening and closing procedures.
the switch immediately, or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening or closing procedure will be stopped.
Rduring
G WARNING
If children operate the sliding sunroof they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Sliding sunroof
it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
Resonance noises can occur in addition to the
usual airflow noises when the sliding sunroof
is open. They are caused by minor pressure
fluctuations in the vehicle interior. Change
the position of the sliding sunroof or open a
side window slightly to reduce or eliminate
these noises.
Only for vehicles with panorama sliding
sunroof:
G WARNING
At high speeds the raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers slightly at the rear. This could
trap you or other persons. There is a risk of
injury. Make sure that nobody reaches into
the sweep of the sliding sunroof whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
If somebody becomes trapped, immediately
pull back the sliding sunroof switch. The sliding sunroof lifts during opening.
Rduring
resetting
Rwhen closing the sliding sunroof again man-
ually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The closing process is stopped.
Rduring
Operating the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Sliding sunroof reversing feature
Your vehicle may be fitted with a sliding sunroof or a panorama sliding sunroof. In this
section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to
both types of sliding sunroof.
The sliding sunroof is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the sliding sunroof during the closing
process, the sliding sunroof opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing feature is only an aid and is no substitute for your
attention when closing the sliding roof.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
X
If you press or pull the 3 switch beyond
the point of resistance, automatic operation
is started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing or
pulling again.
The sun protection cover automatically opens
along with the sliding sunroof. You can open
Z
Opening and closing
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof if
111
112
Sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
or close the sun protection cover manually
when the sliding sunroof is raised or closed.
You can continue to operate the sliding sunroof after switching off the engine or removing the key. This function remains active for
five minutes or until the driver's or frontpassenger door is opened.
Rain-closing feature
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the sliding sunroof closes
automatically:
it starts to rain.
extreme outside temperatures.
Rafter six hours.
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply.
The rear of the sliding sunroof is then raised in
order to ventilate the vehicle interior.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed when
being closed by the rain-closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature
is then deactivated.
The sliding sunroof does not close if:
Make sure that the sliding sunroof can be
fully opened and closed again
(Y page 111).
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
X
Operating the panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Rif
Rat
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor,
e.g. because the vehicle is under a bridge.
Rit
Resetting
! If the sliding sunroof still cannot be
opened or closed fully after resetting, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Reset the sliding sunroof if it does not operate
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Raise the sliding sunroof fully at the rear
(Y page 111).
X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another
second.
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
The panorama sliding sunroof can only be
operated when the roller sunblind is open.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
If you press or pull the 3 switch beyond
the point of resistance, automatic operation
is started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing or
pulling again.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is raised at
the rear, it automatically lowers slightly at
higher speeds. The noise level in the vehicle
interior is reduced as a result. At low speeds it
raises again automatically.
You can continue to operate the panorama
sliding sunroof after switching off the engine
or removing the key. This function remains
Sliding sunroof
Rain-closing feature when the engine is
switched off
If the key is in position 0 in the ignition lock or
if it is removed, the panorama sliding sunroof
closes automatically:
Rif
it starts to rain.
Rat extreme outside temperatures.
Rafter six hours.
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply.
The panorama sliding sunroof remains raised
at the rear in order to allow ventilation of the
vehicle interior.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed
when being closed by the rain-closing feature,
it opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is then deactivated.
The panorama sliding sunroof does not close
if:
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor.
If the vehicle, for example, is under a bridge
or in a carport, the field of the sensor may
be covered.
Rit
Rain-closing feature when driving
The raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers at the rear when driving if it starts to rain.
The sliding sunroof is lowered depending on:
Rthe
Rthe
road speed and
intensity of the rain
You can manually cancel the automatic closing procedure. Press or pull the 3 switch
in any direction.
To raise the sliding sunroof again, press the
3 switch in direction :.
The "Rain-closing feature when driving" function is deactivated, until you:
Rpress
or pull the 3 switch in any direction or
Rturn the key to another position in the ignition lock (Y page 181).
Operating the panorama sliding sunroof roller sunblinds
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roller sunblind
parts of the body could be trapped between
the roller sunblind and the frame or sliding
sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
When opening or closing make sure that no
parts of the body are in the sweep of the roller
sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening/closing process is stopped.
Rduring
The roller sunblinds shield the vehicle interior
from sunlight. The front roller sunblind can
only be opened and closed when the sliding
sunroof is closed.
Roller sunblinds reversing feature
The roller sunblinds are equipped with an
automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts the roller blind during the
closing process, the roller blind opens again
automatically. However, the automatic
reversing feature is only an aid, not a substitute for your attention when closing the roller
sunblind.
Z
Opening and closing
active for five minutes or until you open a
front door.
The panorama sliding sunroof cannot be
opened if a roof carrier is fitted. In order to
allow ventilation of the vehicle interior, you
can raise the panorama sliding sunroof. If a
roof carrier approved by Mercedes-Benz
makes contact with the panorama sliding
sunroof, the sunroof will lower slightly but
remain raised at the rear.
113
114
Sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
G WARNING
The reversing feature especially does not
react to soft, light and thin objects, such as
small fingers. This means that the reversing
feature cannot prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of
injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the sweep of the roller sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
If you press or pull the 3 switch beyond
the point of resistance, automatic operation
is started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing or
pulling again.
Resetting the panorama sliding sunroof or the front roller sunblind
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The closing process is stopped.
Rduring
Opening and closing roller sunblinds
Overhead control panel
: To open
; To open
= To close
You can only close the roller sunblinds when
the panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press the 3 switch in direction :.
Both roller sunblinds open, then the sliding
roof is raised.
X Pull the 3 switch in direction ;.
The sunblinds open
X Pull the 3 switch in direction =.
The roller sunblinds close when the panorama sliding roof is closed.
Reset the panorama sliding sunroof or the
front roller sunblind if the panorama sliding
sunroof or the roller sunblinds does not move
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow :
until the panorama sliding sunroof is fully
closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Pull the 3 switch in the direction of
arrow : repeatedly until the front roller
sunblind is closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Make sure that the panorama sliding sunroof (Y page 112) and the front roller sunblind (Y page 114) can be fully opened
again.
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
Sliding sunroof
115
Problems with the sliding sunroof
If you close the sliding sunroof again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the sliding
sunroof closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts
of the body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
the switch in any direction during the automatic opening/closing process
The closing process is stopped.
Rpress
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The sliding sunroof or If the sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed
panorama sliding sun- during closing and reopens again slightly:
roof cannot be closed X Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to
and you cannot see the
the point of resistance until the sliding sunroof or panorama
cause.
sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof is closed with
more force.
If the sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed
again during closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to
the point of resistance until the sliding sunroof or panorama
sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof or panorama sliding sunroof is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
116
117
Useful information ............................ 118
Correct driver's seat position .......... 118
Seats .................................................. 119
Steering wheel .................................. 125
Mirrors ............................................... 127
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory function ............................... 130
118
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Observe the safety guidelines on seat
adjustment (Y page 119).
X Make sure that seat = is correctly adjusted.
Manual and electrical seat adjustment
(Y page 120)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 121)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
X
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag
as possible
are sitting in a normal upright position
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly
Ryou have moved the backrest to an almost
vertical position
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported
Ryou can depress the pedals properly
Ryour legs are not fully extended
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted correctly.
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 125).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted correctly.
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
(Y page 125)
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 126)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou
Ryou
can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
Ryou can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 47).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 49).
Seats
Rfit
snugly across your body
Rbe routed across the middle of your shoulder
Rbe routed across your hips in the pelvic
area
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors so that you
have a good view of the road and traffic
conditions (Y page 128).
X Vehicles with memory function: you can
store the seat, steering wheel, exterior mirror and head-up display settings with the
memory function (Y page 131).
This could cause you to lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Always make sure that the driver's seat is
engaged before starting the engine.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Seats
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no key in the ignition lock.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
Observe the safety notes on "Airbags"
(Y page 51) and "Children in the Vehicle"
(Y page 63).
G WARNING
If the driver's seat is not engaged, it can move
unexpectedly while the vehicle is in motion.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat belt should:
119
120
Seats
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
Adjusting the seats manually and
electrically
Adjusting the front seat
Vehicles without the seating comfort
package
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see "Interior care".
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
: Backrest angle
; Seat height
= Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Vehicles with the seating comfort package
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
i The rear-compartment head restraints
can be removed (Y page 122).
Vehicles without the through-loading feature: the head restraints cannot be
removed from the rear compartment seats.
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i Further related subjects:
RRear
bench seat through-loading feature
(Y page 371)
:
;
=
?
A
Backrest angle
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Seat cushion length
i In vehicles with the seating comfort package, the seat cushion length can only be
adjusted manually.
Seats
Vehicles without the seating comfort
package
X Lift handle = and slide the seat forwards
or rearwards.
X Release lever = again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
Vehicles with the seating comfort package
X Lift handle ? and slide the seat forwards
or rearwards.
X Release lever ? again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
Adjusting the seat cushion length manually
Lift handle A and slide the seat cushion
forwards or backwards.
X Release lever A again.
The seat cushion engages.
i Manual seat cushion length adjustment is
only available in vehicles with the seating
comfort package.
X
Adjusts the seats electrically
A Seat cushion angle
B Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
i Further related subjects:
RYou can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 131).
PRE-SAFE® is triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position (Y page 62).
RIf
Adjusting the head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
General notes
:
;
=
?
Head restraint height
Backrest angle
Seat height
Seat cushion length
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 119).
Do not interchange the head restraints of the
front and rear seats. Otherwise, you will not
be able to adjust the height and angle of the
head restraints to the correct position.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the seat fore-and-aft
121
Seats
122
Adjusting the head restraint height
manually
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for the head restraint adjustment (Y page 121) up or down in the direction of the arrow.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the head restraint fore-andaft position manually
If the head restraint is fully lowered, it is
necessary to press release catch :.
X To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired height.
X
X
To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
Fitting and removing rear head
restraints
This function allows you to adjust the distance between the head restraint and the
back of the head.
X To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards in the direction of the arrow until
it engages in the desired position.
X To move backwards: press and hold
release button :.
X Push the head restraint back.
X Release the release button once the head
restraint is in the desired position.
X Ensure that the head restraint has engaged
properly.
Seats
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
:
;
=
?
To raise the backrest contour
To soften the backrest contour
To lower the backrest contour
To harden the backrest contour
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Activating/deactivating
G WARNING
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches from level
3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
The system automatically switches from level
2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
X
i If drive program E is selected, the power
of the seat heating is reduced.
RManual
transmission (Y page 192)
transmission (Y page 197)
RAutomatic
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Release the rear seat backrest and fold it
slightly forwards (Y page 372).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X Fold back the rear seat backrest until it
engages.
X
123
124
Seats
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
switched off prematurely or cannot be
switched on.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating can be
switched back on manually.
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Activating/deactivating
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
i You can open the side windows and the
sliding sunroof using the "Convenience
opening" feature (Y page 107). The seat
ventilation of the driver's seat automatically switches to the highest level.
i When the vehicle is stationary, the fan
speed can be reduced automatically. This
reduces the noises of the seat ventilation.
Steering wheel
125
Problems with the seat ventilation
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat ventilation has The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical conswitched off premasumers are switched on.
turely or cannot be
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
switched on.
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat ventilation can
be switched back on.
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The electrically adjustable steering wheel can
still be adjusted when there is no key in the
ignition lock.
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Z
126
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
: To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
; To adjust the steering wheel height
i Further related subjects:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 126)
RStoring settings (Y page 131)
ROperating the on-board computer
(Y page 294).
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
Move the steering wheel adjustment lever if
there is a risk of entrapment by the steering
wheel. The adjustment process is stopped.
Press one of the memory function position
buttons. The adjustment process is stopped.
This function is only available on vehicles with
a memory function.
G WARNING
If children activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, they can become trapped, particularly
when unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If you drive off while the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature is making adjustments, you could lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always wait until the adjustment process is
complete before driving off.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate Audio 20/
COMAND Online operating instructions.
Position of the steering wheel and the
driver's seat when the EASY-ENTRY/
EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards and the driver's seat moves backwards if you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
Rwith KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door;
KEYLESS-GO must be in position 1
the key: open the driver's door; the
key must be in position 0 or 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181)
Ropen the driver's door when the ignition is
switched off
Rwith
i The steering wheel only tilts upwards if
the driving position is stored after the seat
or steering wheel has been adjusted
(Y page 131).
Mirrors
The most recent driving position of the steering wheel is stored if:
Rthe
ignition is switched off
Rthe setting is stored using the memory
function (Y page 131)
127
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe
driver's door is closed and you insert
the key into the ignition lock
Ryou close the driver's door when the ignition is switched on
Ryou press the Start/Stop button once on
vehicles with KEYLESS-GO
i The steering wheel only returns to the last
set position if the driving position is stored
after the seat or steering wheel has been
adjusted (Y page 131).
The most recent driving position of the steering wheel is stored if:
Rthe
ignition is switched off
setting is stored using the memory
function (Y page 131)
Rthe
Crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
triggered in an accident, the steering column
will move upwards when the driver's door is
opened or the key is removed from the ignition lock. This makes it easier to exit the vehicle and rescue the occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in Audio 20/COMAND
Online; see the separate Audio 20/COMAND
Online operating instructions.
X
Anti-dazzle mode: pivot anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
it has not already reached the upper steering limiter.
Mirrors
128
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press button ; for the right-hand exterior
mirror or button = for the left-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp lights up in the button
that has been pressed.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button : as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button : up, down, or to
the left or right until you have adjusted the
exterior mirror to the correct position. You
should have a good overview of traffic conditions.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
X
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior mirrors are automatically heated if the
rear window heating is switched on and the
outside temperature is low.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
X
i If you are driving faster than 47 km/h, you
can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the Automatic
mirror-folding function function in the
on-board computer.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Briefly press button :.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the Automatic mirror-folding func‐
tion function is activated in COMAND Online
or Audio 20 (see the separate COMAND
Online or Audio 20 operating instructions),
Mirrors
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out automatically
again as soon as you unlock the vehicle
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position (forwards or backwards), proceed as
follows:
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold button :
until you hear a click and then the mirror
engaging in position (Y page 128).
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 128).
X
Rif
electrolyte comes into contact with skin
or eyes or is swallowed, seek medical attention immediately.
Rimmediately change out of clothing that has
been in contact with electrolyte.
Rif an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the following conditions are
met simultaneously:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not dip if reverse gear is
engaged or if the interior lighting is switched
on.
Rincident
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
Using reverse gear
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G WARNING
Electrolyte may escape if the glass of an automatic anti-dazzle mirror breaks. Electrolyte is
harmful and causes irritation. It must not
come into contact with your skin, eyes, respiratory organs or clothing or be swallowed.
There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with electrolyte,
observe the following:
Rimmediately
rinse off electrolyte from your
skin with water.
Rimmediately and thoroughly rinse electrolyte out of eyes using clean water.
Rif electrolyte is swallowed, immediately
rinse out your mouth thoroughly. Do not
induce vomiting.
: Memory button M
; Adjustment button
= Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
? Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
129
Memory function
130
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press button = for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button ; to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Using the memory button
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M :.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press button = for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Use adjustment button ; to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
X Press memory button M : and one of the
arrows on adjustment button ; within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
X
Calling up a stored parking position setting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side using button =.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
X
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button ? for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory function
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
When the memory function adjusts the seat or
steering wheel, you and other vehicle occupants – particularly children – could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any body
parts in the sweep of the seat or steering
wheel. If somebody becomes trapped, immediately release the memory function position
button. The adjustment process is stopped.
Memory function
Storing settings
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Calling up a stored setting
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the
Rseat
Rsteering wheel
Rexterior mirrors
Rhead-up display
are in the stored position.
i The steering wheel and seat adjustment
procedure is interrupted as soon as you
release the storage position button. The
adjustment of the mirror is still carried out.
X
Rposition
of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Rseat heating: cushion surfaces
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Rposition of the head-up display
Adjust the seat accordingly (Y page 121).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 126) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 128).
X Press memory button M and then press
storage position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
131
132
133
Useful information ............................ 134
Exterior lighting ................................ 134
Interior lighting ................................. 140
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with LED
headlamps) ........................................ 141
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with halogen headlamps) ............................... 142
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers ........................... 145
134
Exterior lighting
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 27).
Exterior lighting
General notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
General notes
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (only vehicles
with Intelligent Light System). This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
ments are fulfilled without switching the
headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam.
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System
Before crossing the border, set the headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam and after
returning back to asymmetrical dipped beam
via the "Dipped-beam headlamps for driving
on the right/left" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 311).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
"extended range foglamps" functions are not
available.
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set by:
Rusing
the light switch
the combination switch
(Y page 137)
Radjusting the headlamp range (vehicles
with halogen headlamps only)
(Y page 136)
Rusing the on-board computer
(Y page 311)
Rusing
Light switch
Operation
Vehicles with halogen or static LED
headlamps
It is not necessary to switch your headlamps
to symmetrical dipped beam when driving in
countries where vehicles are driven on the
opposite side of the road to the country in
which the vehicle is registered. Legal require-
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand side lamps
Exterior lighting
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to Ã.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
Ropen
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day.
When the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on, the green T (side
lamps) and L (dipped-beam headlamps)
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up.
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
Rkey
in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light
Rwith the engine running: depending on the
ambient light conditions, the daytime driving lights or the parking and dipped-beam
headlamps are switched on or off automatically
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
Dipped-beam headlamps
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in position L, the side lamps and
dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of
your vehicle in heavy fog for the following
traffic. Please observe the country-specific
laws on the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
135
Exterior lighting
136
Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that
the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
is not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen
headlamps)
Headlamp range control
g Driver's seat and front-passenger seat
occupied
1 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied
2 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied, boot laden
3 Driver's and front-passenger seats occu-
pied and maximum permissible rear axle
load utilised, e.g. when towing a trailer
The headlamp range control allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps to
suit the vehicle load.
X
X
Start the engine.
Turn the headlamp range control to the
position which corresponds to the load in
your vehicle.
Exterior lighting
Combination switch
Turn signals
137
If Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active, it controls activation and deactivation of the mainbeam headlamps (Y page 139).
Headlamp flasher
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2, or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
Hazard warning lamps
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
Main-beam headlamps
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
X
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
Ran
airbag is deployed or
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 70 km/h and comes to a
standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
The hazard warning lamps continue to operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Rthe
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
138
Exterior lighting
Intelligent Light System
Cornering light function
Lights and windscreen wipers
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" function using the on-board
computer (Y page 311).
Active light function
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the
steering wheel
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a short
time, but is automatically switched off after
no more than three minutes.
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
you are driving. This allows you to recognise
pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on
Motorway mode
Active: if you are driving at a speed above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering
movements for at least 1,000 m or if you are
driving at a speed above 130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation
Extended range foglamps
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus
General notes
With Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus, you can
automatically switch between dipped-beam,
partial main-beam and main-beam headlamps.
Partial main-beam illumination is a form of
illumination whereby the main beam is directed past other road users. Other road users
are kept out of the main-beam. This prevents
glare. If there is a vehicle in front, for example,
the main-beam headlamps illuminate the
areas to its right and left, and the vehicle in
front is illuminated by the dipped-beam headlamps.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it
switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
If the main-beam or partial main-beam headlamps are causing too much reflection from
traffic signs, the lights are automatically dimmed and glare for the driver caused by the
reflections is thus avoided.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus does not recognise road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Plus may not recognise road users who do
have lights, or may recognise them too late. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or will be activated despite the presence of
other road users. There is a risk of an accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Rwho
Z
139
Lights and windscreen wipers
Exterior lighting
Interior lighting
140
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus cannot take
into account road, weather or traffic conditions. Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is only
an aid. You are responsible for adjusting the
vehicle's lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rdirt
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
PLUS on/off
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up when it is dark and the
light sensor activates the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above 25 km/h:
The headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 30 km/h and no other road users
are recognised:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds above 45 km/h
and other road users are recognised:
Partial main-beam is selected automatically. The K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below approximately 40 km/h:
The partial main-beam headlamps are
switched off automatically. If no other road
users are recognised, the main-beam headlamps are switched on.
X
If you are driving at speeds below approximately 25 km/h or the roads are adequately illuminated:
The main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To switch off: move the combination
switch back to its normal position or move
the light switch to another position.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display goes out.
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Certain climatic and physical conditions may
cause moisture to form in the headlamp. This
moisture does not affect the functionality of
the headlamp.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Front overhead control panel
: p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with LED headlamps)
A p Switches the right-hand front read-
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. This delayed switch-off can be
adjusted using COMAND Online or Audio 20
(see the separate operating instructions).
Control panel in the grab handle (rear
compartment)
Manual interior lighting control
? u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
ing lamp on/off
To switch the front interior lighting on/
off: press the c button.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
141
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
: Reading lamp
; p Switches the reading lamp on/off
Interior lighting control
General notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time,
unless the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
The colour, brightness and display lamp for
the ambient lighting may be set using
COMAND Online or Audio 20 (see the separate operating instructions).
Automatic interior lighting control
X
To switch on/off: press the | button.
When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the
overhead control panel.
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X
To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X
Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with LED
headlamps)
The front and rear light clusters of your vehicle are equipped with LED light bulbs. Do not
replace the bulbs yourself. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required.
Lamps are an important aspect of vehicle
safety. You must therefore make sure that
these function correctly at all times. Have the
headlamp setting checked regularly.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
Ropen
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
142
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can replace the following bulbs. The
details for the bulb type can be found in the
legend.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Bulbs, lamps and plug connectors can
become very hot during use. When replacing a
bulb, you could burn yourself on these components. There is a risk of injury.
Allow these components to cool down before
replacing the bulb.
Do not use a bulb that has been dropped or if
its glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou
touch it
Rit is hot
Ryou drop it
Ryou scratch it
Only operate bulbs in enclosed lamps
designed for that purpose. Only fit spare
bulbs of the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service
life of the bulbs. Do not touch the glass tube
with your bare hands. If necessary, clean the
glass tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and
rub it off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation. Do not allow bulbs to come into contact
with liquids.
Replace only the bulbs listed (Y page 142).
Have the bulbs that you cannot replace yourself replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance replacing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Vehicles with halogen headlamps
: Dipped-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
; Main-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
= Turn signal lamp: PWY 24 W
Tail lamp (halogen headlamps)
: Turn signal lamp: P 21 W
; Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
Fitting/removing the cover on the front
wheel arch
Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
Main-beam headlamps
You must remove the cover of the front wheel
housing before you can change the front turn
signal lamp.
To remove: switch off the lights.
Turn the front wheels inwards.
X Turn rotary knob : 180° outwards until it
stops using a suitable object.
Cover ; is released.
X Fold cover ; upwards.
X To fit: insert cover ; into the left, right and
two lower catches.
X Turn rotary knob : 180° inwards until it
stops using a suitable object.
Cover ; is locked.
X
X
Dipped-beam headlamps
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Replacing the front bulbs
143
Replacing bulbs (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
144
Turn signals
You must open the side trim panel in the boot
before you can replace the bulbs in the tail
lamps.
To open: release right or left side trim
panel : at the top and fold it down in the
direction of the arrow.
X To close: insert side panel :.
X
Tail lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 144).
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Remove the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 143).
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise, unlock
it and pull it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 143).
X
X
X
X
Pull out the plug.
Turn wing nut : 90° anti-clockwise and
remove the bulb holder.
Replacing the rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
Turn signal lamp ;: lightly press the bulb
into the bulb holder, turn it anti-clockwise
and remove it from the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and
turn it clockwise.
X Reversing lamp =: remove the bulb from
the bulb holder.
X
Example: right-hand side trim panel
Windscreen wipers
145
Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder.
Insert the bulb holder again.
X Turn wing nut : 90° clockwise.
X Insert the connector.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 144).
X
X
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î to wipe the wind-
screen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or
Å position, the appropriate wiping frequency is automatically set according to the
intensity of the rain. In the Å position, the
rain sensor is more sensitive than in the Ä
position, causing the windscreen wipers to
wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers
146
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
Lights and windscreen wipers
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the windscreen wiper arm without a wiper
blade and it falls onto the windscreen, the
windscreen may be damaged by the force
of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
Moving the wiper blades to the vertical
position
On vehicles without KEYLESS-GO:
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Set the windscreen wipers to position
°.
X When the wiper arms have reached the vertical position, turn the key to position 0 and
remove it from the ignition lock.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
When the wiper arms have reached the vertical position, press the Start/Stop button.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
X
Removing the wiper blades
Hold onto the wiper arm with one hand.
With the other hand, turn wiper blade in
direction of arrow : away from the wiper
arm as far as it will go.
X Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the removal position with
a noticeable click.
X
X
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
Switch off the engine.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
X Set the windscreen wipers to position
°.
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly
until the windscreen wipers start.
X
X
X
Remove the wiper blade in the direction of
arrow ? away from the wiper arm.
Windscreen wipers
147
Fitting the wiper blades
Insert the new wiper blade into the wiper
arm in the direction of arrow :.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the locking position with
a noticeable click.
X Make sure that wiper blade is seated correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
X Remove the protective film of the service
indicator on the tip of the wiper blade.
X
i If the colour of the service indicator
changes from black to yellow, the wiper
blades should be replaced. The duration of
the colour change varies depending on the
terms of use.
Z
148
Windscreen wipers
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Lights and windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windscreen wipers Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windscreen
are jammed.
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
or
X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
fail completely.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The windscreen washer The spray nozzles are misaligned.
fluid from the spray
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist worknozzles no longer hits
shop.
the centre of the windscreen.
149
Useful information ............................ 150
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 150
Operating the climate control system ..................................................... 156
Climate control
Adjusting the air vents ..................... 177
150
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 27).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch
Rswitch
briefly
Rswitch
off climate control only briefly
on air-recirculation mode only
on the cooling with air dehumidification function
Rswitch on the "demist windscreen" function
briefly, if required
Climate control regulates the temperature
and air humidity in the vehicle interior. The
interior filter cleans the air, thus improving
the interior climate.
For vehicles without hybrid drive, the "Cooling
with air dehumidification" function is available when the engine is running. For hybrid
vehicles, the cooling with air dehumidification
function is also available via the electric
refrigerant compressor when the engine is
not running. Optimum climate control is only
achieved with the side windows and roof
closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 166).
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 107).
This will speed up the cooling process and
the desired interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and soot and completely filters out pollen. It also reduces gaseous pollutants and odours. A clogged filter reduces
the amount of air supplied to the vehicle
interior. For this reason, you should always
observe the interval for replacing the filter,
which is specified in the Service Booklet. As
this depends on environmental conditions,
e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
i It is possible that the blower may be activated automatically 60 minutes after the
key has been removed depending on various factors, e.g. the outside temperature.
The vehicle is then ventilated for
30 minutes to dry the automatic climate
control.
Overview of climate control systems
151
Vehicles with auxiliary heating
: To set the temperature, left (Y page 160)
; To set the air distribution (Y page 161)
= To set the airflow (Y page 162)
To switch the climate control off (Y page 156)
? To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 159)
A To demist the windscreen (Y page 163)
B To call up the Audio 20/COMAND Online climate control menu; see the separate operating
C
D
E
F
G
instructions
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 166)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 164)
To switch the auxiliary heating on/off (Y page 172)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode manually (Y page 165)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 157)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 160)
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
Climate control
152
Overview of climate control systems
Vehicles without auxiliary heating
: To set the temperature, left (Y page 160)
; To set the air distribution (Y page 161)
= To set the airflow (Y page 162)
To switch the climate control off (Y page 156)
? To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 159)
A To demist the windscreen (Y page 163)
B To call up the Audio 20/COMAND Online climate control menu; see the separate operating
C
D
E
F
G
instructions
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 164)
To activate/deactivate synchronisation (Y page 162)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode manually (Y page 165)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 157)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 160)
Information on using THERMATIC
automatic climate control
THERMATIC automatic climate control
The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of THERMATIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the Ã
rocker switch. The indicator lamp above
the à rocker switch lights up. The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is
not activated automatically in automatic
mode. If necessary, activate this function
(Y page 157).
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the windscreen demisting function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
Overview of climate control systems
153
AGILITY SELECT switch
You can choose between various drive programs with the AGILITY SELECT switch.
RManual
transmission (Y page 191)
transmission (Y page 197)
If you have selected drive program E, the climate control switches to Eco mode.
In Eco mode:
RAutomatic
Rthe cooling output is reduced when cooling
is deactivated and heat output is reduced
as a result
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
If you have selected drive program C, S or S+
the climate control switches to Comfort
mode. The current climate control settings
are maintained in Comfort mode.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 187).
Hybrid vehicles
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is available when the vehicle is operational
and the READY indicator is lit (Y page 276).
If the internal combustion engine has been
shut off automatically, the set interior temperature will be maintained for a certain
period of time.
Climate control
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster
154
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (3-zone)
Vehicles with auxiliary heating
Front control panel
: To set the temperature, left (Y page 160)
; To set the air distribution, left (Y page 161)
= To set the airflow (Y page 162)
To switch the climate control off (Y page 156)
? To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 159)
A To demist the windscreen (Y page 163)
B To call up the Audio 20/COMAND Online climate control menu; see the separate operating
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
instructions
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 166)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 164)
To switch the auxiliary heating on/off (Y page 172)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode manually (Y page 165)
To set the air distribution, right (Y page 161)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 160)
Rear control panel
To set the temperature (Y page 160)
Display
To set the airflow (Y page 162)
Vehicles without auxiliary heating
Front control panel
: To set the temperature, left (Y page 160)
; To set the air distribution, left (Y page 161)
= To set the airflow (Y page 162)
To switch the climate control off (Y page 156)
? To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 159)
A To demist the windscreen (Y page 163)
B To call up the Audio 20/COMAND Online climate control menu; see the separate operating
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
instructions
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 166)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 164)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 157)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode manually (Y page 165)
To set the air distribution, right (Y page 161)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 160)
Rear control panel
To set the temperature (Y page 160)
Display
To set the airflow (Y page 162)
Information on using THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the Ã
rocker switch. The indicator lamp above
the à rocker switch lights up. The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is
not activated automatically in automatic
155
Climate control
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
156
Operating the climate control system
mode. If necessary, activate this function
(Y page 157).
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the windscreen demisting function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when
the ignition is switched off. The residual
heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off. The
residual heat function is deactivated when
the ignition is switched on.
AGILITY SELECT switch
You can choose between various drive programs with the AGILITY SELECT switch.
RManual
transmission (Y page 191)
transmission (Y page 197)
If you have selected drive program E, the climate control switches to Eco mode.
In Eco mode:
RAutomatic
Rthe cooling output is reduced when cooling
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster
is deactivated and heat output is reduced
as a result
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
If you have selected drive program C, S or S+
the climate control switches to Comfort
mode. The current climate control settings
are maintained in Comfort mode.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 187).
Hybrid vehicles
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is available when the vehicle is operational
and the READY indicator is lit (Y page 276).
If the internal combustion engine has been
shut off automatically, the set interior temperature will be maintained for a certain
period of time.
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could mist up.
Therefore, only switch off climate control
briefly.
Switch on climate control primarily using the
à rocker switch (Y page 159).
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To switch on: press the t/!
rocker switch up or down.
The Audio 20/COMAND Online climate
control menu opens.
X Activate the climate control using the airconditioning function bar; see the separate
Audio 20/COMAND Online operating
instructions.
or
X Set the airflow to level 1 or higher using the
H button.
X
Operating the climate control system
Activating/deactivating the cooling
with air dehumidification function
General notes
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function only briefly.
For vehicles without hybrid drive, the "Cooling
with air dehumidification" function is available when the engine is running. For hybrid
vehicles, the cooling with air dehumidification
function is also available via the electric
refrigerant compressor when the engine is
not running. The air inside the vehicle is
cooled and dehumidified according to the
temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating
THERMATIC automatic climate control
X To activate: press the ¿ rocker switch
up or down.
The indicator lamp above the rocker switch
lights up.
or
X Activate the cooling with air dehumidification function via Audio 20/COMAND
Online (see the separate operating instructions).
X To deactivate: press the ¿ rocker
switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the rocker switch
goes out.
or
X Deactivate the cooling with air dehumidification function via Audio 20/COMAND
Online (see the separate operating instructions).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control without auxiliary heating
X To activate: press the ¿ rocker switch
up or down.
The indicator lamp above the rocker switch
lights up.
or
X Activate the cooling with air dehumidification function via Audio 20/COMAND
Online (see the separate operating instructions).
X To deactivate: press the ¿ rocker
switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the rocker switch
goes out.
or
X Deactivate the cooling with air dehumidification function via Audio 20/COMAND
Online (see the separate operating instructions).
Climate control
To switch off: press the t/!
rocker switch up or down.
The Audio 20/COMAND Online climate
control menu opens.
X Deactivate the climate control using the
air-conditioning function bar; see the separate Audio 20/COMAND Online operating
instructions.
or
X Set the airflow to level 0 using the H
rocker switch.
X
157
158
Operating the climate control system
Climate control
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control with auxiliary heating
You can activate or deactivate the cooling
with air dehumidification function using
Audio 20/COMAND Online; see the separate
operating instructions.
Operating the climate control system
159
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
THERMOTRONIC
with auxiliary heating: cooling with air
dehumidification can
no longer be switched
on using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see
the separate operating
instructions.
The cooling with air dehumidification function has been deactivated due to a malfunction.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
THERMATIC/
The cooling with air dehumidification function has been deactivaTHERMOTRONIC
ted due to a malfunction.
without auxiliary
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
heating: the indicator
lamp in the ¿ button flashes three times
or remains off. The
cooling with air dehumidification function
can also no longer be
activated using Audio
20/COMAND Online
(see the separate operating instructions).
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. The "Cooling with air
dehumidification" function must be activated
manually in automatic mode. If necessary,
"Cooling with air dehumidification" can also
be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehi-
cle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only switch off cooling with air dehumidification for a short period.
Climate control
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Operating the climate control system
160
Automatic control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Set the desired temperature using the
w rocker switch on the front control
unit.
or
X Set the desired temperature using
Audio 20/COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X To activate: press the à rocker switch
up or down.
The indicator lamp above the à rocker
switch lights up.
X To switch to manual operation: press the
H rocker switch up or down.
or
X Set the airflow using Audio 20/COMAND
Online; see the separate operating instructions.
or
X Press the upper or lower section of the
_ rocker switch.
or
X Set the air distribution using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
The indicator lamp above the à rocker
switch goes out.
Climate control
X
In automatic mode, if you adjust the airflow or
air distribution manually, the indicator lamp
above the à rocker switch goes out. The
function which has not been changed manually, however, continues to be controlled
automatically. When the manually set function switches back to automatic mode, the
indicator lamp above the à rocker switch
lights up again.
In automatic mode you can select the following airflow settings for the driver's and frontpassenger areas:
FOCUS
high airflow that is set slightly
cooler
MEDIUM medium airflow, standard setting
DIFFUSE low airflow that is set slightly
warmer and with less of a draught
X
To set: set the climate mode using Audio
20/COMAND Online (see separate operating instructions).
Setting the temperature
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the w rocker switch.
or
X Set the temperature using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
General notes
Setting the climate mode
This function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control zones
Operating the climate control system
Setting the temperature in the front compartment using the front control panel
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the w rocker switch.
or
X Set the temperature using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
Setting the temperature in the rear compartment using the front control panel
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Set the temperature with the w rocker
switch on the front control panel.
or
X Set the temperature using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X Press the upper or lower section of
the ! rocker switch.
The climate control menu in Audio 20/
COMAND Online opens.
X Select the synchronisation function; see
separate Audio 20/COMAND Online operating instructions.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger side
and the rear compartment.
Setting the temperature in the rear compartment using the rear control panel
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the w rocker switch on
the rear control panel (Y page 154).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
The set temperature appears on the rearcompartment display.
Setting the air distribution
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister vents, the centre and side air vents
as well as the footwell air vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister vents
W Sets the air distribution to automatic
Setting
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control:
you can set the air distribution separately for
the driver's and front-passenger side.
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 181).
X Press the _ button up or down.
The various air distribution settings appear
in Audio 20/COMAND Online.
Climate control
You can select different temperature settings
for the driver's and front-passenger sides as
well as for the rear compartment.
161
Operating the climate control system
162
X
Press and hold the _ button upwards
until the desired position is reached.
or
X
Set the air distribution using Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Setting the airflow
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the H rocker switch.
or
X Set the airflow using Audio 20/COMAND
Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Climate control
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Setting the front-compartment airflow
You can set the airflow separately for the
front and rear compartment.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the H rocker switch.
or
X Set the airflow using Audio 20/COMAND
Online; see the separate operating instructions.
Setting the rear compartment airflow
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press the upper or lower section of
the ! rocker switch.
The Audio 20/COMAND Online climate
control menu opens.
X Select the synchronisation function in the
climate control menu; see separate
Audio 20/COMAND Online operating
instructions.
The airflow setting for the front area is
adopted for the rear compartment.
Setting the rear compartment airflow
using the rear control panel
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To increase/reduce: press the upper or
lower section of the K/I rocker
switch on the rear control panel.
The selected airflow level is shown in the
rear-compartment display.
Activating/deactivating the synchronisation function
General notes
Climate control can be set centrally using the
synchronisation function. The temperature
setting is adopted for the front-passenger
side. For THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control, the temperature setting is adopted
for the front-passenger side and rear compartment.
Activating/deactivating
THERMATIC automatic climate control
without auxiliary heating
X Press the 0 rocker switch up or down.
The indicator lamp in the 0 rocker
switch lights up or goes out.
or
X Activate/deactivate the synchronisation
function using Audio 20/COMAND Online;
see the separate operating instructions).
The synchronisation function deactivates if
the settings for the front-passenger side are
changed.
Operating the climate control system
The synchronisation function deactivates if
the settings for the front-passenger side are
changed.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
X Activate/deactivate the synchronisation
function using Audio 20/COMAND Online;
see the separate operating instructions).
The synchronisation function is deactivated:
Rif
the settings for the front-passenger side
are changed
Rif the settings for the rear compartment are
changed
Rair
distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
i If necessary, the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is activated. In this
case, the indicator lamp above the
¿ button remains switched off.
X To deactivate: press the ¬ rocker
switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the ¬ rocker
switch goes out. The previous settings are
reactivated. Air-recirculation mode
remains deactivated.
or
X Press the top or bottom section of the Ã
rocker switch.
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Demisting the windscreen
X
General notes
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the front side windows.
Switch off the windscreen demisting function
as soon as the windscreen is clear again.
Activating/deactivating the windscreen demisting function
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To activate: press the ¬ rocker switch
on the front control unit up or down.
The indicator lamp above the ¬ rocker
switch lights up. The current climate control settings are deactivated.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
X
Rhigh
airflow
Rhigh temperature
Activate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function with the ¿ rocker
switch.
or
Activate the cooling with air dehumidification function via Audio 20/COMAND
Online; see the separate operating instructions.
For THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control with auxiliary heating, the "Cooling
with air dehumidification" function can only
be activated using Audio 20/COMAND
Online.
X Switch on automatic mode using the Ã
rocker switch.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the windscreen demisting function using
the ¬ rocker switch.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Climate control
THERMATIC automatic climate control
with auxiliary heating
X Activate/deactivate the synchronisation
function using Audio 20/COMAND Online;
see the separate operating instructions).
163
Operating the climate control system
164
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Switch on automatic mode using the Ã
rocker switch.
i If you clean the windows regularly, they
do not mist up so quickly.
X
X
Rear window heating
Climate control
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press the ¤ rocker switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the ¤ rocker
switch lights up or goes out.
X
Operating the climate control system
165
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot
be activated.
The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
lamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating can be activated again.
General notes
You can also temporarily deactivate the flow
of fresh air manually if unpleasant odours are
entering the vehicle from outside. The air
already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you switch on air-recirculation mode, the
windows can mist up more quickly, in particular at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
misting up.
X
To deactivate: press the g rocker
switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch goes out.
Air-recirculation mode is deactivated automatically:
Rafter approximately five minutes at outside
temperatures below approximately 5 †
approximately five minutes if cooling
with air dehumidification is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside
temperatures above approximately 5 † if
the cooling with air dehumidification function is activated
Rafter
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To activate: press the g rocker switch
up or down.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch lights up.
X
Air-recirculation mode switches on automatically:
Rat
high outside temperatures
Rat high levels of pollution (THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control only)
Rin a tunnel (vehicles with a navigation system only)
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch is not lit when automatic air-recirculation mode is activated. Outside air is added
after about 30 minutes.
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
Z
Climate control
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
Operating the climate control system
166
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, press the W switch
immediately to open/close the side window
in the door. The side window stops. To continue closing the side window, pull on the
W switch.
Convenience closing feature (vehicles
with a sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof): press and hold the g
rocker switch up or down until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof start to close automatically.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch lights up. Air-recirculation mode is
activated.
X Convenience closing feature (vehicles
without a sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof): press and hold the g
rocker switch up or down until the side windows start to close automatically.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch lights up. Air-recirculation mode is
activated.
If you open the side windows or the sliding
sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof manually after closing them with the convenience closing feature, they will remain in this
position when opened using the convenience opening feature.
Climate control
X
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
Press the W button for opening/closing
the side windows.
The side windows stop.
X To then open the side window, press the
W button again.
X Only vehicles with sliding sunroof/
panorama sliding sunroof: press the
X
3 switch to open/close the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof.
The sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof stops.
X To then open the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof, pull back on the 3
button.
Notes on the automatic reversing feature for:
Rthe
side windows (Y page 106)
sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof (Y page 111)
X Convenience opening feature (vehicles
with a sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof): press and hold the g
rocker switch up or down until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof start to open automatically.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch goes out. Air-recirculation mode is
deactivated.
X Convenience opening feature (vehicles
without a sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof): press and hold the g
rocker switch up or down until the side windows start to open automatically.
The indicator lamp above the g rocker
switch goes out. Air-recirculation mode is
deactivated.
Rthe
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
General notes
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control and THERMATIC automatic climate control with auxiliary heating.
Once the engine is switched off, it is possible
to make use of the residual heat of the engine
to continue heating or ventilating the front
compartment of the vehicle for approximately
30 minutes. The heating or ventilation time
depends on the set interior temperature.
Operating the climate control system
Activating/deactivating
tally responsible recycling
system.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it (Y page 181).
X To activate: press the ! rocker switch
up or down.
The indicator lamp above the ! rocker
switch lights up.
X
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen the auxiliary heating is switched on
Perfume atomiser
Operating the perfume atomiser
G WARNING
If children open the perfume vial, they could
drink the perfume or it could come into contact with their eyes. There is a risk of injury. Do
not leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
If the perfume liquid has been drunk, consult
a doctor. If perfume comes into contact with
your eyes or skin, rinse the eyes with clean
water. If you continue to experience difficulties, consult a doctor.
H Environmental note
Full perfume vials must not
be disposed of with household rubbish. They must be
collected separately and disposed of in an environmen-
: Perfume lid
; Perfume vial
The perfume atomiser helps to improve driving comfort.
Using Audio 20/COMAND Online, you can:
Rswitch
the perfume atomiser on/off (see
separate Audio 20/COMAND Online operating instructions)
Rregulate the perfume intensity (see the separate Audio 20/COMAND Online operating
instructions)
The following conditions can affect your perception of the perfume intensity:
Roperating
mode of the automatic climate
control
Rinterior temperature
Rtime of year/day
Rair humidity
Rphysiological condition of occupants, e.g.
fatigue or hunger
The perfume atomiser can only be operated
when the automatic climate control is
switched on and is only active when the glove
compartment is closed.
The perfume atomiser is provided with a prefilled perfume vial. You can also choose from
Z
Climate control
Dispose of full perfume vials
in an environmentally
responsible manner and
take them to a special waste
collection point.
The blower will run at a low speed regardless
of the airflow setting.
If you activate the residual heat function at
high temperatures, only the ventilation will be
activated. The blower runs at medium speed.
X To deactivate: press the ! rocker
switch up or down.
The indicator lamp above the ! rocker
switch goes out.
Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rwhen
167
Operating the climate control system
168
a variety of filled perfume vials and an empty
vial which you can fill yourself.
If you refill an empty perfume vial, observe the
separate information sheet attached to the
vial.
! If you do not use genuine Mercedes-Benz
Climate control
interior perfumes, observe the manufacturers' safety notices on the perfume packaging.
Do not refill the pre-filled perfume vial when it
is empty. Dispose of the used vial after use.
X To insert the perfume vial: open the glove
compartment (Y page 369).
X Slide the perfume vial into the holder as far
as it will go.
X To remove the perfume vial: pull out the
perfume vial.
To refill the perfume vial: unscrew the lid
of the empty perfume vial to refill it yourself.
X Refill the vial with a maximum of 15 ml of
the desired liquid perfume.
X Screw the lid back on to the vial.
X
! Only refill the vial when you are outside
the vehicle. Otherwise, liquid perfume
could drip into the interior and contaminate
it.
Always refill the empty refillable vial with the
same perfume. Otherwise, you might not achieve optimum results from the perfume atomiser.
Operating the climate control system
169
Problems with the perfume atomiser
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The perfume atomiser is faulty.
Have the perfume atomiser checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X
Ionisation
Ionisation is used to purify and freshen the air
in the vehicle interior, which is conducive to a
pleasant climate.
The ionisation of the interior air is odourless
and cannot, directly, be perceived in the vehicle interior.
You can switch ionisation on/off using Audio
20/COMAND Online (see the separate operating instructions).
Ionisation can only be operated when the
automatic climate control is switched on. The
side air vent on the driver's side must be
open.
Pre-entry climate control
General notes
The pre-entry climate control function is only
available for hybrid vehicles.
Before getting in, the driver's seat area can be
briefly warmed or ventilated in advance and
the air from the air vents can be pre-cooled.
The high-voltage battery must be sufficiently
charged before the pre-entry climate control
can be activated.
When the vehicle is pre-cooled, the following
functions are activated:
Rautomatic
climate control
Rblower
Rseat ventilation
If the vehicle is preheated, the seat heating is
activated.
If you have switched on the perfume atomiser
or ionisation using Audio 20/COMAND
Online, these will be activated together with
the pre-entry climate control.
Switching on the perfume atomiser/ionisation (see the separate Audio 20/COMAND
Online operating instructions).
Activating/deactivating the pre-entry
climate control
Before the pre-entry climate control can be
activated, you must activate the function via
Audio 20/COMAND Online (see separate
operating instructions).
Z
Climate control
The vehicle interior is
The perfume vial has not been pushed into the holder as far as it
not perfumed although will go.
the perfume atomiser is X Slide the perfume vial into the holder as far as it will go.
activated.
The perfume vial is not adequately filled.
X Pre-filled vials: dispose of the empty vial.
X Use a new pre-filled vial.
X Refillable vials: refill the vial with a maximum of 15 ml of the
same perfume.
Operating the climate control system
170
X
To activate pre-entry climate control:
unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The air-conditioning functions are activated
for up to 120 seconds for preheating and
for up to 60 seconds for pre-cooling.
Climate control
The pre-entry climate control switches off
automatically when the engine is started.
Seat heating (heating), seat ventilation (ventilation), perfume atomiser and ionisation
remain switched on after starting the engine.
Operating the climate control system
171
Problems with the pre-entry climate control
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The pre-entry climate
control cannot be
switched on or has
switched itself off.
The charge status of the high-voltage battery is under the specified
minimum charge status.
X Start the engine when the vehicle is at a standstill.
The internal combustion engine drives the electric motor. The
electric motor is operating as an alternator. The high-voltage
battery is charging.
The pre-entry climate control was started more than twice when
the engine was switched off.
X Switch on the engine and let it run for more than ten seconds.
X Try again to switch the pre-entry climate control on.
The difference between the interior temperature and the desired
temperature is too small.
X Increase the difference between the interior temperature and
the desired temperature.
Remote activation of heating and ventilation system
General notes
Remote activation is only available on vehicles with the BlueEFFICIENCY package.
The driver's and front-passenger seat areas
can also be heated or ventilated when the
engine is switched off.
The starter battery must be sufficiently
charged before remote activation can be
switched on.
When the vehicle is heated, the following
functions are activated:
Rseat
heating
window heating
Rexterior mirror heating
When the vehicle is ventilated, the following
functions are activated:
Rrear
If you have activated ionisation using Audio
20/COMAND Online (see separate operating
instructions), it is activated together with the
remote activation function.
Activating/deactivating the remote
activation function
X
To switch on remote activation: push the
climate control symbol button on the key.
The air-conditioning functions are switched
on, for up to 10 minutes for heating and up
to 120 minutes for ventilation.
Remote activation switches off automatically
if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on, or
engine is started
Seat heating (heating), seat ventilation (ventilation) and ionisation remain switched on
after starting the engine.
Rthe
Rblower
Rseat
ventilation
Z
Climate control
Further information on charging the high-voltage battery
(Y page 416).
172
Operating the climate control system
Problems with remote activation
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Remote activation can- Remote activation was started more than three times when the
not be switched on or engine was switched off.
has switched itself off. X Switch on the engine and let it run for more than ten seconds.
X Try again to switch remote activation on.
Climate control
The starter battery is not sufficiently charged.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Try again to switch remote activation on.
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
Rthe
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
The auxiliary heating is fitted under the front
wing on the right-hand side of the vehicle. The
emissions outlet is found behind the front
wheel on the right hand side of the vehicle.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly once
a month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature. This
occurs without using the heat of the running
engine. The auxiliary heating is operated
directly using the vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the tank content must be at least at
reserve fuel level to ensure that the auxiliary
heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the aux-
Operating the climate control system
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
rocker switch
The colours of the indicator lamps in the
rocker switch have the following meanings:
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Set the desired temperature using the
w rocker switch on the front control
unit.
or
X Set the desired temperature using
Audio 20/COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X
If you do not alter the temperature before
switching on the auxiliary heating, the last
temperature setting will be adopted.
Auxiliary heating or ventilation can also be
switched on if the manually set climate control is activated. Optimum comfort can be
attained when the system is set to automatic
mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
You can activate or deactivate the auxiliary
heating/ventilation:
Rusing
the rocker switch on the centre console (Y page 173)
Rusing the remote control (Y page 173)
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected:
Rusing
the remote control (Y page 173)
Audio 20/COMAND Online; see the
separate operating instructions
Rusing
To switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation on: press rocker switch : up or down.
The red or the blue indicator lamp above
rocker switch : lights up.
X To set the temperature: switch on auxiliary heating/ventilation.
Audio 20/COMAND Online is activated for
approximately one minute.
X Set the desired temperature using
Audio 20/COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X To switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation off: press rocker switch : up or
down.
The red or the blue indicator lamp above
rocker switch : goes out.
X
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
General notes
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For more information, please
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Climate control
iliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off when the
engine is switched off. The auxiliary ventilation is not active if the engine is running.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation switches off
automatically after 30 minutes. This time limit
can be altered. To do this, visit a qualified
specialist workshop.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
173
174
Operating the climate control system
Store the remote control for the auxiliary
heating so that the auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on unintentionally. In particular,
ensure that the remote control for the auxiliary heating is kept out of the reach of children.
The remote control has a range of approximately 300 metres. This range is reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Climate control
Rsolid
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
If the remote control battery is low, the battery symbol on the left of the display is shown
as empty. Replace the remote control battery
and observe the important safety notes when
doing so (Y page 175).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off
To switch on: press and hold the u
button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To switch off: press and hold the ^
button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Briefly press the u button.
The following messages may appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
Remote control
: Display
; u Switches on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation/checks status
= . Sets the departure time
? ^ Switches off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , Sets the departure time
Operating the climate control system
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
activated. The number in
the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating. If the vehicle is
not started after this
time, the running time is
increased by five
minutes.
If the engine has not yet reached operating
temperature when it is started, the auxiliary
heating running time is increased. The auxiliary heating continues to run until the operating temperature is reached. If this is the case,
the y symbol appears in the remote control display and the running time is zero
minutes.
Setting the departure time
Make sure that the time set in the vehicle is
correct before setting the departure time (see
separate operating instructions). Otherwise,
the auxiliary heating may switch on at the
wrong time and at an unsuitable location.
When setting the departure time, also
observe the important safety notes
(Y page 172).
Briefly press the u button.
Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
X
X
X
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating the set departure time
X Briefly press the u button.
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol, the departure time and,
depending on the selected departure time,
the letter A, B or C appear in the display.
Deactivating the set departure time
Briefly press the u button.
X Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Replacing the remote control battery
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Z
Climate control
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently activated. The
number in the display
shows the remaining
time (in minutes) for the
auxiliary ventilation. If
the vehicle is not started
after this time, the running time is increased by
five minutes.
175
176
Operating the climate control system
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
Climate control
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Replacing the battery
If the battery needs to be replaced, the battery symbol on the left of the display is shown
as empty. A CR2450 lithium battery is
required when replacing the battery.
X Press a pointed object into recess :.
X Slide battery cover ; backwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove old battery =.
X Insert the new battery with the lettering
facing upwards.
Slide battery cover ; in the opposite direction to the arrow on the remote control until
it engages.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
X
Adjusting the air vents
177
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
FAIL
¨
FAIL
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle is
faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The starter battery is not sufficiently charged.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The fuel tank content is below the reserve fuel level.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
FAIL
¯
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The auxiliary heating is faulty.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Adjusting the air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior
Z
Climate control
Display messages
Adjusting the air vents
178
Adjusting the centre air vents
To open/close: turn thumbwheel ?, A
or B to the left or right as far as it will go.
X To adjust the air direction: hold centre air
vent :, ; or = by thumbwheel ?, A or
B and move it up or down or to the left or
right.
Vehicles with THERMATIC automatic climate control
Climate control
X
Adjusting the side air vents
Vehicles with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
: Rear-compartment air vent, left
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
= Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
? Rear control panel
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = to the
left or right as far as it will go.
X To adjust the air direction: hold rear air
vent : or ; by the middle fin and move up
or down or to the left or right.
X
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent, left
= Thumbwheel for left side air vent
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = to the
left or right as far as it will go.
X To adjust the air direction: hold side air
vent ; by thumbwheel = and move it up
or down or to the left or right.
X
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Rear air vents are not available in all vehicles.
179
Useful information ............................ 180
Running-in notes ............................... 180
Manual transmission ........................ 190
Automatic transmission ................... 193
Refuelling ........................................... 200
Parking ............................................... 207
Driving tips ........................................ 211
Driving systems ................................ 216
Hybrid operation ............................... 269
Towing a trailer ................................. 283
Driving and parking
Driving ............................................... 180
180
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end
of this teach-in procedure.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
The first 1,500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying road speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RWhen changing gears manually, change up
in good time, before the rev counter needle
reaches Ô of the way to the red area of the
rev counter.
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RVehicles with automatic transmission: try
to avoid depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
After 1,500 km, you may gradually accelerate
the vehicle to full road and engine speeds.
You should also observe these notes on running-in if the engine or parts of the drive train
on your vehicle have been replaced.
Always observe the applicable speed limit.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Rshoes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
Driving
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
Rlose its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
Hybrid vehicles: observe the safety instructions for hybrid vehicles (Y page 269).
Key positions
Key
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 Starting the engine
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on
The engine cannot be started.
Vehicles with AIRPANEL: you can open the
shutters in the radiator trim by turning the key
to position 2 in the ignition lock. After approximately 120 seconds the shutters open automatically. Further information on opening and
cleaning the shutters (Y page 400).
Start/Stop button
General notes
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example, when starting
the engine.
To start the vehicle without actively using the
key:
Rthe
Start/Stop button must be inserted in
the ignition lock
Rthe key must be in the vehicle
Rthe vehicle must not be locked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO (Y page 91)
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
Do not keep the key:
Rwith
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Z
Driving and parking
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
181
182
Driving
If you lock the vehicle with the key's remote
control or with KEYLESS-GO, after a short
time:
Driving and parking
Ryou will not be able to switch on the ignition
with the Start/Stop button
Ryou will not be able to start the engine with
the Start/Stop button until the vehicle is
unlocked again
If you lock the vehicle centrally using the button on the front door (Y page 97), you can
continue to start the engine with the Start/
Stop button.
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding the
Start/Stop button for three seconds. This
function operates independently of the ECO
start/stop automatic engine switch-off function.
To switch on the ignition: press Start/
Stop button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
The power supply is switched off again if:
X
Rthe
driver's door is opened and
Ryou press Start/Stop button : once when
in this position
Removing the Start/Stop button
Key positions with the Start/Stop button
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
X To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can
now activate the windscreen wipers, for
example.
The power supply is switched off again if:
Rthe
driver's door is opened and
Ryou press Start/Stop button : twice when
in this position
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
It is only possible to switch between Start/
Stop button mode and key operation when
the transmission is in position P.
When you insert Start/Stop button : into
ignition lock ;, the system needs approximately two seconds recognition time. You
can then use Start/Stop button :.
X Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
General notes
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the catalytic
converter is preheated for up to 30 seconds
after a cold start. The sound of the engine may
change during this time.
Manual transmission
You can only start the engine when the clutch
pedal is fully depressed.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral N.
Automatic transmission
X
Shift the transmission to position P
(Y page 193).
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P
(Y page 195).
You can also start the engine when the transmission is in position N.
Starting procedure with the key
To start the engine using the key instead of
the Start/Stop button, pull the Start/Stop
button out of the ignition lock.
X To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 181)
and release it as soon as the engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 181).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the % preglow indicator lamp
goes out, turn the key to position 3
(Y page 181) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
You can start the engine without preglow if
the engine is warm.
! Do not depress the accelerator when
starting the engine.
Z
Driving and parking
Starting the engine
183
Driving
184
If the engine will not start:
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Reinsert the key into the ignition lock after
a short waiting period.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
The indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up (Y page 351).
X Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181) and release it as soon as
the engine is running.
Driving and parking
X
Starting procedure with the Start/Stop
button
The Start/Stop button is only available on
vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESSGO start function.
The Start/Stop button can be used to start
the vehicle manually without inserting the key
into the ignition lock. The key must be in the
vehicle and the Start/Stop button must be
inserted in the ignition lock. This mode for
starting the engine operates independently of
the ECO start/stop automatic engine start
function.
You can start the engine if a valid key is in the
vehicle. Switch off the engine and always take
the key with you when leaving the vehicle,
even if you only leave it for a short time. Pay
attention to the important safety notes.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X To start a petrol engine: press the Start/
Stop button once (Y page 181).
The engine starts.
X To start a diesel engine: press the Start/
Stop button once (Y page 181).
Preglow is activated and the engine starts.
Pulling away
Manual transmission
! Change gear in good time and avoid spinning the wheels. Otherwise, you could damage the vehicle.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
X Release the electric parking brake
(Y page 209).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal and gently
depress the accelerator pedal.
X
Follow the shift recommendations in the multifunction display for an economical driving
style (Y page 191).
The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at any
time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking
feature, see the Digital Owner's Manual.
Automatic transmission
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
! If a warning tone sounds and the
Release park. brake message appears
in the multifunction display, the parking
brake is still applied. Release the parking
brake.
Driving
It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if you
depress the brake pedal. Only then is the
parking lock released. If the brake pedal is not
depressed, the DIRECT SELECT lever can still
be moved but the parking lock remains
engaged.
The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at any
time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking
feature; see the Digital Owner's Manual.
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Pulling away with a trailer
Press and hold handle :.
The electric parking brake continues to
brake and prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster remains lit.
X Depress the accelerator pedal.
X As soon as the vehicle/trailer combination
is held by the driving force of the engine,
release lever :.
the electric parking brake is released.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
For further information on the electric parking
brake, see (Y page 209).
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It
holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
The vehicle is then held for about a second.
X Pull away.
X
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou
To ensure that you do not roll backwards
when pulling away on an uphill slope, engage
the electric parking brake.
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is in position N.
Rthe electric parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
Z
Driving and parking
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
The electric parking brake (Y page 209) is
automatically released.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
185
186
Driving
ECO start/stop function
Driving and parking
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
: ECO start/stop display
If the è ECO symbol is shown in green in
the multifunction display, the ECO start/stop
function switches the engine off automatically once the vehicle stops moving.
The ECO start/stop function is activated
whenever you switch on the engine using the
key or the Start/Stop button.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 187) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the è ECO symbol is not displayed.
Automatic engine switch-off
General notes
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the è ECO symbol is shown in green in
the multifunction display, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button lights
up green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rno electrical connection is established
between the vehicle and the trailer or
another carrier system (e.g. bicycle rack)
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If the conditions for automatic engine switchoff are not all fulfilled, the è ECO symbol is
shown in yellow.
All of the vehicle's systems remain active
when the engine is switched off automatically.
Vehicles with manual transmission
The ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically at low speeds.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The engine is started automatically if:
Brake the vehicle.
Shift to neutral N (follow gearshift instruction : to shift into neutral N, if necessary).
X Release the clutch pedal.
The engine is switched off automatically.
Ryou
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or N,
the ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically.
The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It
is then not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase.
When you depress the accelerator pedal, the
engine starts automatically and the braking
effect of the HOLD function is deactivated.
switch to drive program S+
Rin transmission position D or N, the brake
pedal is released and the HOLD function is
not active
Ryou shift from transmission position P
Shifting the transmission to position P does
not start the engine.
If you shift the transmission from R to D, the
ECO start/stop function is available again
once the è ECO symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
Switching off/on the ECO start/stop
function
Automatic engine start
General notes
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
Vehicles with manual transmission
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
The engine is started automatically when you
depress the clutch pedal.
To switch off: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the è ECO symbol in the multifunction display go out.
X To switch on: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If all conditions
for automatic engine switch-off
(Y page 186) are met, the è ECO symbol is shown in green in the multifunction
display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 186) are met, the è
ECO symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the
ECO start/stop function is not available.
X
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been deactivated manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will
Z
187
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving and parking
188
Driving
then not be switched off automatically when
the vehicle stops.
Selecting drive program S+ deactivates the
ECO start/stop function. If you press ECO
button :, the ECO start/stop function is
activated.
Driving
189
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 232) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 222).
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 183).
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Before attempting to start the engine again, turn the key in the
ignition back to position 0 or press the Start/Stop button
repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go
out.
RThere
X
Try to start the engine again (Y page 183). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display is at the
reserve level.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 418).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
Try to start the engine again (Y page 183).
X
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Driving and parking
190
Manual transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. A
X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
display message may
cool down.
also appear in the mul- X
Check the coolant level (Y page 393). Observe the warning
tifunction display and a
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
warning tone may
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Manual transmission
Gear lever
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
trailer, you must shift into gear 1, 2 or 3 in
good time. This uses the engine's braking
effect. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
! When shifting between 5th and 6th gear,
you should always push the gear lever all
the way to the right. Otherwise, you could
shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th gear
and damage the transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine
to overrev, leading to engine damage.
Do not use the clutch bite point to keep the
vehicle stationary on uphill gradients.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
clutch.
! On long and steep downhill gradients,
especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a
k
Reverse gear
1 - 6 Forward gears
Manual transmission
C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition: in drive
program E the accelerator pedal also transmits double pulses. Additional information
for drive programs (Y page 192).
AGILITY SELECT switch
Use the AGILITY SELECT switch to change the
drive program. Depending on the drive program selected, the following vehicle characteristics will change:
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Move the gear lever to position N :.
X
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could
damage the transmission.
X
Move the gear lever firmly to the left,
beyond the point of resistance, then forwards.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. For further
information on the ECO start/stop function;
see (Y page 186).
Gearshift recommendation
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function (Y page 186)
Rthe climate control settings
- THERMATIC (Y page 153)
- THERMOTRONIC (Y page 156)
Rthe rear window heating operation period
(Y page 164)
Rthe performance of the seat heating
(Y page 123)
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, drive program C is activated when the
engine is next started.
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift gear according to gearshift recommendation : when shown in the multifunction display of the instrument cluster.
Z
Driving and parking
Shifting to neutral N
191
Manual transmission
192
Driving and parking
X
Push AGILITY SELECT switch : up or down
until the desired drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds
the display goes out and the status icon of
the selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings are displayed in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display.
Available drive programs:
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits extremely sporty driving characteristics
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly stiff
springing and damping settings (vehicles
with AIRMATIC)
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available
I Individual
Individual settings
Drive program S (Sport)
S+ Sport Plus
Extremely sporty driving
characteristics
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
S Sport
Sporty driving characteristics
Rthe
C Comfort
Comfortable and economical driving characteristics
E Eco
Particularly economical
driving characteristics
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 192).
Drive programs
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
RC 180 BlueTEC BlueEFFICIENCY Edition:
availability of the economical accelerator
pedal
Information about the selection of drive program I with COMAND Online or Audio 20 can
be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics
Rthe suspension exhibits stiff springing and
damping settings (vehicles with AIRMATIC)
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle delivers comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Drive program E (Eco)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe performance of the air-conditioning and
heating systems are reduced.
Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
Bear in mind that power transmission
between the engine and the transmission is
interrupted when the engine is switched off.
For this reason, shift the automatic transmission to P when the engine is switched off and
the vehicle is stationary. Apply the electric
parking brake to prevent the vehicle from rolling away.
Hybrid Vehicles: observe the safety instructions for hybrid vehicles (Y page 269).
j
k
i
h
Driving and parking
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
193
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
The DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns to
its original position. The current transmission
position P, R, N or D appears in the transmission position display in the multifunction display (Y page 195).
Engaging park position P
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
the automatic transmission directly from D
to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise,
the automatic transmission could be damaged.
j Park position with parking lock
k Reverse gear
Z
Automatic transmission
194
i Neutral
h Drive
Driving and parking
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
Engaging park position P automatically
Park position P is automatically engaged if:
Ryou switch off the engine using the key and
remove the key
switch off the engine using the Start/
Stop button and open the driver's door
Ryou open the driver's door when the vehicle
is stationary or driving at very low speed
and the transmission is in position D or R
Ryou
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
If the transmission is in position D or N:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever up past the first point of
resistance.
X
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. For further
information on the ECO start/stop function,
see (Y page 186).
Shifting to neutral N
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Rclimb
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
If the transmission is in position D or R:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever up or down to the first point of
resistance.
X
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open one of the
front doors or remove the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then
open one of the front doors, the automatic
transmission shifts to P.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the
vehicle cleaned in an automatic car wash with
a towing system:
With the key:
Switch the ignition on.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
With the Start/Stop button:
Switch the ignition on.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
The arrows in the transmission position display show how and into which transmission
positions you can change using the DIRECT
SELECT lever.
Transmission positions
B
Engaging drive position D
If the transmission is in position R or N:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever down past the first point of
resistance.
X
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped.
Do not shift the transmission into
position P (Y page 193) unless the
vehicle is stationary. The parking
lock should not be used as a brake
when parking. In order to secure
the vehicle, always engage the
electric parking brake in addition to
the parking lock.
The automatic transmission shifts
to P automatically if you:
Rremove
the key
Rswitch off the engine when in R
or D and open one of the front
doors
In the event of a malfunction of the
vehicle's electronics, the transmission may be locked in position P.
Have the vehicle electronics
checked immediately at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Transmission position and drive program display
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or
S.
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
: Status symbol drive program
; Transmission position
= Gear
Z
195
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
196
Automatic transmission
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
shift the transmission to position N
if the vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
If you switch off the engine using
the key or the Start/Stop button,
the automatic transmission shifts
to neutral N automatically.
Driving and parking
A
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
7
Driving tips
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Rthe
selected drive program (Y page 197)
position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
Double-clutch function
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Rocking the vehicle free
Rocking the vehicle free by shifting the transmission repeatedly between transmission
positions D and R may help to free the vehicle
if it has become stuck in mud or snow.
The vehicle's engine management restricts
repeated shifting between gears D and R up
to a maximum speed of 9 km/h.
To shift back and forth between transmission
positions D and R, move the DIRECT SELECT
lever up and down past the point of resistance.
Towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see
(Y page 284).
X Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Manual shifting: depending on the uphill
or downhill gradient, shift into a gear
(Y page 198) in which the engine will run in
the middle of the engine speed range.
This also applies if cruise control,
DISTRONIC PLUS or SPEEDTRONIC are
activated.
AGILITY SELECT switch
Use the AGILITY SELECT switch to change the
drive program. Depending on the drive program selected, the following vehicle characteristics will change:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function (Y page 186)
Rthe climate control settings
- THERMATIC (Y page 153)
- THERMOTRONIC (Y page 156)
Rthe rear window heating operation period
(Y page 164)
Rthe performance of the seat heating
(Y page 123)
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, drive program C is activated when the
engine is next started.
the display goes out and the status icon of
the selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings are displayed in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display.
Available drive programs:
I Individual
Individual settings
S+ Sport Plus
Extremely sporty driving
characteristics
S Sport
Sporty driving characteristics
C Comfort
Comfortable and economical driving characteristics
E Eco
Particularly economical
driving characteristics
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 197).
Using the steering wheel gearshift paddles,
you can temporarily change gear yourself.
Further information on the manual drive program (Y page 198).
Drive programs
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe
X
Push AGILITY SELECT switch : up or down
until the desired drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
To permanently select the gears in the drive
program I using the steering wheel paddles,
select the permanent manual gearshift program.
Information about the selection of drive program I with COMAND Online or Audio 20 can
be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Z
197
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
198
Automatic transmission
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Driving and parking
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits extremely sporty driving characteristics
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly stiff
springing and damping settings (vehicles
with AIRMATIC)
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher
Rthe suspension exhibits stiff springing and
damping settings (vehicles with AIRMATIC)
sooner. The vehicle is driven in the low
engine speed range and the wheels are less
likely to spin.
Drive program E (Eco)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. The vehicle is driven in the low
engine speed range and the wheels are less
likely to spin.
Rduring deceleration, the engine is disconnected from the drive train. The vehicle
uses kinetic energy and consumes less fuel
(overrun mode).
Rthe performance of the air-conditioning and
heating systems are reduced.
Manual gearshifting
General notes
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle delivers comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
: Left steering wheel gearshift paddle:
shifts down
; Right steering wheel gearshift paddle:
shifts up
Automatic transmission
Gearshift recommendation
Activating
X
X
Shift the transmission to position D.
Pull the left or right steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 198).
Manual gearshifting is activated temporarily. The selected gear appears in the multifunction display.
Further information on activating manual
gearshifting in hybrid vehicles (Y page 278).
Shifting gears
Pulling on the left or right gear shift paddle
allows you to shift gears yourself for a limited
time. Depending on which gearshift paddle is
pulled, the automatic transmission immediately shifts into the next gear up or down, if
permitted.
X To shift up: pull the right-hand steering
wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 198).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
If the maximum engine speed on the currently engaged gear is reached and you
continue to accelerate, the automatic
transmission automatically shifts up in
order to prevent engine damage.
X To shift down: pull on the left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 198).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
If the engine exceeds the maximum engine
speed when shifting down, the automatic
transmission protects against engine damage by not shifting down.
Automatic downshifting occurs when
coasting.
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display of the
instrument cluster.
Deactivating
If you have activated manual gearshifting, it
will remain active for a certain amount of
time. Under certain conditions the minimum
amount of time is extended, e.g. in the case of
lateral acceleration, during an overrun phase
or when driving on steep terrain.
If manual gearshifting is deactivated, the
gears will be selected automatically.
You can also deactivate manual gearshifting:
X
Pull on the right-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle and hold it in place
(Y page 198).
or
X
Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to shift the
transmission position.
or
X
Use the AGILITY SELECT switch to change
the drive program (Y page 197).
Manual gearshifting is deactivated.
Z
Driving and parking
Using the steering wheel gearshift paddles,
you can temporarily change gear yourself.
The transmission must be in position D.
199
200
Refuelling
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Problems with hybrid operation (Y page 282).
Transfer case
This section only applies to vehicles with allwheel drive (4MATIC). The front and rear
axles are constantly driven.
! Performance tests may only be carried
out on a two-axle roller dynamometer. Otherwise, the braking system or the transfer
case could be damaged. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop for more information
on performance tests.
! Since ESP® engages automatically, the
ignition must be switched off (the key or
Start/Stop button must be in position 0 or
1) if:
Rthe electric parking brake is being tested
using a brake dynamometer.
vehicle is being towed with only one
axle raised (not permitted for vehicles
with 4MATIC).
The brake system could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
Refuelling
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
G WARNING
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel
system. Even small amounts of the wrong
fuel can result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. The repair costs are high.
Notify a qualified specialist workshop and
have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may
spray out when you remove the fuel pump
nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 468).
Refuelling
General notes
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 200).
If you unlock/lock the vehicle from the outside, the fuel filler flap also unlocks/locks.
The position of the 8 fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
Z
Driving and parking
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
201
Refuelling
202
Opening the fuel filler flap
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
Driving and parking
X
Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle.
:
;
=
?
To open the fuel filler flap
To insert the fuel filler cap
Tyre pressure table
Fuel type to be refuelled
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Open the driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder on
the inside of fuel filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place
and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
X
X
Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise, fuel
may leak out.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the filler neck is
designed for refuelling at diesel filling pumps.
Refuelling
203
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The engine does not
start.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Open the driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status 0. This is the same as
the key having been removed.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for approximately ten seconds
(Y page 181).
X Start the engine continuously for a maximum of ten seconds
until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again a maximum of ten seconds
(Y page 181).
X Start the engine again continuously for a maximum of ten seconds until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
Driving and parking
204
Refuelling
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key battery is discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 91).
or
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 93).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
AdBlue® (BlueTEC vehicles only)
Important notes on use
To function properly, BlueTEC exhaust gas
aftertreatment must be operated with the
reducing agent AdBlue®. Topping up AdBlue®
is part of the maintenance work.
When the supply of AdBlue® is down to
approximately 3.0 litres, the Refill
AdBlue See Owner's Manual message is
shown in the multifunction display.
When the AdBlue® supply drops to a minimum, the Refill AdBlue No start in X
km message is shown in the multifunction display.
If you drive the vehicle faster than 15 km/h,
the Refill AdBlue See Owner's Manual
message goes out after approximately one
minute.
If the Refill AdBlue No start in X km
message is shown in the multifunction display, you can still drive the vehicle over the
distance shown. If the AdBlue® is not topped
up, you will subsequently be unable to
start the engine. If the Refill AdBlue
Start not possible message appears in
the multifunction display and the engine does
not start, you must top up AdBlue®.
Add at least 3.5 l of AdBlue®.
Switch on the ignition for at least 60 seconds.
X Start the engine.
X
X
i You can also have the AdBlue® tank refilled at a qualified specialist workshop.
Before driving your vehicle outside Europe,
have the AdBlue® supply checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Further information about BlueTEC exhaust
gas aftertreatment and about AdBlue® can
be obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Important notes on the refilling procedure
AdBlue® is a water-soluble fluid for the
exhaust gas aftertreatment of diesel engines.
It is:
Rnon-toxic
Rcolourless
and odourless
Rnon-flammable
If you open the AdBlue® tank, small amounts
of ammonia vapour may be released.
Ammonia vapours have a pungent odour and
are particularly irritating to the skin, to
mucous membranes and to the eyes. You may
experience a burning sensation in your eyes,
Refuelling
rinse AdBlue® off your skin
with soap and water.
Rif AdBlue® comes into contact with your
eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly
with clean water. Seek medical attention
immediately.
Rif AdBlue® is swallowed, immediately rinse
your mouth out thoroughly. Drink plenty of
water. Seek medical attention immediately.
Rchange immediately out of clothing that
has come into contact with AdBlue®.
Rimmediately
! Only use AdBlue® in accordance with
ISO 22241. Do not mix any additives with
AdBlue®, and do not dilute AdBlue® with
water. This may destroy the BlueTEC
exhaust gas aftertreatment system.
! In order to fill the
AdBlue®
tank, the vehicle must be parked on a level surface. The
AdBlue® tank can only be filled as intended
with the vehicle parked on a level surface.
Fluctuations in capacity will thus be avoided. Filling a vehicle standing on an uneven
surface is not permitted. There is a danger
of overfilling, which can cause damage to
BlueTEC exhaust gas aftertreatment components.
! Surfaces which have come into contact
with AdBlue® while refilling should be
rinsed immediately with water, or remove
AdBlue® with a moist cloth and cold water.
If AdBlue® has already crystallised, use a
sponge and cold water to clean the area.
AdBlue® residue crystallises after a certain
amount of time and soils the affected surfaces.
! AdBlue® is not a fuel additive and must
not be added to the fuel tank. If AdBlue® is
added to the fuel tank, this can lead to
engine damage.
Have the AdBlue® tank refilled at a qualified
specialist workshop. However, you can also
top up the AdBlue® tank:
a filling station with an AdBlue® filling
pump
Rwith AdBlue® refill bottles
Rwith an AdBlue® refill canister
When the pump nozzle switches off automatically during filling at a filling pump, the
AdBlue® tank has been completely filled. Do
not fill the AdBlue® tank any further. AdBlue®
may leak out.
To avoid transporting already opened refill
containers in the vehicle, completely empty
refill bottles or canisters when filling the
AdBlue® tank, if possible.
Further information on AdBlue®
(Y page 472).
Rat
Opening the AdBlue® filler cap
Example: Saloon
Z
Driving and parking
nose and throat. You may also experience
coughing and watery eyes.
Do not inhale any ammonia vapours that may
be released. Only fill the AdBlue® tank in wellventilated areas.
Do not swallow AdBlue® or let it come into
contact with skin, eyes or clothing. Keep
AdBlue® away from children.
If you or others come into contact with
AdBlue®, observe the following:
205
Refuelling
206
Switch the ignition off.
Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn blue AdBlue® filler cap ; anti-clockwise and remove it.
AdBlue® filler cap ; is secured with a plastic strip.
X
Driving and parking
X
i The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked
automatically when you unlock or lock the
vehicle.
AdBlue® refill canisters
! Do not tighten the disposable hose with
too much force. The disposable hose may
otherwise be destroyed.
Disposable hose : remains closed until
you fasten disposable hose : to the
AdBlue® filler neck of the vehicle.
X Place disposable hose : on the filler neck
on the vehicle and screw it on clockwise
until hand-tight. When you feel resistance,
disposable hose : is sufficiently secured.
X Lift up and tip AdBlue® refill canister ;.
Filling stops when the AdBlue® tank is completely filled. Do not fill the AdBlue® tank
any further. AdBlue® refill canister ; can
be removed when it has been only partially
emptied.
X Turn disposable hose : on the filler neck
of the vehicle anti-clockwise and remove it.
X Turn disposable hose : on the opening of
AdBlue® refill canister ; anti-clockwise
and remove it.
X Reseal AdBlue® refill canister ; with the
cap.
AdBlue® refill canisters are available at many
filling stations or at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. AdBlue® refill canisters are often sold
with a filler hose. A filler hose that does not
exactly fit the vehicle's AdBlue® tank offers
no protection against overfilling. AdBlue®
may leak out as a result of overfilling.
Mercedes-Benz offers a special disposable
hose with overfill protection. You can obtain
this from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
AdBlue® is available in a variety of containers
and receptacles. Only use the disposable
hose with the Mercedes-Benz AdBlue® refill
canisters.
AdBlue® refill bottle
Unscrew the cap from the opening on top of
AdBlue® refill canister ;.
X Place disposable hose : on the opening of
AdBlue® refill canister ; and screw it on
clockwise until hand-tight.
X
! Screw on the AdBlue® refill bottle only
hand-tight. It may otherwise be destroyed.
Parking
207
Unscrew the protective cap from AdBlue®
refill bottle :.
X Place AdBlue® refill bottle : on the filler
neck as shown and screw it on hand-tight.
X Press AdBlue® refill bottle : towards the
filler neck.
The AdBlue® tank is filled. This could last up
to one minute.
When AdBlue® refill bottle : is no longer
pressed, filling stops and the bottle may be
taken off again after being only partially
emptied.
X Release AdBlue® refill bottle :.
X Turn AdBlue® refill bottle : anti-clockwise
and remove it.
X Screw the protective cap onto AdBlue®
refill bottle : again.
X
AdBlue® refill bottles are available at many
filling stations or at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Refill bottles without a threaded seal
offer no protection against overfilling.
AdBlue® may leak out as a result of overfilling.
Mercedes-Benz offers special refill bottles
with a threaded cap. These are available at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Example: Saloon
Fit AdBlue® filler cap ; on the filler neck
and turn it clockwise.
X To close the fuel filler flap, press it in the
direction of arrow :.
X Drive faster than 15 km/h.
The Refill AdBlue See Owner's Man‐
ual message goes out after approximately
one minute.
X
If the Refill AdBlue See Owner's Manual
message continues to be shown in the multifunction display, you must top up with more
AdBlue®.
Parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
Z
Driving and parking
Closing the AdBlue® filler cap
208
Parking
Driving and parking
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe
electric parking brake must be applied
vehicles with manual transmission,
engage first gear or reverse gear
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock
Rthe front wheels must be turned towards
the kerb on steep uphill or downhill gradients
Rthe empty vehicle must be secured at the
front axle with a wheel chock or similar
object, for example, on uphill or downhill
gradients
Ra laden vehicle must also be secured at the
rear axle with a wheel chock or similar
object, for example, on uphill or downhill
gradients
Ron
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Vehicles with manual transmission
Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Apply the electric parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X With the key: turn the key to position 0 in
the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With the Start/Stop button: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 181).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0: "key removed".
X
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open one of the
front doors or remove the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then
open one of the front doors, the automatic
transmission shifts to P.
Parking
Switch the ignition on.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
With the Start/Stop button:
Switch the ignition on.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding the
Start/Stop button for about three seconds.
This function operates independently of the
ECO start/stop automatic engine switch-off
function.
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction in the system, it may not be possible to
apply the released parking brake.
If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it from
rolling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first gear.
X
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or
if there is a malfunction in the system. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
The electric parking brake carries out a function check at regular intervals when the
engine is switched off. Noises that occur are
normal.
Z
Driving and parking
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the
vehicle cleaned in an automatic car wash with
a towing system:
With the key:
209
Parking
210
Applying/releasing manually
Rthere
is a system malfunction
power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically applied if the engine is switched off by
the ECO start/stop function.
Driving and parking
Rthe
Releasing automatically
X
To apply: push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red ! indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake can also be
applied when the key is removed.
To release: pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
The electric parking brake can only be
released:
X
Rwhen
the key is in position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 181) or
Rif the ignition was switched on using the
Start/Stop button
Applying automatically
The electric parking brake is applied automatically:
Rif
DISTRONIC PLUS brings the vehicle to a
standstill (vehicles with automatic transmission) or
Rif the HOLD function is keeping the vehicle
stationary or
Rif Active Parking Assist is holding the vehicle at a standstill
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
engine is switched off
Rthe driver's door is open and the seat belt is
not fastened
The electric parking brake of your vehicle is
released automatically when all of the following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe
engine is running
with automatic transmission:
the transmission is in position D or R
RVehicles with manual transmission: a
gear is engaged
Rthe seat belt is fastened
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
when the transmission is in position R the
boot lid must be closed.
Vehicles with manual transmission: when
reverse gear R is engaged, the boot lid must
be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
RVehicles
Rthe
driver's door is closed
with automatic transmission:
you are shifting from transmission position
P or have previously driven faster than
3 km/h
RVehicles with manual transmission: you
have previously driven faster than 3 km/h
Ensure that you do not depress the accelerator pedal unintentionally. Otherwise, the
parking brake will be released and the vehicle
will start to move.
RVehicles
Driving tips
Emergency braking
Driving tips
The vehicle can also be braked during an
emergency by using the electric parking
brake.
X While driving, push handle : of the electrical parking brake (Y page 209).
General driving tips
Ra
warning tone sounds
Release park. brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Rthe
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging and further damaged in the event of this occurring again.
X Disconnect the battery or connect it to a
trickle charger.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, it may suffer from lack of use.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
Hybrid vehicles: observe the safety notes
for the high-voltage battery (Y page 269).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Observe the following tips to save fuel:
The tyres should always be inflated to the
recommended tyre pressure.
X Remove unnecessary loads.
X Remove roof racks when they are not needed.
X Warm up the engine at low engine speeds.
X Avoid frequent acceleration or braking.
X Have all maintenance work carried out as
indicated by the service intervals in the
Service Booklet or by the service interval
display.
X
Fuel consumption also increases when driving in cold weather, in stop-start traffic, on
short journeys and in hilly terrain.
ECO display
The ECO display shows you how economical
your driving style is. The ECO display assists
you in achieving the most economical driving
style for the selected settings and prevailing
conditions. Consumption can be significantly
influenced by your driving style.
Z
Driving and parking
The vehicle is braked as long as you keep
handle : of the electric parking brake
depressed. The longer the electric parking
brake handle : is depressed, the greater the
braking force.
During braking:
211
212
Driving tips
The ECO display consists of three sections,
with an inner and outer area. The sections
correspond to the following three categories:
Driving and parking
:
Acceleration (evaluation of all
acceleration processes):
Rthe
:
;
=
?
Acceleration
Coasting
Constant
Additional range achieved
outer area fills up and the
inner area lights up green: moderate acceleration, especially at
higher speeds
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: sporty acceleration
;
Range ? is shown under Bonus fr. start
and represents the additional range achieved
since the beginning of the journey as a result
of an adapted driving style.
If the fuel level has dropped into the reserve
range, the Reserve fuel message is shown
in the multifunction display instead of
range ?. In addition, the 8 warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up
(Y page 360).
Coasting (evaluation of all deceleration processes):
Rthe
outer area fills up and the
inner area lights up green: anticipatory driving, keeping your distance and early release of the
accelerator. The vehicle can
coast without use of the brakes.
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: frequent heavy
braking
=
Constant (continuous evaluation
over the entire journey):
Rthe
outer area fills up and the
inner area lights up green: constant speed and avoidance of
unnecessary acceleration and
deceleration
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: fluctuations in
speed
The three inner areas display the current driving style and light up green as a result of a
particularly economical driving style.
Depending on the driving situation, up to two
areas may light up simultaneously.
At the beginning of the journey, the three
outer areas are empty and fill up as a result of
economical driving. A higher level indicates a
more economical driving style. If the three
outer areas are completely filled at the same
Driving tips
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
Rcold start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
An economical driving style involves driving at
a moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
"acceleration" and "smooth driving":
Robserve
the gearshift recommendation
the vehicle in drive program E (vehicles with the AGILITY SELECT switch)
On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g. on
the motorway, only the outer area for "constant" will change.
The ECO display summarises the driving style
from the start of the journey to its completion.
Therefore, there are more marked changes in
the outer areas at the start of a journey. During a prolonged driving time, these changes
are smaller. For more marked changes, perform a manual rest (Y page 299).
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 298).
Rdrive
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle and
when towing a trailer.
This also applies if cruise control, DISTRONIC
PLUS or SPEEDTRONIC are activated.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If heavy demands are made on the brakes, do
not park the vehicle immediately. Drive on for
a short while. This allows the airflow to cool
the brakes more quickly.
Z
Driving and parking
time, the driver has adopted the most economical driving style for the selected settings
and prevailing conditions. The ECO display
border lights up.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption. The additionally achieved
range displayed under Bonus fr. start
does not indicate a fixed consumption reduction.
In addition to driving style, the actual consumption is affected by other factors, such
as:
213
Driving and parking
214
Driving tips
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed while paying attention to the
traffic conditions. This improves the grip of
the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of
salt may form on the brake discs and pads.
This can increase the braking distance considerably.
RIn order to prevent a layer of salt forming,
apply the brakes occasionally while paying
attention to the traffic conditions.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the
end of the journey and when starting the
next journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the
vehicle in front.
New brake discs and brake pads/
linings
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends only fitting the following brake discs
and brake pads/linings:
Rbrake
discs that have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz
Rbrake pads/linings that have been
approved by Mercedes-Benz or that are of
an equivalent standard of quality
Other brake discs or brake pads/linings can
compromise the safety of your vehicle.
Always replace all brake discs and brake
pads/linings on an axle at the same time.
Always fit new brake pads/linings when
replacing brake discs.
The vehicle is equipped with lightweight
brake discs to which the wheel assembly with
rim and threaded connection is matched.
The use of brake discs other than those
approved by Mercedes-Benz may alter track
width and is subject to approval, if applicable.
Shock-type loads when handling the brake
discs, such as when changing wheels, can
lead to a reduction in comfort when driving
with lightweight brake discs. Avoid shocktype loads on the lightweight brake discs,
particularly on the brake plate.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
are driving at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, drive in the following manner
in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in
which aquaplaning can occur:
Rthe
Rlower
Ravoid
your speed
tyre ruts
Driving tips
sudden steering movements
carefully
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you must drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
water level, in the case of still water,
may not exceed a maximum point of the
lower edge of the vehicle body
Ryou should drive no faster than walking
pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres. Do
not use cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges. The
vehicle could skid if you fail to adapt your
driving style. Always adapt your driving style
and drive at a speed to suit the prevailing
weather conditions.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
Further information on driving with snow
chains (Y page 431).
Further information on driving with summer
tyres (Y page 430).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 430).
Z
Driving and parking
Ravoid
Rbrake
215
216
Driving systems
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive stands for
innovative driver assistance and safety systems which enhance comfort and support the
driver in critical situations. With these intelligent co-ordinated systems Mercedes-Benz
has set a milestone on the path towards
autonomous driving.
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive embraces all
elements of active and passive safety in one
well thought-out system – for the safety of the
vehicle occupants and that of other road
users.
Further information on driving safety systems
(Y page 74).
for braking in good time, and for staying in
lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in heavy traffic or on winding roads)
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. Change into
a lower gear in good time on long and steep
downhill gradients. Take particular note of
this when driving a laden vehicle and when
towing a trailer. By doing so, you will make
use of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions are appropriate for maintaining a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. Cruise control is
only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and to call up
the last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
Driving systems
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
RLIM
Selecting cruise control
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically braking the vehicle.
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
Ralways
drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds
Rchange gear in good time.
Rif possible, do not change down several
gears at a time
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
Z
Driving and parking
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. In addition, the é symbol
appears in the multifunction display. In the
speedometer, the segments between the
stored speed and the maximum speed light
up.
217
Driving systems
Driving and parking
218
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, cruise control adjusts
the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored
after you have finished overtaking.
X
Deactivating cruise control
Setting a speed
Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =.
or
X Brake.
or
X Briefly move the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp : in the cruise control lever
is lit.
Driving systems
Ryou
apply the electric parking brake
are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rwhile driving a vehicle with manual transmission, you shift into neutral or depress
the clutch pedal for longer than six seconds
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high, and as a
result the engine speed is too low
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
you shift into position N while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
Ryou
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 221)
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. Change into
a lower gear in good time on long and steep
downhill gradients. Take particular note of
this when driving a laden vehicle. By doing so,
you will make use of the braking effect of the
engine. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics.
SPEEDTRONIC cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time, and for staying in lane.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
A To switch between cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
Z
Driving and parking
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
219
220
Driving systems
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
Driving and parking
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
The current speed is stored and shown in
the multifunction display.
The speedometer dial lights up between
the start of the scale and the stored speed.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the limit speed stored.
X Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever is on. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Storing the current speed
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
Driving systems
Setting a speed
221
Rdrive slower than the stored speed without
kickdown
a new speed or
Rcall up the last speed stored again
The SPEEDTRONIC passive message in the
multifunction display disappears.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
X
To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : past the pressure point for
a higher speed, or down ; for a lower
speed.
or
X
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ; for a
lower speed.
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ; for a lower
speed.
Switching SPEEDTRONIC to passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the pressure point (kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC is switched to passive mode. The following message appears in the multifunction
display: SPEEDTRONIC passive.
passive
You can then exceed the stored speed.
SPEEDTRONIC is activated again if you:
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 313).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
Z
Driving and parking
Rset
222
Driving systems
Driving and parking
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. Vehicles are detected with the aid of the radar
sensor system. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes
automatically so that the set speed is not
exceeded.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on
the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention,
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision.
An intermittent warning tone will then sound
and the distance warning lamp will light up in
the instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
DISTRONIC PLUS operates in the range
between 0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to:
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stopped or parked vehicles
Roncoming and crossing traffic
As a result, DISTRONIC PLUS may neither give
warnings nor intervene in such situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly recognise other road users and complex traffic
conditions.
In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate or brake unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be prepared to
brake, particularly if DISTRONIC PLUS warns
you.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up
to 50% of the maximum possible deceleration.
If this deceleration is not sufficient,
DISTRONIC PLUS alerts you with a visual and
acoustic warning. There is a risk of an accident.
Apply the brakes yourself in these situations
and try to take evasive action.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style,
DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk
of an accident nor override the laws of physics. DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take road and
weather conditions or traffic conditions into
account. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle
Driving systems
in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in lane.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS:
Cruise control lever
Rin
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
If DISTRONIC PLUS no longer detects a vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate to
the speed stored.
This speed can:
Rsnow
Rbe
too high for a filter lane or a slip road
so high in the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the left (left-hand drive
countries)
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the right (right-hand
drive countries)
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Rbe
To activate or increase speed
To set the specified minimum distance
LIM indicator lamp
To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
A To activate or reduce speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
:
;
=
?
You can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control
lever.
LIM indicator lamp = on the cruise control
lever indicates which function you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp = off: DISTRONIC
PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp = on: variable
SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
Z
Driving and parking
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
in heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow
vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
223
Driving and parking
224
Driving systems
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following
conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before
DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe electric parking brake must be
released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RActive Parking Assist must not be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and the rear
doors must be closed.
Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS function must be
selected with the cruise control lever
(Y page 223).
Activating
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ; or press it up : or down =.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Press the cruise control lever repeatedly
up : or down = until the desired speed is
set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
X
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS inactive
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
You can also activate DISTRONIC PLUS when
stationary. The lowest speed that can be set is
30 km/h.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ; or press it up : or down =.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
Activating at the current speed/last
stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Driving systems
225
facing an unidentified obstacle or is driving
on a different line from another vehicle. The
vehicle then brakes automatically. There is
a risk of an accident. Be ready to brake at all
times.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
Driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
Pulling away and driving
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle.
In this way, the distance you have selected is
maintained.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed.
However, the vehicle is only accelerated up to
the speed you have stored.
Selecting the drive program
DISTRONIC PLUS supports a sporty driving
style when you have selected the S or S+
drive program (Y page 197). Acceleration
behind the vehicle in front or to the set speed
is then noticeably more dynamic. If you have
selected the C or E drive program, the vehicle
accelerates more gently. This setting is recommended in stop-and-start traffic.
Changing lanes
If you change to the overtaking lane,
DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
Ryou
are driving faster than 70 km/h
switch on the respective turn signal
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
Ryou
If you want to pull away with
DISTRONIC PLUS: remove your foot from
the brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
or
X Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front. If no
vehicle is detected in front, your vehicle
accelerates to the set speed.
X
i When you change lanes, DISTRONIC
PLUS monitors the left lane (on left-handdrive vehicles) or the right lane (on righthand-drive vehicles).
Z
Driving and parking
i The vehicle can also pull away when it is
226
Driving systems
Road and traffic conditions
Stopping
Driving and parking
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked
only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if:
Rthere
i The following function is only available in
vehicles with the Driving Assistance Plus
package.
The function is not operational in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
adapt to certain traffic situations. This is the
case if, while following a vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive around a roundabout
a T-junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the speed you set.
The system takes into account the fact that
overtaking on the right is not permitted on
motorways or high-speed major roads at
speeds above 80 km/h. The driving speed is
adjusted to the speed of the queue of vehicles
in the adjacent lane to the left.
Rapproach
i Prevention of overtaking on the right
applies to countries where traffic drives on
the right. In countries where traffic drives
on the left, overtaking on the left is prevented accordingly.
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated
with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed,
e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
For further information on deactivating
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 228).
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it
is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
After a short period, the vehicle is secured by
the electric parking brake, thus relieving the
service brake.
Depending on the specified minimum distance, your vehicle will come to a standstill at
a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
front. The specified minimum distance is set
using the control on the cruise control lever.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
and:
Rthe seat belt is unfastened and the driver's
door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Driving systems
system fault occurs
power supply is insufficient
If a malfunction occurs, then the transmission
may also be shifted into position P automatically.
Rthe
Setting a speed
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 228).
i Make sure that you maintain the mini-
mum distance to the vehicle in front as
required by law. Adjust the distance to the
vehicle in front if necessary.
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
X
To increase: turn control ; in direction
=.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control ; in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
i If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC
PLUS adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Z
Driving and parking
Ra
227
228
Driving systems
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the instrument cluster
Driving and parking
Displays in the speedometer
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments between the speed of the vehicle in
front : and stored speed ; light up. The
segments likewise light up if a vehicle in front
is detected in the fast lane.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 306).
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
: DISTRONIC PLUS active (text only
appears when the cruise control lever is
actuated)
; Vehicle in front, if detected
= Specified minimum distance to the vehicle in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
In the Assistance menu (Y page 307) of the
on-board computer, you can select the assistance graphics display.
X Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 306).
You will see the stored speed for approximately five seconds when you activate
DISTRONIC PLUS.
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
In the Assistance menu (Y page 307) of the
on-board computer, you can select the assistance graphics display.
Driving systems
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you
will see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message in
the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
Pay particular attention in the following traffic
situations:
RCornering,
entering and exiting a bend
RVehicles which are not driving in the middle
of their lane
vehicles changing lane
RNarrow vehicles
RObstructions and stationary vehicles
RCrossing vehicles
In such situations, brake if necessary.
DISTRONIC PLUS is then deactivated.
ROther
Cornering, entering and exiting a bend
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the
electric parking brake
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door or one of the rear doors is
open
Rthe vehicle has skidded
Ryou activate Active Parking Assist
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the
DISTRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
which are not driving in the middle of their
Z
Driving and parking
There are several ways to deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS:
229
230
Driving systems
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front will
be too short.
Driving and parking
Other vehicles changing lane
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
Narrow vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may mistakenly detect
vehicles that are crossing your lane. Activating DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with
crossing traffic, for example, could cause
your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist
and Stop&Go Pilot
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway
because of its narrow width. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist and
Stop&Go Pilot aids you in keeping the vehicle
in the centre of the driving lane by means of
moderate steering interventions in a speed
range from 0 - 200 km/h.
It monitors the area in front of your vehicle by
means of camera system : at the top of the
windscreen.
Driving systems
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style,
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist and
Stop&Go Pilot can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
It cannot take into account road, weather or
traffic conditions. DISTRONIC PLUS with
Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot is only an
aid. You are responsible for the distance to
the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for
braking in good time, and for staying in lane.
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist and
Stop&Go Pilot does not detect road and traffic conditions and does not detect all road
users. If you are following a vehicle which is
driving towards the edge of the carriageway,
your vehicle could come into contact with the
kerb or other road boundaries. In the case of
deviations in road markings, beware of other
road users, e.g. cyclists, that are directly next
to your vehicle.
Obstacles such as traffic pylons on the lane or
projecting out into the lane are not detected.
An inappropriate steering intervention, e.g.
after intentionally driving over a lane marking,
can be corrected at any time if you steer
slightly in the opposite direction.
DISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist and
Stop&Go Pilot cannot continuously keep your
vehicle in lane. In some cases, the steering
intervention is not sufficient to bring the vehicle back to the lane. In such cases, you must
steer the vehicle yourself to ensure that it
does not leave the lane.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
The system is switched to passive and no longer assists you by performing steering interventions if:
Ryou
actively change lane
switch on the turn signal
Ryou take your hands off the steering wheel
or do not steer for a prolonged period of
time
Ryou
i After you have finished changing lanes,
Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are automatically active again.
Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot cannot
provide assistance:
Ron
very sharp corners
towing a trailer
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed
Rwhen
Z
Driving and parking
At speeds of more than 60 km/h Steering
Assist focuses on clear lane markings (left
and right).
In a speed range from 0 - 60 km/h Stop&Go
Pilot focuses on the vehicle in front, taking
into account lane markings, e.g. when following vehicles in a traffic jam.
If these conditions are not present, Steering
Assist and Stop&Go Pilot cannot provide
assistance.
DISTRONIC PLUS must be active in order for
the function to be available.
231
Driving systems
Driving and parking
232
Also observe the important safety notes for
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 222).
The steering interventions are carried out
with a limited steering moment. The system
requires the driver to keep his hands on the
steering wheel and to steer himself.
If you do not steer yourself or if you take your
hands off the steering wheel for a prolonged
period of time, the system will first alert you
with a visual warning. A steering wheel symbol appears in the multifunction display. If you
have still not started to steer and have not
taken hold of the steering wheel after five
seconds at the latest, a warning tone also
sounds to remind you to take control of the
vehicle. Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot
switch to passive mode. DISTRONIC PLUS
remains active.
Activating Steering Assist and Stop&Go
Pilot
Information in the multifunction display
If Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are activated but is not ready for a steering intervention, steering wheel symbol : appears in
grey. If the system provides you with support
by means of steering interventions, symbol : is shown in green.
Deactivating Steering Assist and Stop&Go
Pilot
X Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : goes out. The DTR+:
steering assist. offmessage
off
appears
in the multifunction display. Steering Assist
and Stop&Go Pilot are deactivated.
When DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are deactivated
automatically.
X
Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : lights up. The DTR+:
steering assist. onmessage
on
appears
in the multifunction display. Steering Assist
and Stop&Go Pilot are activated.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Driving systems
Activating the HOLD function
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
towing the vehicle
Rin the car wash
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if all of
the following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt
is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
RVehicles with automatic transmission: the
transmission is in position D, R or N
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
Rthe
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou accelerate. On vehicles with automatic
transmission: only when the transmission
is in position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P on vehicles
with automatic transmission.
Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until : disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric
parking brake.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake. The HOLD function is
then deactivated.
Z
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
233
234
Driving systems
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated and:
Driving and parking
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Vehicles with automatic transmission: if a
fault occurs, then the transmission may also
be shifted into position P automatically.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
The Brake immediately message can also
appear in the multifunction display.
X Immediately depress the brake pedal firmly
until the warning message in the multifunction display goes out.
The HOLD function is deactivated.
A horn will sound at regular intervals if you
turn off the engine, take off your seat belt or
open the driver's door when the HOLD function is activated. The horn alerts you to the
fact that the HOLD function is still activated.
If you attempt to lock the vehicle, the tone
becomes louder. The vehicle cannot be
locked until you have deactivated the HOLD
function.
i Once you have switched off the engine,
option to manually adjust the vehicle level.
AIRMATIC consists of level setting, level control and the Adaptive Damping System ADS.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
vehicle level can be set using the AGILITY
SELECT switch (Y page 197) or the level button (Y page 234). The setting always corresponds to the last selected function.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
vehicle level can be set using the AGILITY
SELECT switch (Y page 191) or the level button (Y page 234). The setting always corresponds to the last selected function.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
i If one of the doors is open, the vehicle is
not lowered.
Vehicle level
Setting the raised vehicle level
you cannot restart it until you have deactivated the HOLD function.
AIRMATIC
General notes
AIRMATIC is an air suspension system with
variable damping for improved driving comfort. All-round level control ensures the best
possible suspension and constant ground
clearance, even with a laden vehicle. When
you drive fast, the vehicle is lowered automatically to improve driving safety and to
reduce fuel consumption. There is also the
It is possible to choose between the "Normal"
and "Raised" vehicle levels below a speed of
80 km/h. Select the "Normal" setting for normal road surfaces and "Raised" for driving
with snow chains or on particularly poor road
surfaces. Your selection remains stored even
if you remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Start the engine.
If indicator lamp ; is not lit:
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle is
raised by 25 mm compared to the normal
level.
The Vehicle rising message appears in
the multifunction display.
i The message disappears after ten seconds, irrespective of the level reached. If
necessary, the vehicle is raised further.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
X
Rdrive
faster than 120 km/h
for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h.
The "Raised level" remains saved when you
are not driving within these speed ranges.
Rdrive
Setting the normal vehicle level
X
Start the engine.
If indicator lamp ; is lit:
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to the height of the currently
selected drive program (Y page 197).
Suspension setting
General notes
The Adaptive Damping System automatically
controls the calibration of the dampers.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection, i.e. sport or comfort
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Rthe
Sport mode
In the "Sport" and "Sport Plus" drive programs, the firmer suspension setting ensures
even better contact with the road. Select this
mode when employing a sporty driving style,
e.g. on winding country roads.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select the S or S+ drive program with the
AGILITY SELECT switch (Y page 197).
Vehicles with manual transmission:
select the S or S+ drive program with the
AGILITY SELECT switch (Y page 191).
The vehicle is lowered by 15 mm compared
to the normal level.
Comfort mode
In the "Eco" and "Comfort" drive programs,
the driving characteristics of your vehicle are
more comfortable. Therefore, select this
mode if you prefer a more comfortable driving
style. Select Comfort mode also when driving
fast on straight roads, e.g. on straight
stretches of motorway.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select the E or C drive program with the
AGILITY SELECT switch (Y page 197).
Vehicles with manual transmission:
select the E or C drive program with the
AGILITY SELECT switch (Y page 191).
The vehicle is raised to the normal level.
When driving at speeds above 125 km/h, the
vehicle is automatically lowered by 15 mm in
the E and C drive programs. When driving at
speeds below 80 km/h, the vehicle is raised
again.
4MATIC (permanent all-wheel drive)
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it
improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient
grip.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC
can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
Z
235
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
236
Driving systems
override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot
take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. 4MATIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time and for staying in the lane.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Rwhen
pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary
Raccelerate less when driving
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the transfer case.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground or
be fully raised. Observe the instructions for
towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
you use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It monitors the area
around your vehicle using six sensors in the
front bumper and six sensors in the rear
bumper. PARKTRONIC indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars.
PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects
when they are in the immediate vicinity of
the vehicle. You could damage the vehicle
or the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause
PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically if
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
Rshift
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account
obstacles located:
Rbelow
the detection range, e.g. persons,
animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles
Driving systems
237
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 401).
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is in the
instrument cluster. The warning display for
the rear area is located on the roof lining in
the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if operational readiness indicator = lights up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling deterZ
Driving and parking
Rear sensors
238
Driving systems
Driving and parking
mine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Vehicles without AIRMATIC
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
Vehicles with AIRMATIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Parking Assist is then also
deactivated.
: To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
; Indicator lamp
If indicator lamp ; lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Parking Assist is then also
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving systems
239
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has been deactivated.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated and the
indicator lamp on the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 401).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated.
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. It measures the road on
both sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol
indicates a suitable parking space. Active
steering intervention and brake application
can assist you during parking and when exiting a parking space. You may also use
PARKTRONIC (Y page 236).
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that no persons, animals or
objects are in the manoeuvring range.
When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
For vehicles with the trailer tow hitch folded
out, the minimum length for parking spaces is
slightly longer.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use Active Parking Assist.
Once the electrical connection is established
between your vehicle and the trailer, Active
Parking Assist is no longer available.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area.
G WARNING
While parking or pulling out of a parking
space, the vehicle swings out and can drive
onto areas of the oncoming lane. This could
cause you to collide with other road users.
There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users. Stop the
vehicle if necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at a
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
240
Driving systems
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Driving and parking
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rparking
or stopping prohibitions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly.
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 237) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Ryou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces
that are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
straight roads, not bends
Ron the same level as the road, e.g. not on
the pavement
Ron
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles.
G WARNING
If there are objects above the detection range:
RActive
Park Assist may steer too early
vehicle may not stop in front of these
objects.
This could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop and switch off Active Parking
Assist.
Rthe
Further information on the detection range
(Y page 236).
Active Parking Assist does not assist you
parking in spaces at right angles to the direction of travel if:
Rtwo
parking spaces are located directly
next to one another
Rthe parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a low kerb
Ryou forward park
Active Parking Assist does not assist you
parking in spaces that are parallel or at right
angles to the direction of travel if:
Rthe
parking space is on a kerb
system reads the parking space as
being blocked, for example by foliage or
grass paving blocks
Rthe area is too small for the vehicle to
manoeuvre into
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle, e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer
Rthe
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
are parallel to the direction of travel
and are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel
and at least 1.0 m longer than your vehicle
Rthat are at right angles to the direction of
travel and at least 1.0 m wider than your
vehicle
Rthat
driver's side is activated. When parking on the
driver's side, this must remain switched on
until you acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist by pressing the a button on the
multifunction steering wheel. The system
automatically determines whether the parking space is parallel or at right angles to the
direction of travel.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Parking
G WARNING
If you leave the vehicle when it is only being
braked by Active Parking Assist it could roll
away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe vehicle is accelerated, e.g. by a vehicle
occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always secure it
against rolling away.
i Vehicles with automatic transmis-
sion: if PARKTRONIC detects obstacles,
Active Parking Assist brakes automatically
during the parking process. You are responsible for braking in good time.
i Note that Active Parking Assist cannot
measure the length of a parking space if it
is at right angles to the direction of travel.
You will need to judge whether your vehicle
will fit in the parking space.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
will see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the instrument cluster. When a parking space has been detected, an arrow
towards the right or the left also appears.
Active Parking Assist only displays parking
spaces on the front-passenger side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side are
displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the
instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to reverse gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift into position R.
The Start Park Assist?Yes: OKNo:
% message appears in the multifunction
display .
X
Z
241
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
242
X
To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
Driving and parking
or
X
To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brakeObserve surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. When reversing, drive at a speed
below 10 km/h. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Active Parking Assist brakes the vehicle to
a standstill when the vehicle approaches
the rear border of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select DObserve
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage forward
gearObserve surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to first gear while the vehicle is stationary.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select transmission position D while the
vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brakeObserve surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Active Parking Assist brakes the vehicle to
a standstill when the vehicle approaches
the front border of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select RObserve
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage reverse
gearObserve surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears and a warning tone sounds. The
vehicle is now parked.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
vehicle is kept stationary without the driver
having to depress the brake pedal. The braking effect is cancelled when you depress the
accelerator pedal.
Active Parking Assist no longer supports you
with steering interventions and brake applications. When Active Parking Assist is finished, you must steer and brake again yourself. PARKTRONIC is still available.
Parking tips:
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also preselect transmission position D. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should
the transmission change take place too
early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible parking position can no longer be achieved from this position.
Exiting a parking space
In order that Active Parking Assist can support you when you exit the parking space:
Rthe
border of the parking space must be
high enough at the front and the rear. A
kerb stone is too small, for example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide, as the position of the vehicle must
not exceed an angle of 45° to the starting
position as it is manoeuvred into the parking space.
Ra manoeuvring distance of at least 1.0 m
must be available.
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle parallel to the direction of travel using
Active Parking Assist.
i If PARKTRONIC detects obstacles, Active
Parking Assist brakes automatically whilst
the vehicle exits the parking space. You are
responsible for braking in good time.
Start the engine.
Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction
you are pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position D or R.
X
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to forward or reverse gear.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To exit a parking space using Active
Parking Assist: press the a button on
the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Pull away, being ready to brake at all times.
Do not exceed a maximum speed of
approximately 10 km/h when exiting a
parking space. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
shift the transmission to position D or R.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
engage forward or reverse gear.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction. The Park Assist
active Accelerate and brake
Observe surroundings message appears
in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X
Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and
the Park Assist switched off message
Z
243
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
Driving and parking
244
appears in the multifunction display. You will
then have to steer and merge into traffic on
your own. PARKTRONIC is still available. You
can take over the steering before the vehicle
has exited the parking space completely. This
is useful, for example when you recognise
that it is already possible to pull out of the
parking space.
Reversing camera
General notes
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
X
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button
(Y page 238).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
electric parking brake is applied
position P is selected in vehicles with automatic transmission
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ÷ warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
disappears and the multifunction display
shows the Park Assist cancelled message.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer and brake again yourself.
If a system malfunction occurs, the vehicle is
braked to a standstill. To drive on, depress the
accelerator pedal again.
Rtransmission
Reversing camera : is in the boot lid handle.
Reversing camera : is an optical parking
and manoeuvring aid. It shows the area
behind your vehicle with guidelines in the
Audio 20/COMAND Online display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
i The text shown in the Audio 20/COMAND
Online display depends on the language
setting. The following are examples of
reversing camera messages in the
Audio 20/COMAND Online display.
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
the boot lid is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent bulbs or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rin
Driving systems
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed.
Observe the notes on cleaning
(Y page 401)
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the Activation by R
gear function is selected in Audio 20/
COMAND Online; see the Digital Owner's
Manual.
X Engage reverse gear.
The reversing camera flap opens. The area
behind the vehicle is shown with guide lines
in the Audio 20/COMAND Online display.
The image from the reversing camera is
available throughout the manoeuvring
process.
i The reversing camera is protected from
X
raindrops and dust by means of a flap.
When the reversing camera is activated,
this flap opens.
The flap closes again when:
Ryou have finished the manoeuvring proc-
ess
Ryou
switch off the engine
open the boot
Observe the notes on cleaning
(Y page 401).
For technical reasons, the flap may remain
open briefly after the reversing camera has
been deactivated.
Ryou
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
245
To change the function mode for vehicles with trailer tow hitch: using the
Audio 20/COMAND controller, select symbol : for the "Reverse parking" function or
symbol ; for "Coupling up a trailer".
The symbol of the selected function is highlighted.
Further information on the Audio 20/
COMAND controller, see the Digital Owner's
Manual.
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
Messages in the Audio 20/COMAND
Online display
The reversing camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
reversing camera in the following locations:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the tailgate
handle
Runder
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe
Z
Driving and parking
X
246
Driving systems
Rthe
rear section of an HGV
slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Driving and parking
Ra
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (locating aid)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
The guide lines are shown when the transmission is in position R.
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC: when
PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 237),
additional measurement operational readiness indicator ; appears in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display. If the PARKTRONIC
warning displays are active or light up, warning displays : and = are also active or light
up correspondingly in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display.
Driving systems
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approximately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 245).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide line :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide line : as a guide, carefully reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
Driving and parking
"Reverse parking" function
247
: Parking space marking
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 245).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking space until yellow guide line ; reaches
parking space marking :.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and reverse carefully.
X
: Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
Z
Driving systems
248
Driving and parking
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
"Coupling up a trailer" function
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position while the vehicle is stationary.
line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m
from the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
This function is only available on vehicles with
a trailer tow hitch.
X Before coupling up a trailer, set the height
of trailer drawbar ; so that it is slightly
higher than the ball coupling.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of
trailer drawbar ;.
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached
the end position.
Red guide line : is then at the end of parking space =. The vehicle is almost parallel
in the parking space.
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the ball coupling
; Trailer drawbar locating aid
= Trailer drawbar
? Symbol for the "Coupling up a trailer"
function
A Ball coupling
Driving systems
Wide-angle function
Object detection
The reversing camera helps detect moving
and stationary objects. If an object (person,
vehicle or other obstacle) is detected, this
object is marked with a bar. Objects located
some distance from the vehicle away are
marked with a yellow bar. If the distance to
the object is very small, the bar is displayed in
red.
Object detection only works in full screen
mode.
To ensure that you can use the function, it
must be switched on in Audio 20/COMAND
Online, see the separate operating instructions.
360° camera (surround view)
General notes
The 360° camera is a camera system that
consists of four cameras.
The system evaluates images from the following cameras:
Rreversing
camera
camera
Rtwo cameras in the exterior mirrors
The cameras cover the immediate surroundings of the vehicle. The system assists you,
e.g. when parking or at exits with reduced
visibility.
You can show pictures from the 360° camera
in full-screen mode or in seven different splitscreen views on the COMAND/Audio 20 display. A split-screen view also includes a top
view of the vehicle. This view is calculated
from the data supplied by the installed cameras (virtual camera).
The seven split-screen views are:
Rtop view and image from the reversing camera (130° viewing angle)
Rtop view and image from the front camera
(130° viewing angle without displaying the
maximum steering wheel angle)
Rtop view and enlarged rear view
Rfront
: Symbol for the wide-angle view function
; Own vehicle
= PARKTRONIC warning displays
You can also use the reversing camera to
select a wide-angle view.
When PARKTRONIC is operational
(Y page 237), a symbol for your own vehicle
appears in the Audio 20/COMAND Online
display. If the PARKTRONIC warning displays
are active, warning displays = light up in the
Audio 20/COMAND Online display in yellow
or red respectively.
Z
Driving and parking
Select symbol ? using the Audio 20/
COMAND controller, see the Audio 20/
COMAND Online operating instructions.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
apply to objects that are at the same level
as the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure that trailer
drawbar locating aid ; points approximately in the direction of trailer drawbar
=.
X Reverse carefully until trailer drawbar =
reaches red guide line.
The distance between the trailer drawbar
and the red guide line is now approximately
0.30 m.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 284).
X
249
250
Driving systems
Rtop
view and enlarged front view
view and trailer view (vehicles with
trailer tow hitch)
Rtop view and images from the rear-facing
mirror cameras (rear wheel view)
Rtop view and images from the forwardfacing mirror cameras (front wheel view)
When the function is active and you shift the
transmission from D or R to N, the guidelines
in the COMAND display are hidden.
When you change between transmission
positions D and R, you see the previously
selected front or rear view.
Driving and parking
Rtop
Important safety notes
The 360° camera is only an aid and may show
a distorted view of obstacles, show them
incorrectly or not at all. The 360° camera is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
You are responsible for safe manoeuvring and
parking. Make sure that there are no persons,
animals or objects in range while manoeuvring and parking.
You are always responsible for safety, and
must always pay attention to your surroundings when parking and manoeuvring. This
applies to the areas behind, in front of and
beside the vehicle. You could otherwise
endanger yourself and others.
The 360° camera will not function or will
function only in a limited manner:
Rif
the doors are open
the exterior mirrors are folded in
Rif the boot lid is open
Rin heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the cameras are exposed to very bright
light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent bulbs or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif the camera lenses mist up, e.g. when
driving into a heated garage in winter, causing a rapid change in temperature
Rif
Rif
the camera lenses are dirty or covered
the vehicle components in which the
cameras are fitted are damaged. In this
event, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not use the 360° camera in this case. You
could otherwise injure others or damage
objects when parking the vehicle.
Guide lines are always shown at road level.
In trailer mode, the guide lines are shown at
the level of the trailer coupling.
The camera in the rear area is protected by
means of a flap. This flap opens when the
360° camera is activated. Observe the notes
on cleaning (Y page 401). For technical reasons, the flap may remain open briefly after
the 360° camera has been deactivated.
Rif
Activation conditions
The 360° camera image can be displayed if:
RCOMAND
Online/Audio 20 is switched on,
see the Digital Owner's Manual
Rthe 360° camera function is switched on
i If the 360° camera is activated at speeds
above 30 km/h, a warning message
appears.
The warning message disappears if:
Rthe vehicle's speed falls below 30 km/h.
The 360° camera is then activated.
message is confirmed with the %
button.
Rthe
Driving systems
X
Press button :.
The following appears depending on
whether transmission position D or R is
selected:
Rfull-screen view with image from the
front camera
Rfull-screen view with image from the
reversing camera
i You can also switch to the split-screen
view from the full-screen view.
Activating the 360° camera using
COMAND Online
X
To select 360° camera in the carousel
menu: turn and press the controller.
The following appears depending on
whether transmission position D or R is
selected:
Ra split-screen with top view and the
image from the front camera or
Ra split-screen with top view and the
image from the reversing camera
Activating the 360° camera using
reverse gear
You can show images from the 360° camera
automatically by engaging reverse gear.
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Make sure that the Activation by R
gear function is selected in COMAND
Online, see the Digital Owner's Manual.
X To show the 360° camera image: engage
reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown in the
COMAND display in split-screen mode. You
see the top view of the vehicle and the
image from the reversing camera.
X
Selecting the split-screen and full
screen displays
Switching between split screen views:
To switch to the line with the vehicle icons:
slide Z V the controller.
X To select a vehicle icon: turn the controller.
X
Switching to full screen mode:
X
180° view Turn and press the controller.
i The full screen option is only available in
the following views:
RTop
view with image from the reversing
camera
RTop view with image from the front camera
Displays in the COMAND display
Important safety notes
The camera system may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
system in the following locations:
Runder
the front and rear bumpers
close to the front and rear bumpers
Rin the area immediately above the handle
on the boot lid
Rvery close to the exterior mirrors
Rin the transitional areas between the various cameras in the virtual top view
Rvery
Z
Driving and parking
Activating the 360° camera using the
function button
251
252
Driving systems
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Driving and parking
Rthe
Top view with image from the reversing
camera
B Vehicle centre axis (locating aid)
C Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
D Bumper
E Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
The guide lines are shown when the transmission is in position R.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
Top view with image from the front camera
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; Symbol for the split screen setting with
top view and reversing camera image
= Guide line for the maximum steering angle
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
A Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
: Symbol for the split screen setting with
top view and front camera image
; Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the front of the vehicle
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
Driving systems
imately 0.30 m from the front of the vehicle
B Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from the front of the vehicle
Top view with image from the mirror cameras
Driving and parking
A Red guide line at a distance of approx-
Top view and enlarged rear view
: Symbol for the top view and forward-
facing mirror camera setting
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
: Symbol for the split screen setting with
top view and reversing camera image
enlarged
; Red guide line at a distance of approximately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
This view assists you in estimating the distance to the vehicle behind you.
i This setting can also be selected as an
253
including the exterior mirror (right side of
vehicle)
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirror (left side of
vehicle)
i You can also select the mirror camera
setting for the rear-facing view.
"Coupling up a trailer" function
enlarged front view.
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide
line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m
from the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
= Red guide line at a distance of approximately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
Z
Driving systems
254
Set the height of trailer drawbar ; so that
it is slightly higher than the ball coupling.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of
trailer drawbar ;.
Driving and parking
X
Wide-angle function
: Symbol for the full-screen setting with the
reversing camera image
:
;
=
?
Symbol for the trailer view setting
Trailer drawbar locating aid
Ball coupling
Red guide line at a distance of approximately 0.30 m from the ball coupling
Select symbol : using the COMAND controller; see the COMAND Online operating
instructions.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
apply to objects that are at the same level
as the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure trailer drawbar locating aid ; points approximately in
the direction of the trailer drawbar.
X Reverse carefully until the trailer drawbar
reaches red guide line ?.
The distance between the trailer drawbar
and the red guide line is now approximately
0.30 m.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 284).
X
The lines are shown at the level of the trailer
coupling.
; Own vehicle
= PARKTRONIC warning displays
If the vehicle is equipped with PARKTRONIC
and the function is activated (Y page 238),
warning displays = in the COMAND display
are also active or light up accordingly.
PARKTRONIC appears as follows:
Ras
red or yellow brackets around the vehicle symbol in top view in split-screen mode
or
Rat the bottom right as red or yellow brackets around the vehicle symbol in full-screen
mode
i Full-screen mode can also be selected as
front view.
Select this view when you are driving out of an
exit and the view of crossing traffic is restricted, for example.
i To select split-screen view, select the
% symbol in the display, then confirm
with the COMAND controller.
Object detection
The 360° camera helps detect moving and
stationary objects. If an object (person, vehicle, other obstacle) is detected, this object is
marked with a bar. Objects located some distance from the vehicle away are marked with
a yellow bar. If the distance to the object is
very small, the bar is displayed in red.
Driving systems
Stopping the 360° camera display
As soon as the vehicle exceeds a speed of
30 km/h, the function switches off. The view
which was active before the 360° camera
was displayed appears in the COMAND display. You can also stop the 360° camera display from split-screen view by selecting the
% symbol in the display and then confirming with the COMAND controller.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
360° camera display is also ended if you
select transmission position P.
Rif
you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h
Rif you are driving with the active Steer
Assist of DISTRONIC PLUS
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
Ryou
switch off the engine
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break
Ryou
Displaying the attention level
ATTENTION ASSIST
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 60 km/h to
200 km/h range. If ATTENTION ASSIST
detects typical indicators of fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration on the part
of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration until too late, or may not detect them at
all. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the length of the journey is less than
approximately 30 minutes
Rif the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
You can have current status information displayed in the assistance menu (Y page 307)
of the on-board computer.
X Select the assistance graphics display for
ATTENTION ASSIST using the on-board
computer (Y page 306).
The following information is displayed:
Rthe
length of the journey since the last
break
Rthe attention level determined by ATTENTION ASSIST (Attention
Attention level),
level dis-
Z
Driving and parking
Object detection only functions in both fullscreen modes.
To ensure that you can use the function, it
must be switched on in COMAND Online (see
the separate operating instructions).
255
Driving systems
Driving and parking
256
played in a bar display in five levels from
high to low
RIf ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate
the attention level and cannot output a
warning, the System suspendedmessage
suspended
appears. The bar display then changes the
display, e.g. if you are driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h.
Activating ATTENTION ASSIST
X
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 309).
The system determines the attention level
of the driver depending on the setting
selected:
Selection Standard
Standard: the sensitivity with
which the system determines the attention
level is set to normal.
Selection Sensitive
Sensitive: the sensitivity is set
higher. The attention level detected by Attention Assist is adapted accordingly and the
driver is warned earlier.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
When ATTENTION ASSIST has been deactivated, it is automatically reactivated after the
engine has been stopped. The sensitivity
selected corresponds to the last selection
activated (standard/sensitive).
Warning in the multifunction display
If fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration are detected, a warning appears in the
multifunction display: ATTENTION ASSIST
Take a break!.
break!
In addition to the message shown in the multifunction display, you will then hear a warning tone.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Confirm the message by pressing the a
button on the steering wheel.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break and ATTENTION ASSIST
still detects increasing lapses in concentration, you will be warned again after
15 minutes at the earliest. This will only happen if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects typical
indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in
concentration.
If a warning is output in the multifunction display, a service station search is performed in
COMAND. You can select a service station
and navigation to this service station will then
begin. This function can be activated and
deactivated in COMAND.
Traffic Sign Assist
General notes
Traffic Sign Assist displays the maximum
speed permitted and overtaking restrictions
to the driver in the instrument cluster. Driving
onto a section of road in the wrong direction
triggers a warning. Traffic Sign Assist detects
traffic signs with camera system : attached
behind the top of the windscreen. The data
and general traffic regulations stored in the
navigation system are also used to determine
the current speed limit.
If a traffic sign that is relevant to your vehicle
is passed, the display of the speed limits and
overtaking restrictions is updated.
Driving systems
Rthe
vehicle changes roads (e.g. motorway
exit or slip road)
Ra village or town boundary is passed which
is stored in the digital map
Rthe last traffic sign detected by the camera
has not been repeated
If a sign indicating the end of a restriction
(speed limit or overtaking restriction) is
passed, the sign is displayed for five seconds.
The applicable traffic regulation then appears
in the instrument cluster.
The camera also detects traffic signs with a
restriction indicated by an additional sign
(e.g. in wet conditions).
The traffic signs are only displayed with the
restrictions if:
Rthe
regulation must be observed with the
restriction, or
RTraffic Sign Assist is unable to determine
whether the restriction applies
If Traffic Sign Assist is unable to determine a
maximum permitted speed from any of the
available sources, no speed limit is displayed
in the instrument cluster either.
always have priority over the Traffic Sign
Assist display.
The system may be either functionally
impaired or temporarily unavailable if:
Rvisibility
is poor, e.g. due to snow, rain, fog
or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun being low in
the sky
Rthere is dirt, ice or misting on the windscreen in the vicinity of the camera
Rtraffic signs are hard to detect (dirt, ice,
snow)
Rthe traffic signs are insufficiently lit at night
Rsigns are ambiguous (e.g. traffic signs on
construction sites or in adjacent lanes)
Rthe information in the digital street map of
the navigation system is incorrect or out of
date
Activating Traffic Sign Assist
X
Activate the Traffic Sign Assist display
using the on-board computer
(Y page 308).
If you have activated the display of Traffic
Sign Assist in the on-board computer, the
traffic regulations (speed limits and overtaking restrictions) are displayed in the instrument cluster. The wrong-way warning
remains active even when the display has
been deactivated.
Instrument cluster display
Speed limit with overtaking restriction
Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all countries. In this case, display : is shown in the
speedometer.
Important safety notes
Traffic Sign Assist is only an aid and is not
always able to correctly display speed limits
and overtaking restrictions. Traffic signs
Z
Driving and parking
The display can also be updated without a
visible traffic sign if:
257
258
Driving systems
A maximum permitted speed of 60 km/h
(60 mph) : and an overtaking restriction ;
apply.
Cancelling the overtaking restriction
Driving and parking
Speed limit with unknown restriction
: Maximum permitted speed
; Maximum permitted speed for vehicles
for which the restriction in the additional
sign is relevant
= Additional sign for unknown restriction
A maximum permitted speed of 60 km/h
(60 mph) : applies. The overtaking restriction no longer applies ;. The crossed-out no
overtaking traffic sign is displayed for five
seconds.
End of a speed limit
A maximum permitted speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) and a speed limit of 60 km/h
(60 mph) with an unknown restriction apply.
Speed limits in wet conditions
No speed limit : applies here.
i The unit for the speed limit (km/h or mph)
: Maximum permitted speed
; Additional signs for wet conditions
A maximum permitted speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) applies in wet conditions and when
Traffic Sign Assist has determined that the
restriction must be observed.
depends on the country in which you are
driving. It is generally neither shown on the
traffic sign nor on the instrument cluster
but must be taken into account when
observing the maximum permitted speed.
Driving systems
No entry (wrong-way warning)
259
Important safety notes
Rovertaken
If no entry signs or roundabout signs are
passed, warning message : is displayed in
the instrument cluster if Traffic Sign Assist
detects that you are driving in the wrong
direction. You will then also hear a warning
tone. You should immediately check your
direction of travel in order to avoid danger to
yourself and other road users.
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 259) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 261).
Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas on either
side of the vehicle that are not visible to the
driver with two lateral, rear-facing radar sensors. A warning display in the exterior mirrors
draws your attention to vehicles detected in
the monitored area. If you then switch on the
corresponding turn signal to change lanes,
you will also receive a visual and audible collision warning.
Blind Spot Assist supports you from a speed
of approximately 30 km/h.
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rwhen the difference in the speed of
approach and overtaking is too great
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in these situations. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is no substitute for
attentive driving. Always ensure that there is
sufficient distance to the side for other road
users and obstacles.
Radar sensors
The radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the rear bumper. Make sure
that the bumpers are free from dirt, ice or
slush. The sensors must not be covered, for
example by cycle racks or overhanging loads.
Following a severe impact or in the event of
damage to the bumpers, have the function of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist may no
longer work properly.
Monitoring range
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain,
snow or spray
Rnarrow vehicles, e.g. motorcycles or bicycles
Rvery wide lanes
Rnarrow lanes
Rvehicles not driving in the middle of their
lane
Rbarriers or other road boundaries
Rpoor
Z
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles:
260
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Warning display
: Warning display
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if there are vehicles at the edge of
their lane nearest your vehicle.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time
The two radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist
are integrated into the sides of the rear
bumper. Make sure that the bumper is free of
dirt, ice or slush in the vicinity of the sensors.
The sensors must not be covered, for example by cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have the function of the
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise
not work properly.
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning
always lights up when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
If you select the reverse gear, Blind Spot
Assist is not operational.
The brightness of the warning lamps is automatically adapted to the brightness of the
surroundings.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Driving systems
Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Display in the assistance graphic
When Blind Spot Assist is activated, grey
radar waves propagating backwards appear
next to the vehicle in the assistance display in
the multifunction display. Above a speed of
30 km/h, the colour of the radar waves in the
assistance display changes to green ;. Blind
Spot Assist is then ready for use.
Towing a trailer
If you couple up a trailer, make sure that you
have correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking the trailer lighting. Blind Spot Assist is
then deactivated. The Blind Spot Assist
not available when towing a trailer
See Owner's Manual message appears in
the multifunction display.
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of camera :
at the top of the windscreen. Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
can warn you before you leave your lane unintentionally.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration through the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
identify lane markings.
In these cases, Lane Keeping Assist may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep in lane, especially if Lane
Keeping Assist alerts you.
Rnot
G WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist warning does not
return the vehicle to the original lane. There is
a risk of an accident.
Z
Driving and parking
Activating Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 309) is activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red until the engine is started.
261
262
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Always steer, apply the brakes or accelerate
the vehicle yourself, especially if Lane Keeping Assist alerts you.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. Lane
Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front,
for vehicle speed, for braking in good time,
and for staying in lane.
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : lights up. The Lane
Keeping Assist onmessage
on
appears in
the multifunction display. If all conditions
have been satisfied, there may be a warning.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lines in the
assistance graphic display (Y page 306)
are shown in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
X To deactivate: press button ;.
Indicator lamp : goes out. Lane Keeping
Assist is deactivated. The Lane Keeping
Assist offmessage
off
appears in the multifunction display.
X
Selecting Standard or Adaptive setting
In the Assistance menu on the on-board
computer, select the Lane Keeping
Assist function (Y page 309).
X Select Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X
Standard
When Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Adaptive
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
Driving Assistance PLUS package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance PLUS package
consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 222),
Active Blind Spot Assist (Y page 263) and
Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 266).
Active Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas
on either side of the vehicle that are not visible to the driver with two lateral, rear-facing
radar sensors. A warning display in the exterior mirrors draws your attention to vehicles
detected in the monitored area. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lanes, you will also receive a visual
and audible collision warning. If a risk of side
impact is detected, corrective braking may
help you avoid a collision. Active Blind Spot
Assist evaluates the free space in the direction of travel and to the side before making a
course-correcting brake application. For this,
Active Blind Spot Assist uses the forwardfacing radar sensors.
Active Blind Spot Assist supports you from a
speed of approximately 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not react to
vehicles:
Rovertaking
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rif the difference in the speed of approach
and overtaking is too great
As a result, Active Blind Spot Assist may neither give warnings nor intervene in such situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Radar sensors
The Active Blind Spot Assist radar sensors are
integrated into the front and rear bumpers
and behind a cover in the radiator grille. Make
sure that the bumpers and the cover in the
radiator grille are free of dirt, ice or slush. The
rear sensors must not be covered, e.g. by
bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following
a severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise no longer function properly.
Z
263
Driving and parking
Driving systems
264
Driving systems
Monitoring range
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not detect all
traffic situations and road users. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always make sure that there is sufficient distance to the side for other traffic or obstacles.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time
Warning display
: Warning display
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to 3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next
to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
The detection of vehicles may be impaired in
the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
visibility, e.g. due to rain, snow or
spray
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or may only detect them too late.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if there are vehicles at the edge of
their lane nearest your vehicle.
Rpoor
Active Blind Spot Assist is not operational at
speeds below approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning lamp
always lights up when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
If you select the reverse gear, Active Blind
Spot Assist is not operational.
The brightness of the warning lamps is automatically adapted to the brightness of the
surroundings.
When Active Blind Spot Assist is activated,
grey radar waves propagating backwards
appear next to the vehicle in the assistance
display in the multifunction display. Above a
speed of 30 km/h, the colour of the radar
waves in the assistance display changes to
green ;. Active Blind Spot Assist is then
ready for use.
Visual and acoustic collision warning
If you switch on the turn signals to change
lanes and a vehicle is detected in the side
monitoring range, you receive a visual and
acoustic collision warning. You will then hear
a double warning tone and red warning
lamp : flashes. If the turn signal remains on,
detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Course-correcting brake application
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a
side impact in the monitoring range, a coursecorrecting brake application is carried out.
This is designed to help you avoid a collision.
G WARNING
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Blind Spot Assist warns
you or makes a course-correcting brake application. Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
If a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and a dual warning tone
sounds. In addition, display ; underlining
the danger of a side collision appears in the
multifunction display.
In very rare cases, the system may make an
inappropriate brake application. A coursecorrecting brake application may be interrupted at any time if you steer slightly in the
opposite direction or accelerate.
The course-correcting brake application is
available in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h.
Either a course-correcting brake application
appropriate to the driving situation, or none at
all, may occur if:
Rthere
are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the
side
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake
RESP® is deactivated
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
detected
Z
265
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
266
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that Active Blind Spot Assist is
activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 309).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds.
Grey radar waves propagating backwards
appear next to the vehicle in the assistance
display in the multifunction display.
Driving and parking
X
Towing a trailer
If you couple up a trailer, make sure that you
have correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking the trailer lighting. Active Blind Spot Assist
is then deactivated. The radar waves next to
the vehicle are hidden in the assistance display. The Active Blind Spot Assist not
available when towing a trailer See
Owner's Manual message appears in the
multifunction display.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
a lane-correcting application of the brakes
can bring the vehicle back into the original
lane.
If you select km in the Display unit
Speed-/odometer: function on the on-board
computer (Y page 312), Active Lane Keeping
Assist is activated starting at a speed of
60 km/h. If the miles display unit is selected,
the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Active
Lane Keeping Assist can neither reduce the
risk of an accident nor override the laws of
physics. Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot
take account of road and weather conditions.
It may not recognise traffic situations. Active
Lane Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot continuously keep your vehicle in its lane.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot always
clearly detect lane markings.
In such cases, Active Lane Keeping Assist
can:
Rgive
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of camera
system : at the top of the windscreen. Various areas to the front, rear and side of your
vehicle are also monitored with the aid of the
radar sensor system. Active Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
can warn you before you leave your lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the warning,
an unnecessary warning and then
make a course-correcting brake application
to the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep within the lane, especially
if Active Lane Keeping Assist alerts you. Terminate the intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rif the radar sensors in the front or rear
bumpers or the radiator grille are dirty, e.g.
obscured by snow
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
If no vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane
and broken lane markings are detected, no
lane-correcting brake application is made.
Warning vibration through the steering
wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration in the steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Lane-correcting brake application
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is intended to help you return the
vehicle to the original lane.
G WARNING
A lane-correcting brake application cannot
always bring the vehicle back into the original
lane. There is a risk of an accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Lane Keeping Assist warns
you or makes a lane-correcting brake application.
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
display : appears in the multifunction display. The brake application also slightly
reduces driving speed.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A lane-correcting brake application can be
made after driving over a lane marking recognised as being solid or broken. Before this,
a warning must have been issued by means of
intermittent vibration through the steering
wheel. In addition, a lane with lane markings
on both sides must be recognised.
In the case of a broken lane marking being
detected, a lane-correcting brake application
can only be made if a vehicle has been detected in the adjacent lane. Oncoming vehicles,
overtaking vehicles and vehicles in adjacent
lanes can be detected.
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
Z
267
Driving and parking
Driving systems
268
Driving systems
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
Ryou
Driving and parking
clearly and actively steer, brake or
accelerate
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend
Ryou have switched on the turn signal
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
RESP® is deactivated
Rthe transmission is not in position D
Ron vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the
electrical connection to the trailer has been
correctly established
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed
Ran obstacle in the lane in which you are
driving has been detected
Active Lane Keeping Assist may not detect
other road users or traffic situations. An inappropriate brake application may be interrupted at any time if:
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
Ryou
steer slightly in the opposite direction
switch on the turn signal
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ryou
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
Rlane markings are no longer detected
Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : lights up. The Lane
Keeping Assist onmessage
on
appears in
the multifunction display. If all conditions
have been satisfied, a warning or steering
intervention may be made.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lines in the
assistance graphic display (Y page 306)
are shown in green. Active Lane Keeping
Assist is ready for use.
X To deactivate: press button ;.
Indicator lamp : goes out. Active Lane
Keeping Assist is deactivated. The Lane
Keeping Assist offmessage
off
appears in
the multifunction display.
X
Selecting Standard or Adaptive setting
In the Assistance menu on the on-board
computer, select the Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist function (Y page 309).
X Select Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
When Standard is selected, no warning
vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning
vibration occurs if:
X
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes.
Ryou cut the corner on a bend.
Towing a trailer
If you couple up a trailer, make sure that you
have correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking the trailer lighting.
Hybrid operation
Points to remember
General notes
Hybrid technology combines a fuel efficient
internal combustion engine with a powerful
electric motor. The hybrid system automatically selects the most efficient operating
mode for every driving situation. Drive the
vehicle in the usual manner.
To save fuel, the hybrid system switches off
the combustion engine as often as possible
during the journey when power output
requirements are low. When power output
requirements are low, the electric motor powers the vehicle. When power output requirements are high, the combustion engine is
switched on, even during a journey. When the
vehicle is stationary, the combustion engine
is usually switched off. Consequently, there is
usually no engine idling as with combustion
engine vehicles.
For pulling away and accelerating, the electric
motor supports the internal combustion
engine using the power stored in the highvoltage battery. In addition, the power is used
for partially electric driving, operation of the
electric coolant compressor and to support
the 12 V on-board electrical system. In this
way the hybrid drive helps to reduce your
vehicle's fuel consumption.
Observe the driving tips on hybrid operation
(Y page 278).
RBS (Recuperative Brake System)
If you release the accelerator pedal when the
vehicle is in motion, overrun recuperation is
initiated. The electric motor is operated as a
generator when in overrun mode and when
you brake. Hybrid technology converts the
kinetic energy of the vehicle into electricity
and stores it in the high-voltage battery.
Important safety notes
All of the vehicle's systems remain active, if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary,
combustion engine is switched off and
Rthe READY-indicator in the instrument cluster is lit.
If you remove your foot from the brake pedal
while in transmission position D or R, the
vehicle could pull away automatically.
Observe the notes on the READY display of
the ECO start/stop function (Y page 279).
Vehicles with an electric motor generate significantly less noise than vehicles with internal combustion engines. As a result, in certain
Rthe
Z
269
Driving and parking
Hybrid operation
Driving and parking
270
Hybrid operation
situations your vehicle may not be heard by
other road users. This is the case, for example, when you are parking and your vehicle is
not seen by other road users.
This requires you to adopt a particularly anticipatory driving style, as it is necessary to allow
for the possibility that other road users may
behave unpredictably.
Hybrid operation
271
Driving and parking
Hybrid system overview
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
Recuperative Brake System
12 V battery
High-voltage battery
Electric cables for the high-voltage electrical system
High-voltage battery cooling
Electric refrigerant compressor
Power electronics cooling
Electric vacuum pump
Transmission with electric motor
Power electronics (DC/AC converter or DC/DC converter)
You can deactivate the hybrid system manually. For further information on the high-voltage
disconnect device, see (Y page 43).
Z
272
Hybrid operation
Driving and parking
Instrument cluster
: Charge level display for high-voltage battery (Y page 273)
; RBS warning lamp (Y page 362)
= Electric motor power display (Y page 272)
Displays and operation
Electric motor power display
Coolant temperature display for a combustion engine
You can call up the coolant temperature using
the on-board computer.
X Use Ñ on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Coolant.
Coolant
The electric motor power display is on the
right-hand side of the instrument cluster.
The current charge level of the high-voltage
battery is shown as a percentage in charge
level display A. 100% corresponds to the
highest possible charge level of the high-voltage battery.
There are two further areas located to the left
and right of charge level display A:
RArea
: to ; (E-DRIVE):
Hybrid operation
Operating the on-board computer
You can display the current operating condition of the hybrid system in the multifunction
display and the COMAND display
(Y page 273).
You can display the current operating condition of the hybrid system in the multifunction
display and the Audio 20/COMAND Online
display (Y page 273).
In the Audio 20/COMAND Online display, you
can also call up a graphic display of the fuel
consumption and generated electricity
(Y page 276).
Menus and submenus
Selecting messages in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display
Press the Ø button on the controller.
The vehicle menu appears.
X To select Energy flow
flow: turn and press the
controller.
The energy flow is displayed.
X To select Consumption
Consumption: turn and press the
controller.
Fuel consumption and the electric energy
generated are displayed.
X To exit the display: press the % button
on the controller.
X
Selecting the energy flow display in the
multifunction display
Use Ñ on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select Energy flow.
flow
The energy flow is displayed.
X
Energy flow display
Overview
: Internal combustion engine
; Electric motor
= Charge status of the high-voltage battery
Z
Driving and parking
This shows the electric output from the
electric motor, e.g. when driving using the
electric motor or in boost mode.
When the motor is switched on, the display
is at :. When driving solely on electricity,
the display fills up from : to ; depending
on the power output demanded as a result
of pressing the accelerator pedal.
If the display has reached limit ;, additional power output can only be provided by
the combustion engine. The combustion
engine starts. If the display is approaching
limit ; and you remove your foot from the
accelerator pedal, the display empties
again. The combustion engine is not
switched on. At low speeds, you can
thereby control the electric drive usage so
that you only drive in electric mode.
RArea = to ? (CHARGE):
This shows the recuperated energy which is
stored in the high-voltage battery as electrical energy.
When the display reaches limit ?, the maximum recuperative braking power has been
exhausted. The conventional brakes are
activated.
273
274
Hybrid operation
Driving and parking
? High-voltage battery
A Energy flow
The active hybrid components are highlighted.
The energy flow is indicated by arrows. The
arrows have a different colour depending on
the operating state:
The combustion engine is running while the
vehicle is stationary. The high-voltage battery
is not being charged.
The arrows for the energy flow are not shown.
The combustion engine is highlighted.
Charging while the vehicle is stationary
RGreen:
energy recuperation
normal energy consumption
RRed: increased energy consumption, provided by the vehicle's high-voltage electrical
system
RWhite:
Automatic engine switch-off
The internal combustion engine drives the
electric motor. The electric motor is operating
as an alternator. The high-voltage battery is
charging.
The arrow representing energy flow is shown
in white.
The internal combustion engine and the electric motor are switched off.
The arrows for the energy flow are not shown.
The combustion engine is shown in dark grey.
The charge status of the high-voltage battery
is shown when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving using the internal combustion
engine
Engine running while the vehicle is stationary
The internal combustion engine powers the
vehicle.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
white.
Hybrid operation
If you rapidly depress the accelerator, the
electric motor supports the internal combustion engine by providing additional torque.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
red.
Driving using the internal combustion
engine and energy recuperation
Driving using the internal combustion
engine and charging the high-voltage battery
The internal combustion engine powers the
vehicle. The internal combustion engine also
drives the electric motor. The electric motor
is operating as an alternator. The high-voltage
battery is charging.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
white.
Driving using the electric motor
The internal combustion engine powers the
vehicle.
The electric motor is being operated as an
alternator, e.g. in overrun mode and when
braking (Y page 279). The kinetic energy of
the vehicle is converted into electrical energy.
The high-voltage battery is charging.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
green.
The electric motor powers the vehicle. The
high-voltage battery supplies the electric
motor with electrical energy.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
green.
Z
Driving and parking
Driving using the internal combustion
engine and boost mode
275
276
Hybrid operation
Driving and parking
Driving using the electric motor and
charging the high-voltage battery
The electric motor is being operated as an
alternator, e.g. in overrun mode and when
braking. The kinetic energy of the vehicle is
converted into electrical energy. The highvoltage battery is charging.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
green. The combustion engine is shown in
dark grey.
Displaying the total range
Displaying fuel consumption and generated electrical energy
: Fuel consumption
; Electrical energy generated
Every bar of the graph displays the average
value for one minute.
Fuel consumption indicator : may differ
from the indicator in the From start trip
computer in the Trip menu.
To reset values: the values are reset along
with the From start trip computer
(Y page 299).
X To select Consumption
Consumption: turn and press the
controller.
The Audio 20/COMAND Online display
shows fuel consumption : and electrical
energy generated ; for the last
15 minutes driven.
Starting the engine
READY indicator
The approximate range is based on the current driving style.
X Use Ñ on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press : or 9 to select the approximate total range.
X
X
Switch the ignition on.
Depress the brake pedal.
Hybrid operation
Noiseless start
The vehicle starts in electric mode without the
internal combustion engine. The internal
combustion engine starts only after the
power demanded by the driver exceeds the
available power that the electric motor can
currently provide.
Noiseless start operation is dependent on the
outside temperature and the operating temperature of the internal combustion engine.
The vehicle is operational when READY indicator : lights up.
Rthe
availability of the ECO start/stop function (Y page 279)
Rthe climate control settings
- THERMATIC (Y page 153)
- THERMOTRONIC (Y page 156)
Rthe rear window heating operation period
(Y page 164)
Rthe performance of the seat heating
(Y page 123)
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, drive program C is activated when the
engine is next started.
Pulling away
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the brake pedal.
X
Further information on pulling away
(Y page 184).
Driving
AGILITY SELECT switch
Driving programs
Use the AGILITY SELECT switch to change the
drive program. Depending on the drive program selected, the following vehicle characteristics will change:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
X
Push AGILITY SELECT switch : up or down
until the desired drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds
the display goes out and the status icon of
the selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings are displayed in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display.
Available drive programs:
I Individual
Individual settings
S+ Sport Plus
RExtremely sporty driving
style with boost mode
RElectric-only drive is not
possible
ECO start/stop
function is not available
RThe
Z
Driving and parking
Observe the notes on starting the engine
(Y page 183).
X Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock (Y page 183) or press the Start/Stop
button once (Y page 184).
The vehicle is operational when READY indicator : lights up.
X
277
Hybrid operation
278
S Sport
boost mode
Driving and parking
RElectric-only drive is not
possible
RThe ECO start/stop
function is not available
C Comfort
E Eco
RComfortable,
economical driving style
RElectric-only drive is
possible
RThe ECO start/stop
function is available
RParticularly
economical
driving style
RElectric operation mode
is used as often as possible
RThe ECO start/stop
function is available
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 197).
Using the steering wheel gearshift paddles,
you can temporarily change gear yourself.
Further information on the manual drive program (Y page 278).
Manual gearshifting
Using the steering wheel gearshift paddles,
you can temporarily change gear yourself.
The transmission must be in position D. Electric-only operation is not possible when manually changing gear.
Activating when driving with the electric
motor:
X
ing is not active switches to overrun mode
(Y page 280).
RSporty driving style with
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 198).
The combustion engine is switched on.
Manual gearshifting is activated temporarily. The selected gear and M appear in the
multifunction display.
Pulling on the right-hand steering wheel
gearshift paddle when manual gear chang-
Activating when driving with the combustion
engine:
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 198).
Manual gearshifting is activated temporarily. The selected gear and M appear in the
multifunction display.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when manually changing gear.
Further information on the manual drive program (Y page 198).
Driving tips
General driving tips
Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance from the vehicle in front. Avoid frequent
and sudden acceleration as well as abrupt
braking.
During partially electric driving, pulling away
and acceleration, the electric motor supports
the internal combustion engine.
During overrun in transmission position D and
braking, the electric motor operates as an
alternator.
To reduce fuel consumption, use:
Rrecuperative
braking (Y page 269)
mode (Y page 280) or extended
overrun mode (Y page 280)
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function; see (Y page 279).
Additional driving tips (Y page 211).
Roverrun
Stationary vehicle
If the vehicle is stopped, the combustion
engine is, for the most part, switched off.
Automatic climate control continues to function. The electro-mechanically assisted steering gear allows use of the power steering
without loss of comfort.
Hybrid operation
Rentirely
by electric propulsion
Rin combination with the internal combustion engine
When accelerating at an increased or full
load, boost mode is utilised. The electric
motor supports the internal combustion
engine by providing additional torque when
the accelerator is depressed rapidly.
Overrun mode or braking
There are three possible operating modes
when the hybrid vehicle is decelerating:
RWhen
coasting and decelerating, energy
recuperation is already taking place
(Y page 269). The electric motor functions
as an alternator and stores the recuperated
energy in the high-voltage battery.
RWhen braking gently, the electric motor
increases the deceleration of the vehicle.
Energy recuperation is increased
(Y page 269). The electric motor functions
as an alternator and stores the recuperated
energy in the high-voltage battery.
RDuring heavy braking, the service brake is
also used to slow down the vehicle. Both
systems work together.
Driving in the city
Energy is recuperated during frequent deceleration and stopping in city traffic.
The vehicle can be driven by the electric
motor alone up to a speed of approximately
35 km/h, e.g.:
Rwhile
approaching a traffic light
stop-and-start traffic
The vehicle is driven by the electric motor
alone only when all conditions for the automatic engine switch-off are fulfilled.
Further information on the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 280).
Driving on inter-urban roads
Three phases are possible when driving on
inter-urban roads:
Rrapid
acceleration (boost mode)
energy consumption
Renergy recuperation
Depending on the characteristics of the
route, there may be a lot of recuperated
energy available. This reduces consumption
and emissions.
Rconstant
Driving on the motorway
When driving on a motorway, the following
have a particularly positive effect on fuel consumption and emissions:
Rthe
decrease in wasted power when using
recuperative braking
Rthe decrease in wasted power in overrun
mode when the combustion engine is
switched off
Manoeuvring and turning
The hybrid drive makes it possible to manoeuvre and turn solely using the electric motor.
ECO start/stop function
General notes
The ECO start/stop function switches the
internal combustion engine off automatically
when the vehicle stops moving and at high
speeds (Y page 280).
All vehicle systems remain active, e.g. the
automatic climate control.
The ECO start/stop function is only available
in drive programs C, E and I. Electric-only
operation is only possible in drive programs C
and E.
Rin
Z
Driving and parking
Acceleration
Depending on the operating mode, pulling
away and driving under low load conditions
are performed:
279
280
Hybrid operation
Automatic engine switch-off
The internal combustion engine is switched
off automatically if:
has reached the lower limit
settings of the automatic climate control require it, e.g. at external temperatures
above 30 †
Rthe
Rthe
Driving and parking
driver removes his foot from the accelerator pedal and a speed of 160 km/h is
not exceeded (Y page 280)
Rthe combustion engine and the transmission have reached operating temperature
Rthe driver's seat belt is fastened and the
driver's door is closed
Rthe driver only slightly depresses the accelerator pedal in order to, for example, maintain the current speed for a limited distance
Rthe bonnet is closed and engaged properly
Rthe high-voltage battery is charged sufficiently
Rthere are no faults in the hybrid system
The internal combustion engine will not be
switched off automatically, if:
Rthe charge level of the high-voltage battery
Rthe
self-diagnosis function of the engine
control unit is still active
Rthe climate control of the vehicle requires it
Rthe high-voltage battery is being charged
(Y page 274)
Rautomatic emissions tests are running
Rthe operating temperature of the engine,
transmission and catalytic converter has
not yet been reached
Automatic engine start
The internal combustion engine, which has
been automatically switched-off, starts automatically in certain situations, when:
Rthe
power demand from the driver via the
accelerator pedal is greater than the electric motor alone can provide
Rthe driver switches to drive program S or S
+
Rthe driver has activated manual gearshifting
Overrun mode
This operating mode is available in the speed
range below 160 km/h.
The combustion engine is switched off and is
disconnected from the drive train.
The electric motor:
Rsimulates an overrun torque which is equiv-
alent to the overrun torque of the combustion engine
Rfunctions as a generator and produces the
necessary energy for the auxiliary consumers and charges the high-voltage battery
Extended overrun mode
Overrun mode allows you to increase the
vehicle range.
When the vehicle is in overrun operating
mode:
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
Energy recuperation is reduced to the minimal amount of energy required. The vehicle rolls faster and further, e.g. on long and
steep downhill gradients or while coasting
towards a set of traffic lights.
You can see the reduction in energy recuperation in the electric motor CHARGE display
(Y page 272).
The "extended overrun" operating mode is
deactivated again if:
Rthe
Ryou
combustion engine starts
depress the brake pedal
Hybrid operation
281
Parking
Apply the electric parking brake.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to shift the
automatic transmission to P.
X Switch the ignition off.
The READY indicator in the instrument cluster goes out.
Driving and parking
X
Further information on parking and switching
off the internal combustion engine
(Y page 208).
Z
282
Hybrid operation
Problems with hybrid operation
Internal combustion engine
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot start the
For example, the self-diagnosis is not yet complete or the hybrid
internal combustion
system is malfunctioning.
engine. The multifunc- X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
tion display shows no X
Try to start the internal combustion engine again.
display messages. The
If
the
internal combustion engine still does not start:
READY indicator in the
multifunction display is X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
off.
You wish to pull away, The ECO start/stop function has failed. The warning and indicator
but the ECO start/stop lamps in the instrument cluster light up.
function does not start X Move the transmission selector lever to P.
the internal combusX Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
tion engine. The READY
X Start the engine.
indicator in the multifunction display is off.
The hybrid system is malfunctioning.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hybrid system
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The hybrid system was You have been in an accident.
deactivated automati- The hybrid system remains deactivated if:
cally.
Rthe internal combustion engine cannot be restarted after a few
seconds.
Rthe red SRS warning lamp 6 in the instrument cluster is lit.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The hybrid system was An electrical short circuit has occurred in the hybrid system or an
deactivated automati- electrical connection has been disconnected.
cally. The multifunction X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display also shows a
display (Y page 314).
display message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination if it begins to swerve. The vehicle/trailer combination could even overturn.
There is a risk of an accident.
On no account should you attempt to
straighten out the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing speed. Decrease your
speed and do not countersteer. Brake if necessary.
G WARNING
If the maximum the permissible load for a carrier system is exceeded, the carrier could
come loose from the vehicle and endanger
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Never exceed the permissible noseweight
when using a carrier.
Exceeding the maximum permissible noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling may cause damage to the following:
Ryour
vehicle
Rthe trailer
Rthe ball coupling
Rthe trailer tow hitch
The vehicle/trailer combination could
become unstable.
If the noseweight used is lower than the minimum permissible noseweight, the vehicle/
trailer combination could also become unstable.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rmake
sure to check the noseweight before
each journey.
Ruse a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum noseweight.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
noseweight.
Rdo not use a noseweight lower than the
minimum permissible trailer drawbar noseweight.
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
The applicable permissible values, which
must not be exceeded, can be found:
Rthe
Rin
your vehicle documents
Ron the identification plates of the trailer tow
hitch and the trailer
the vehicle identification plate
If the values differ, the lowest value applies.
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates
and those for the towing vehicle under "Technical data" (Y page 478).
Ron
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Z
Driving and parking
Towing a trailer
283
284
Towing a trailer
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
Driving and parking
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Ris
heavier
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Rhas an increased braking distance
Ris affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands more sensitive steering
Rhas a larger turning circle
This can impair the vehicle's handling characteristics. Adapt your driving style accordingly. Maintain a safe distance. Drive carefully.
When towing a trailer, always adjust your
speed to the current road and weather conditions. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed for your vehicle/trailer combination.
Ris
Notes on towing a trailer
General notes
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RC
180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
220 BlueTEC BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
When towing a trailer, set the tyre pressure on
the rear axle of the towing vehicle for a maximum load; see the tyre pressure table in the
fuel filler flap (Y page 432).
RC
On vehicles without level control, the height
of the ball coupling will alter according to the
load placed on the vehicle. If necessary, use a
trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
You will find fitting dimensions and loads
under "Technical data" (Y page 477).
When towing a trailer, the ECO start/stop
function is deactivated. The è ECO symbol appears yellow in the multifunction display. For further information on the ECO
start/stop function; see (Y page 186).
Driving tips
Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation (Y page 82).
The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations depends on the type of
trailer. Before beginning the journey, check
the trailer's documents to see what the maximum permitted speed is. Observe the legally
prescribed maximum speed in the relevant
country.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. See the "Technical
data" section to find out whether this applies
to your vehicle (Y page 478). If you utilise any
of the added maximum rear axle load when
towing a trailer, the vehicle/trailer combination may not exceed a maximum speed of
100 km/h for reasons concerning the operating permit. This also applies in countries in
which the permissible maximum speed for
vehicle/trailer combinations is above
100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer and it will
consume more fuel.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients.
This also applies if cruise control, DISTRONIC
PLUS or SPEEDTRONIC are activated.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
Towing a trailer
285
Driving tips
If the trailer swings from side to side:
Do not accelerate.
Do not countersteer.
X Brake if necessary.
X
X
RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle in
front than when driving without a trailer.
braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then, increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradientclimbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
X
X
RAvoid
Open the boot lid.
Pull release knob : until the ball coupling
unlocks.
The ball coupling folds out from under the
rear bumper.
The indicator lamp on the release knob
flashes. The trailer socket folds away automatically.
Folding out the ball coupling
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not correctly engaged,
the trailer can detach. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always engage the ball coupling as described.
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
The indicator lamp on the release knob
goes off.
The multifunction display shows the
Trailer hitch Check lock mech. message until the ball coupling is engaged.
X Remove the protective covering from the
ball coupling and store it in a safe place.
X
Hybrid vehicles: observe the safety instructions for hybrid vehicles (Y page 269).
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly. If you
need additional braking, depress the brake
pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.
Towing a trailer
286
Coupling up a trailer
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Position the trailer horizontally behind the
vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electric connection between
the vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is
working.
X Push the combination switch upwards/
downwards and check whether the corresponding turn signal on the trailer is flashing.
A connected trailer is only recognised when
the electrical connection is established
correctly and when the lighting system is
working properly. The functioning of other
systems, e.g. ESP®, PARKTRONIC, Active
Parking Assist, Active Blind Spot Assist or
Lane Keeping Assist also depends on this.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise, your
vehicle could be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun brake.
Driving and parking
X
Uncoupling a trailer
G WARNING
If you uncouple a trailer with an engaged overrun brake, you could trap your hand between
the vehicle and the trailer drawbar. This poses
a risk of injury.
Do not uncouple a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake.
G WARNING
Vehicles with level control:
If you disconnect the trailer cable, the vehicle
is lowered. This can cause you or others to
become trapped between the vehicle body
and tyres, or underneath the vehicle. This
poses a risk of injury.
Make sure that no-one is in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arch or underneath the
vehicle when disconnecting the trailer cable.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
X
Folding in the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Fold the ball coupling back in if you are not
using the trailer tow hitch.
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
the trailer cables are disconnected.
X Place the protective covering on the ball
coupling.
X Open the boot lid.
Towing a trailer
287
X
Pull release knob : until the ball coupling
unlocks.
The ball coupling folds down from under the
rear bumper. The indicator lamp on the
release knob flashes.
Do not attempt to speed this process up by
applying additional pressure with your foot.
The system could otherwise be mechanically damaged.
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket is equipped with a permanent
power supply and a power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
You can find more information about fitting
the trailer electrics at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X To switch the connected power supply
on or off: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or 0 respectively (Y page 181).
Bulb failure indicator for LED lamps
X
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages audibly behind
the bumper.
The indicator lamp on the release knob
goes out and the message in the multifunction display disappears.
Trailer power supply
! You can connect accessories with a
power rating of up to 240 W to the permanent power supply and with a power rating
of up to 180 W to the power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, an error
message may appear in the multifunction display even if there is no fault. The reason for
the error message may be that the current
has fallen below the minimum of 50 mA.
To ensure reliable operation of the bulb failure
indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting
must be guaranteed a minimum current of
50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General notes
Trailer with 7-pin connector: you can connect to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling
using an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter
cable. Both can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
The trailer battery may not be charged from
the power supply.
Towing a trailer
288
Fitting the adapter
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
Driving and parking
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
Open the socket cover.
Insert the plug connector with lug : into
groove = on the socket. Turn bayonet connection ; clockwise to the stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
Towing a trailer
289
Problems with trailer towing
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The released ball coupling cannot be
engaged.
X
Driving and parking
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The ball coupling does The on-board voltage is insufficient.
not unlock, even
X Start the engine.
though:
If the ball coupling still does not unlock:
Rthe vehicle is stationX Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ary
Rno trailer cable is
connected
Rthe release knob to
unlock the ball coupling has been pulled
for more than a second.
Z
290
Useful information ............................ 292
Important safety notes ..................... 292
Displays and operation ..................... 292
Menus and submenus ...................... 297
Display messages ............................. 314
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................ 351
On-board computer and displays
291
On-board computer and displays
292
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
times. Otherwise, a vehicle that is not operating safely may cause an accident.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle safely as soon as
possible. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
For an overview, see the instrument cluster
illustration (Y page 34).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using brightness control
knob :.
X Turn brightness control knob : up or
down.
If the light switch (Y page 137) is set to
Ã, T or L the brightness is
dependent upon the brightness of the
ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are illuminated. A dimming function
is not possible in daylight.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RCruise
control activated (Y page 216):
The segments light up from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 219):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 222):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The analogue coolant temperature gauge is in
the instrument cluster on the right-hand side
(Y page 34).
In the on-board computer in the Service
menu there is a digital coolant temperature
gauge (Y page 307).
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
Bear in mind that the outside temperature
display indicates the temperature measured
and does not record the road temperature.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 295).
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Z
293
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
294
Operating the on-board computer
9
:
Press and hold:
RRapid
scrolling in all lists
the Radio
Radio/Media
Media menu:
selects a station, audio track or
video scene using rapid scrolling
RIn the Telephone menu: starts
rapid scrolling if the phone book
is open
RIn
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= Left control panel
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
Vehicles with manual transmission: if you
remove the key then quickly re-insert it and
turn to position 1, the on-board computer/
instrument cluster is not activated.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Left control panel
ò
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
up a main menu
RScrolls
through lists
a menu or function
RIn the Radio
Radio/Media
Media menu:
opens the track or station list
and selects an audio track or
video scene
RIn the Telephone menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or a telephone
number
RSelects
a
all menus: confirms the selected entry in the list
RIn the Radio
Radio/Media
Media menu:
opens the list of available radio
sources/media
RIn the Telephone menu:
switches to the phone book and
starts dialling the selected number
ñ
Switches off LINGUATRONIC, see
the separate operating instructions
%
Press briefly:
RIn
RBack
RIn the Radio
Radio/Media
Media menu: dese-
lects the track or station list or
list of available radio sources/
media
RHides display messages
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Right control panel
~
RRejects
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
or accepts a call
RSwitches to the redial memory
W
X
RAdjusts
RMakes
the volume
8
RMute
ó
Switches on LINGUATRONIC, see
the separate operating instructions
Multifunction display
Multifunction display (example: vehicles with automatic transmission)
: Drive program (Y page 195)
; Transmission position (Y page 195)
= Display panel for display messages,
menus and menu lists
? Time
A Outside temperature (Y page 293)
B Additional speedometer (Y page 312)
The unit displayed in additional speedometer
B in the multifunction display is inverse to
the speedometer unit in the instrument cluster.
X To call up the menu list in display panel
=: press the ò button on the steering
wheel.
Display panel = shows the selected menu
or submenu and display messages.
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
Z
Gearshift recommendation, for
manual transmission
(Y page 191) or when shifting
manually (automatic transmission) (Y page 198)
XjY
Active Parking Assist
(Y page 239)
¯
Cruise control (Y page 216)
È
SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 219)
READY indicator for the hybrid
READY
system (Y page 272)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS
(Y page 139)
è
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 186)
ë
HOLD function (Y page 232)
a
DISTRONIC PLUS Steering
Assist and Stop&Go Pilot
(Y page 230)
120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Head-up display
General notes
The head-up display projects information
from the navigation system and the driver
assistance system above the dashboard into
the driver's field of vision.
A requirement for the display of the contents
is that the following functions are available in
the vehicle and are switched on:
RNavigation
RDISTRONIC
PLUS
control and SPEEDTRONIC
RTraffic Sign Assist
The head-up display allows the driver to see
all of the information without having to take
his eyes off the road.
RCruise
Important safety notes
The head-up display is only an aid and is not a
substitute for attentive driving.
Z
295
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
296
Speed limits and overtaking restrictions are
not always correctly displayed. Traffic signs
always have priority over the Traffic Sign
Assist display.
The visibility of the head-up display is influenced by the following conditions:
Rthe
driver's seat position
positioning of the display image
Rthe general light conditions
Rsunglasses with polarisation filters
Rwet road surfaces
Rblocking of sunlight by objects on the display cover
In the event of extreme sunlight, sections of
the display may fade. This can be reversed by
switching the head-up display off and on
again.
Rthe
i Vehicles with the head-up display are
equipped with a special windscreen.
Should repairs be necessary, have the
windscreen replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Displays and operation
Switching the head-up display on/off
X
Press button :.
When the head-up display is switched on,
the display appears in the driver's field of
vision.
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
Head-up display
Content and information for the following systems are shown in the head-up display:
: Navigation messages
; Current speed
= Set DISTRONIC PLUS speed (Y page 222)
The selected cruise control speed (Y page 216)
The selected SPEEDTRONIC speed (Y page 219)
If Traffic Sign Assist is activated in the head-up display sub-menu, detected traffic signs are
also shown in the display.
In the Settings menu, in the submenu head-up display, you have the following settings options:
RSwitching
other displays on/off (Y page 310)
the position (Y page 310)
RAdjusting the brightness (Y page 310)
RSetting
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Press the ò button on the steering wheel
to call up the list of menus and select a menu.
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 294).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
297
RMedia
menu (Y page 302)
menu (Y page 304)
RAssistance graphic menu
(Y page 306)
RService menu (Y page 306)
RSettings menu (Y page 307)
RTelephone
RTrip
menu (Y page 298)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 300)
RRadio menu (Y page 302)
RNavi
Z
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
298
Trip menu
Standard display
refuelled C instead of approximate
range :.
Recuperation display = shows you if energy
has been recuperated from the kinetic energy
in overrun mode and saved in the battery.
Recuperation display = depends on the
engine installed and is therefore not available
in all vehicles.
Information on the total electric range in
hybrid vehicles can be found in the "Hybrid
drive" section (Y page 276).
ECO display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use the : or 9 button to select ECO
DISPLAY.
X
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
approximate range : and current fuel consumption ;.
X
Approximate range : that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 211).
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
:
;
=
?
Distance
Duration
Average speed
Average fuel consumption
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 299).
The From start trip computer is automatically reset if:
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
Digital speedometer
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Resetting values
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
X
Z
299
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
300
Menus and submenus
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip
meter
R"From start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
If you reset the values in the ECO display, the
values in the "From start" trip computer are
also reset. If you reset the values in the "From
start" trip computer, the values in the ECO
display are also reset.
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation messages.
Further information on navigation can be
found in the separate Audio 20 or COMAND
Online operating instructions.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
Route guidance not active
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
:
;
=
?
Distance to the next destination
Estimated arrival time
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to the change of direction
= Change-of-direction symbol
? Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction (white)
A Possible lane (light grey)
B Lane not recommended (dark grey)
: Direction of travel
; Current road
On multilane roads, new lane recommendations can be displayed for the next change of
direction if the digital map supports this data.
During the change of direction, new lanes
may be added.
Lane not recommended B: you will not be
able to complete the next change of direction
if you stay in this lane.
Possible lane A: you will be able to complete
the next change of direction in this lane only.
Recommended lane ?: in this lane you will
be able to complete the next change of direction and the one after that.
Change of direction with lane recommendation
Change of direction without lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
? Lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
Other status indicators of the navigation system
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is to be made, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. This shortens
towards the top of the display as you
approach the point of the announced change
of direction. The change of direction starts
once the distance display reaches zero.
: Additional information
Other possible additional information:
RNew
route... or Calculating route...
A new route is calculated.
RRoad not mapped
The vehicle position is inside the area of the
digital map but the road is not recognised,
e.g. off-road position.
RNo route
No route could be calculated to the selected destination.
RO
Z
301
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
302
Menus and submenus
You have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
Radio menu
Use : or 9 to select the waveband
or station preset.
X Press a to confirm the selection.
X
i You can store your stations in Audio 20 or
COMAND Online, see the separate operating instructions.
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcast-
ing) is an optimised digital transmission
standard designed for the mobile reception
of radio transmissions.
Media menu
Changing the media source
:
;
=
?
Waveband
Station frequency with memory position
Name of artist
Name of track
Station ; is displayed with the station frequency or station name. The memory position
is only displayed along with station ; if this
has been stored.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Radio menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
Currently selected station ; appears in
the multifunction display.
X To open the station list: press : or
9 briefly.
X To select a station from the station list:
press : or 9 briefly.
X To select a station from the station list
using rapid scrolling: press and briefly
hold the : or 9 button.
X To select a waveband or station preset:
press a briefly.
You can change the media source and playback mode (audio, video or TV) at any time in
the Media menu.
You can change the media source and playback mode (audio, video or TV) at any time in
the Media menu.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Media menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X To open/close the media sources list:
press a briefly.
The list shows the following media sources,
for example:
Rdisc
(CD/DVD)
card (SD/SDHC)
RMEDIA REGISTER
RUSB storage device
RBluetooth® audio device
Rmemory
Observe the additional information on media
support and on media mode in the separate
Audio 20 or COMAND Online operating
instructions.
Audio player or audio media operation
Press a to confirm.
To open the track list: press : or 9
briefly.
X To select next/previous track from the
track list: briefly press : or 9.
X To select a track from the track list
using rapid scrolling: press and
hold : or 9 until the desired track is
reached.
If you press and hold the : or 9
button, the rapid scrolling speed is
increased. Not all audio devices or media
support this function.
X
X
If the corresponding track information is
stored on the audio drive or audio media, the
multifunction display may display the following:
Rtrack
Rtrack
number
name
Rartist
Ralbum
: Media source, e.g. name of USB memory
;
=
?
A
stick
Current track
Name of artist
Name of album
Folder name
The track information does not appear in
audio AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode:
external audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
Audio files from various audio players or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Media menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X To select audio player or data carrier:
press a briefly, to open the list of media
sources.
X Use : or 9 to select the corresponding audio player or audio media.
X
Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Media menu.
X
Z
303
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
304
Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X To select DVD single drive or data carrier: press a briefly, to open the list of
media sources.
X Use : or 9 to select the corresponding DVD player or DVD media.
X Press a to confirm.
X To open the scene list: press : or
9 briefly.
X To select the next or previous scene
from the scene list: briefly press : or
9.
X To select a scene from the scene list
using rapid scrolling: press and
hold : or 9 until desired scene : is
reached.
X Press a to confirm your selection.
X
TV operation
Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X To select TV: press a briefly to open
the list of media sources.
X Use : or 9 to select TV.
X Press a to confirm.
X To open the channel list: press : or
9 briefly.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press : or 9 briefly.
X To select a channel from the channel
list using rapid scrolling: press and
briefly hold the : or 9 button.
X Press a to confirm your selection.
X
i You can store TV channels in COMAND
Online, see the separate operating instructions.
Telephone menu
Introduction
: Station frequency with memory position
; Programme information, e.g. the name of
the film
= Name of channel list
The memory position is only displayed along
with channel : if this has been stored.
X Switch on COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Media menu.
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone, see the separate telephone operating instructions.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online,
see the separate operating instructions.
X
Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 386).
or
Establish a Bluetooth® connection to Audio
20 or COMAND Online, see the separate
operating instructions.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press : or 9 on the steering wheel
to select the Telephone menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service:
service there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rfrom
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If you are not in the Telephone menu, you can
still accept a call.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
If you are not in the Telephone menu, you can
still reject or end a call.
Dialling a number from the phone book
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press : or 9 on the steering wheel
to select the Telephone menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the :, 9 or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
desired name.
or
X To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold
the : or 9 button for longer than
one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the telephone book: press the
~ or % button.
X
If someone calls you when you are in the
Telephone menu, a display message appears
in the multifunction display.
Z
305
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
306
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press : or 9 on the steering wheel
to select the Telephone menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the redial memory: press the
~ or % button.
X
The assistance graphic shows you the status
of and/or information from the following driving systems or driving safety systems:
RDISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 228)
RTraffic Sign Assist (Y page 256)
RDistance warning function and autonomous braking system of COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS (Y page 308)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 82)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 259) or Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 263)
RATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 255)
RLane Keeping Assist (Y page 261) or Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 266)
Service menu
Introduction
Assistance graphic menu
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Assistance
graphic menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
The multifunction display shows the
DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the
assistance graphic.
X Press : to display the ATTENTION ASSIST assessment.
X
In the Service menu, you have the following
options:
RCalling up display messages in the message memory (Y page 314)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning
system (Y page 437)
RChecking the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 434)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 395)
RDisplaying the coolant temperature
(Y page 307)
RDisplaying the AdBlue® level and range
(Y page 307) (BlueTEC vehicles only)
Displaying the coolant temperature
The coolant temperature is also shown in the
instrument cluster in the rev counter.
Observe the notes on coolant temperature
(Y page 293).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Coolant
submenu.
X Press a to confirm your selection.
The coolant temperature is shown in a bar
display.
Displaying AdBlue® level and range
This menu is only available in BlueTEC vehicles.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Select the AdBlue submenu using : or
9.
X Press a to confirm your selection.
The range and AdBlue® level appear in a bar
graph in the multifunction display.
Observe the information and notes on "Refuelling" (Y page 204).
Settings menu
Introduction
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
RChanging assistance settings
(Y page 307)
RChanging head-up display settings
(Y page 310)
RChanging the light settings (Y page 311)
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
(Y page 312)
RChanging the vehicle settings
(Y page 313)
RRestoring the factory settings
(Y page 313)
Assistance submenu
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Observe the "Important safety notes" section
in the description of ESP® (Y page 80).
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Z
307
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
308
Menus and submenus
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 80).
X Start the engine.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
ESP.
ESP
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
If the å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the vehicle is ready
to drive, ESP® is deactivated.
Rin
If the ÷ and å warning lamps light up
continuously, ESP® is not available due to a
malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 357).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 315).
Activating/deactivating the message display for Traffic Sign Assist
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Traffic Sign Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
When the display is activated, recognised
traffic signs are displayed in the multifunction display for five seconds.
X
For further information about Traffic Sign
Assist, see (Y page 256).
Activating/deactivating COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Use 9 or : to select Collision
Prevention.
Prevention
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS is deactivated, the æ symbol
appears in the multifunction display in the
Assistance graphic menu.
For further information about COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, see (Y page 77).
Activating/deactivating PRE-SAFE®
Brake
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
PRE-SAFE Brake.
Brake
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the Assistance
graphic menu in the multifunction display.
X
For more information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake,
see (Y page 82).
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot
Assist is activated, grey radar waves propX
agating backwards appear next to the vehicle in the Assistance graphic menu in
the multifunction display.
For further information about Blind Spot
Assist, see (Y page 259).
For further information about Active Blind
Spot Assist, see (Y page 263).
Setting ATTENTION ASSIST
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Attention Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Sensitive
Sensitive.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated,
the é symbol appears in the Assis‐
tance graphic menu in the multifunction
display when the ignition is on.
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 255).
Setting Lane Keeping Assist
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select the Assis‐
tance submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select Lane Keep‐
ing Assist.
Assist
Z
309
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
310
Press a to confirm.
The current selection Standard or Adap‐
tive is displayed.
X To change the setting: press a again.
X
For further information about Lane Keeping
Assist; see (Y page 261).
For further information about Active Lane
Keeping Assist; see (Y page 266).
Head-up display submenu
Switching other displays on/off
This function is only available if the vehicle is
equipped with Navigation and/or Traffic Sign
Assist.
In the on-board computer, you can select
which contents are shown on the windscreen
when the head-up display is activated
(Y page 295).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Head-up display submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 buttons to select
Display content.
content
X Press a to confirm.
Switching the Traffic Sign Assist display
on/off
X
Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate the Traffic Sign
Assist display, recognised traffic signs are
shown on the windscreen when the headup display is activated.
Switching the navigation messages display on/off
Vehicles with Traffic Sign Assist:
press : to select Navigation mes‐
sages.
sages
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you switch on the Navigation mes‐
sages display, navigation messages are
shown on the windscreen when the headup display is activated.
X
For more information on navigation, see the
separate operating instructions.
Further information on Traffic Sign Assist
(Y page 256).
Setting the position
You can adjust the position of the displayed
contents on the windscreen.
X Switch on the Head-up display
(Y page 296).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Head-up display submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Use the : or 9 button to select the
Position function.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X Use the : or 9 button to set the
position from Level +5 to Level -5.
-5
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Using the Memory function, you can save and
call up the position of the head-up display as
a single memory preset (Y page 130).
Adjusting the brightness
You can adjust the brightness of the displayed
contents on the windscreen.
Switch on the head-up display
(Y page 296).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Head-up display submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Brightness function.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
brightness from Level +5 (bright) to
Level -5 (dark).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Light submenu
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intelligent Light System function.
If the Intelligent Light System function has been switched on, the cone of light
and the L symbol in the multifunction
display are shown in white.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate the Intelligent Light
System you activate the following functions:
System,
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering
light function
range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Inactive for leftside traffic or Inactive for rightside traffic display message instead of
the Intelligent Light System function in
the Lights submenu (Y page 311). This display message will only appear if the setting for
driving on the left/right is set opposite to your
vehicle's country version.
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 138).
RExtended
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 134).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Dipped
beams Setting for function.
You will see the selected setting: rightside traffic or left-side traffic.
traffic
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable. These are only deactivated if the
setting for driving on the left/right is set
opposite to your vehicle's country version.
Z
311
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
312
Menus and submenus
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the
left/right.
Instrument cluster submenu
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in
the multifunction display.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
Miles.
Miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rtotal
Selecting the permanent display function
Using the Permanent display function you
can enable outside temperature and additional speedometer displays in the status
area of the multifunction display.
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Perma‐
nent display function.
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection Outside tempera‐
ture or Additional speedometer is displayed.
X To change the setting: press a again.
X
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
United Kingdom only:
The speed is shown continuously in mph as a
digital display in the status area. The additional speedometer cannot be switched on or
off.
Use the Digital speedo function to choose
whether the status area in the multifunction
display shows the speed digitally. The unit in
the additional speedometer is always inverse
to the speedometer unit.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Use : or 9 to select the Digital
speedo function.
The current selection is displayed.
X To switch on/off: press the a button
again.
Vehicle submenu
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Limit speed (winter tyres) function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (240
240 km/h to 160 km/h).
km/h The Off setting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 221).
Restoring the factory settings
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory settings submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
Z
313
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
314
Display messages
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
With certain display messages, you will also hear a warning tone.
You can hide the display messages. The display messages are then stored in the message
memory. Rectify the cause of a display message as soon as possible.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD
function (Y page 232)
page 207)
RParking (Y
Hides display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up the list of menus.
Press the : or 9 button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering wheel.
X Press : or 9 to select the message memory.
If there are no display messages, you will see No messages in the multifunction display.
If there are display messages, the number of messages stored is shown.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to scroll through the display messages.
X
X
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program),
BAS (Brake Assist System), PRE‑SAFE®, HOLD function, hill start
assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake
lights, STEER CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active
Blind Spot Assist are temporarily unavailable.
BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
For example, the on-board voltage may be insufficient.
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, HOLD function, hill start assist,
ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights,
STEER CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind
Spot Assist are unavailable due to a malfunction.
BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
The J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps may also light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Z
315
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
316
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, HOLD function, hill start assist,
ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights,
STEER CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind
Spot Assist are unavailable due to a malfunction.
BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, HOLD function, hill start assist,
ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights,
STEER CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind
Spot Assist are unavailable due to a malfunction.
BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
317
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
318
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS,
PRE‑SAFE®, HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights, STEER CONTROL,
Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist are
unavailable due to a malfunction.
BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
J
Brake immediately
A malfunction has occurred while the HOLD function is active.
or
With the HOLD function activated, you have:
Ropened
the driver's door and released the seat belt or
off the engine
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. If you attempt to lock
the vehicle, the tone becomes louder.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
You can restart the engine.
Rswitched
!
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 209).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking
brake (Y page 209).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
Press the electric parking brake handle for at least ten seconds.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are
lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
or
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 209).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
X
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
319
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
320
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 439).
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake manually:
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 209).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to
apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: switch off the ignition.
The electric parking brake is applied automatically.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P, as the electric parking brake is not applied automatically.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake manually:
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 209).
!
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
Parking brake inop‐ has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
erative
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by
charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is still not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up and the red ! indicator
lamp flashes.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
321
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
322
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition was switched off.
X Switch the ignition on.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release
the parking brake
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
#
Check brake pad
wear
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Restart the engine.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
inoperative
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is temporarily inoperative
due to a malfunction. Adaptive Brake Assist may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PRE-SAFE inopera‐
tive See Owner's
Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE Functions
currently limited
See Owner's Manual
PRE‑SAFE® PLUS or PRE‑SAFE® Brake is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
PRE‑SAFE® PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake are operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Restart the engine.
X
PRE-SAFE Functions
limited See Own‐
er's Manual
PRE‑SAFE® PLUS or PRE‑SAFE® Brake is unavailable due to a malfunction. BAS PLUS might also be deactivated.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
323
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
324
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Radar sensors
dirty See Owner's
Manual
At least one of the following driving systems or driving safety systems is temporarily restricted or inoperative:
RPRE-SAFE®
PLUS
Brake
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
RActive Lane Keeping Assist
RActive Blind Spot Assist
RDISTRONIC PLUS
Possible causes:
RPRE-SAFE®
Rthe sensors in the radiator trim and/or in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe function of the driving system and/or driving safety system
is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out. All driving systems/driving safety systems are operative
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Switch off the engine.
X Clean the sensors (Y page 401) in the following locations:
Rin the radiator trim
Rin the front bumper
Rin the rear bumper, particularly in the middle of the rear
bumper
X Restart the engine.
The display message disappears.
X
ü
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 50).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ý
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been
engaged in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts (Y page 49).
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 50).
6
The restraint system is faulty. The 6 warning lamp also lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Further information on the restraint system (Y page 44).
6
The front left-hand or right-hand restraint system has malfunctioned. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument
Front left malfunc‐ cluster.
tion Consult work‐
G WARNING
shoporFront
shop
Front right
malfunction Con‐
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintensult workshop
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shoporRear
shop
Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
The rear left-hand or right-hand restraint system has malfunctioned. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument
cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
325
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
326
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The rear centre restraint system has malfunctioned. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Rear centre mal‐
function Consult
workshop
6
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
There is a malfunction in the left or right windowbag. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Left windowbag mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshoporRight
workshop
Right
The left or right windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally
windowbag malfunc‐ or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
tion Consult work‐ This poses an increased risk of injury.
shop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front-passenger
airbag disabled
See Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is disabled during the journey
although:
Ran
adult
or
person larger than a certain size is occupying the frontpassenger seat
If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the system
detects may be too low.
Ra
G WARNING
The front-passenger front airbag does not deploy during an accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Have the occupant on the front-passenger seat step out of the
vehicle.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the frontpassenger door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
Rthe PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must then light
up and remain lit. If the indicator lamp is on, the automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 54).
Rthe display messages Front-passenger airbag enabled
See Owner's Manual or Front-passenger airbag disa‐
bled See Owner's Manual must not appear in the multifunction display.
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF or ON indicator
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic frontZ
327
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
328
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
passenger front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 54).
Front-passenger
airbag enabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is enabled during the journey
although:
Ra child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system
weight threshold is located on the front-passenger seat
or
Rthe front-passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are adding to the
weight applied to the seat.
G WARNING
The airbag may deploy unintentionally.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat.
X Make sure there are no objects applying additional force to the
seat.
The system may otherwise detect the additional force and interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually is.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the frontpassenger door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
Rthe PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must then light
up and remain lit. If the indicator lamp is on, the automatic
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 54).
Rthe display messages Front-passenger airbag enabled
See Owner's Manual or Front-passenger airbag disa‐
bled See Owner's Manual must not appear in the multifunction display.
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF or ON indicator
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 54).
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all the LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 142).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
Left cornering
light or Right cor‐
nering light
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
Trailer left tail
lamporTrailer
lamp
Trailer
right tail lamp
Z
329
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
330
Display messages
Display messages
b
Trailer left indi‐
catororTrailer
cator
Trailer
right indicator
b
Trailer brake lamp
b
Rear left indica‐
tor or Rear right
indicator
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 142).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 142).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
tor or Right mir‐
ror indicator
b
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left brake lamp or
Right brake lamp
Third brake lamp
Left-hand tail
lamp/ brake
lamporRight-hand
lamp
Right-hand
tail lamp/ brake
lamp
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left tail lamp or
Right tail lamp
b
Left main
beamorRight
beam
Right main
beam
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 142).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 142).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left-hand or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Number plate lamp
Rear fog lamp
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
Reversing light
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
b
Active Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
The active light function is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
331
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
332
Display messages
Display messages
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The exterior lighting is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
X Check the fuses (Y page 424).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Switch off lights
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is faulty.
Adaptive Highbeam
Assist Plus inoper‐ X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ative
Adaptive Highbeam
Assist Plus cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is deactivated and temporarily
inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, display
message Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus available again
is displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is operational again.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner’s Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 393).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Wait until the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Z
333
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
334
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
See Owner's Manual
Rfaulty
alternator
power electronics (hybrid vehicles)
Rtorn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
Rdefective
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
The battery is no longer being charged and the battery charge level
is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Observe the instructions in the # See Owner's Manual
display message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
The engine is off and the battery charge level is too low.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating and interior lighting.
X Leave the engine running for a few minutes, or drive for a longer
distance.
The battery charges.
Stop vehicle See
Owner's Manual
Start engine See
Owner's Manual
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the engine oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 392).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 392).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
4
Display message only for AMG vehicles:
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
Add 1 litre engine
oil when next refu‐ X Check the engine oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 392).
elling
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 392).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
4
The engine oil level is too low. There is a risk of engine damage.
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Check the engine oil level (Y page 392).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 392).
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
C
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
Engine oil level
Stop vehicle
Switch engine off
Reserve fuel level
X
Z
335
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
336
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Refill AdBlue See
Owner’s Manual
The AdBlue® level has fallen below the reserve range. A warning
tone also sounds.
X
Refill AdBlue No
start in ... mi
Refill AdBlue® as soon as possible (Y page 204).
The AdBlue® level is only sufficient for the indicated distance. A
warning tone also sounds.
Refill AdBlue® immediately (Y page 204).
i If you drive the vehicle faster than 15 km/h the Refill
AdBlue No start in ... mi message goes out after approximately one minute.
X
Refill AdBlue Eng.
start not possible
The AdBlue® tank is empty. A warning tone also sounds. You can
no longer start the engine.
Add at least 3.5 l of AdBlue® (Y page 204).
Turn the ignition on for approximately one minute.
The system requires approximately one minute after refilling to
detect the change in the AdBlue® level.
X Start the engine.
X
X
Check AdBlue See
Owner’s Manual
The AdBlue® system is malfunctioning. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Eng. start not pos‐ The AdBlue® system is malfunctioning. A warning tone also
sible
sounds. You can no longer start the engine.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Hybrid system
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Û
The hybrid system is malfunctioning.
X Have the vehicle transported on a transporter or towed with the
rear axle raised to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
d
The drive system is malfunctioning.
The ECO start/stop function may be malfunctioning.
The drive power is restricted.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Malfunction
Malfunction
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
¨
Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
¨
The vehicle level is too low when the vehicle is stationary. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not pull away.
The vehicle level is set when the display message disappears.
¨
You have pulled away while the vehicle level is still too low.
AIRMATIC sets the vehicle to the selected level after a short
period.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
Vehicle rising
Vehicle rising
Please wait
Stop vehicle Vehi‐
cle too low
Z
337
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
338
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
AIRMATIC is faulty. A warning tone also sounds.
Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front
wings or the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement
is too great.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions, and select a higher vehicle level.
Depending on the malfunction, it may be possible to raise the
vehicle.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
¨
The AIRMATIC function is restricted. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated
and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Malfunction
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthere are no lane markings for a long or extended period
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rvisibility
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inopera‐
tive or Active
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual or Active
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Restart the engine.
X
Blind Spot Assist
not available when
towing a trailer
See Owner's Manual
or Active Blind
Spot Assist not
available when tow‐
ing a trailer See
Owner's Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while
towing a trailer.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer
and your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative or
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open.
led
X Repeat the parking gap measurement and parking process with
the driver's door closed.
You touched the multifunction steering wheel while steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 239).
Z
339
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
340
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist inoper‐ PARKTRONIC is malfunctioning or faulty.
ative
X Follow the instructions and helpful hints in the "Problems with
PARKTRONIC" section (Y page 239).
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Parking Assist is unavailable or faulty.
X Switch off the ignition and restart the engine.
If Active Parking Assist continues to be unavailable (the j symbol
is not shown in the multifunction display):
X
Traffic Sign
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Traffic Sign Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Traffic Sign Assist is operational again.
Traffic Sign
Assist inoperative
Traffic Sign Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 232).
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 232).
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 222).
If it was not deactivated by the driver, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 222).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
rently unavailable DISTRONIC PLUS Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are also temSee Owner's Manual porarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty.
The following may have also failed:
RBAS
PLUS with Cross-Traffic Assist
Brake
RDISTRONIC PLUS with Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
RPRE-SAFE®
DISTRONIC PLUS sus‐ You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
pended
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 222).
DISTRONIC PLUS
- - - mph
X
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
341
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
342
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DTR+: steering
assist. currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
DISTRONIC PLUS Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthere are no lane markings for a long or extended period
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC PLUS Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are operative
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
DTR+: steering
assistant inopera‐
tive
DISTRONIC PLUS Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot are malfunctioning.
However, the DISTRONIC PLUS functions are still available.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
SPEEDTRONIC Limit
- - - mph
While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
Cruise control
- - - mph
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 216).
120 km/h!
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!.
km/h!
X Drive more slowly.
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted
new wheels and tyres
tyre pressure in one or more tyres is not correct
Rthe
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 408).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 437).
Check tyre pres‐
sures then restart
Run Flat Indicator
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 437).
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
343
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
344
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Rectify tyre pres‐
sure
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 433).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 435).
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 408).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 433).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning tyre defect The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 408).
Ryou
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. moni‐
tor currently
unavailable
Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to either P
or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the transmission is no longer being
charged.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Apply brake to
deselect Park (P)
position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
X
X
Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Depress the brake pedal.
Z
345
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
346
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Risk of vehicle
rolling Transmis‐
sion not in P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N or
D.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The vehicle may roll away.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
Without changing
gear, consult work‐ A warning tone also sounds.
shop
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only select Park
(P) when vehicle
is stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Clutch overheated
Avoid pulling away
Engage/disengage
clutch quickly if
req.
The clutch is under considerable load and the permitted operating
temperature has been exceeded. A warning tone also sounds.
Avoid frequent pulling away and driving at walking pace over longer distances.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Leave the engine running.
The clutch is cooled more quickly with the engine running.
or
X If possible, continue driving at a steady speed.
X Remove your foot from the clutch pedal and do not allow the
clutch to slip.
The clutch may also cool down during the journey.
It may take several minutes for it to cool down. When the clutch
has cooled down, the display message disappears. The clutch is
fully operational again.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
M
The bonnet is open. A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a
malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
_
Saloon with through-loading feature in the rear bench seat:
The backrest in the rear is not engaged on the left-hand and/or
right-hand side.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
_
Saloon with through-loading facility in the rear compartment:
The centre rear seat backrest is not engaged.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
j
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Engage the trailer coupling's ball coupling in the end position
(Y page 285).
Rear left seat
backrest not
locked or Rear
right seat back‐
rest not locked
Rear centre back‐
rest not locked
Check trailer
hitch lock
Z
347
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
348
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
&
Hybrid vehicles: with the engine switched off, you have attempted
to switch on the pre-entry climate control more than twice.
X Let the engine run for ten seconds.
After running the engine, the pre-entry climate control is operational again.
Pre-entry climate
control (via key)
available again
after engine start
&
Hybrid vehicles: the on-board voltage is too low.
The pre-entry climate control cannot be switched on.
Pre-entry climate
X Drive for a considerable distance.
control (via key)
The battery charges. The pre-entry climate control is operational
inoperative HV bat‐
again
as soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is suftery low
ficient.
&
Vehicles with BlueEFFICIENCY package: you have attempted to
switch on the pre-entry climate control (eHeat/eVent) more than
3 times with the engine switched off.
X Let the engine run for ten seconds.
After running the engine, the pre-entry climate control is operational again.
&
The on-board voltage is too low.
The auxiliary heating (Y page 172) has switched itself off. The
auxiliary heating or pre-entry climate control (eHeat/eVent) cannot be switched on.
X Drive for a considerable distance.
The battery charges. The auxiliary heating or the auxiliary climate control ("eHeat/eVent" function) is operational again as
soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
&
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on (Y page 172).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
&
The auxiliary heating is temporarily malfunctioning or faulty.
X When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 172).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Function available
again after engine
start
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
Ð
The electric steering lock is malfunctioning.
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Steering malfunc‐
tion See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The steering may be locked by the electric steering lock.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 207).
X Do not drive on and consult the nearest qualified specialist
workshop.
_
The electric steering lock was unable to unlock the steering.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Before starting
X To unlock the steering, move the steering wheel slightly.
the engine, turn
the steering wheel. X Insert the key into the ignition lock again.
Telephone No ser‐
vice
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 394).
Z
349
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
350
Display messages
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Â
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Â
The key batteries are discharged.
X Replace the batteries (Y page 94).
Â
The key is currently undetected.
X Change the location of the key in the vehicle.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Replace key
Change key batter‐
ies
Key not detected
(white display message)
Â
Key not detected
(red display message)
If the key still cannot be detected:
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
The key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Locate the key.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves,
the key is not detected whilst the engine is running.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
The key is continually undetected.
The key detection function has a temporary malfunction or is
faulty. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety
Seat belts
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up for
6 seconds after the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten
their seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the
engine starts. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up to 6 seconds.
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
The warning tone ceases.
Z
351
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
352
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the engine starts, as soon as
the driver's or the front-passenger door is closed.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
The warning lamp goes out.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a
secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent audible warning
sounds.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the same time, you
are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time, you are
driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a
secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
Safety systems
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The yellow brake system warning lamp lights up while the engine is running
or the ECO start/stop function is activated.
Hybrid vehicle: the yellow brake system warning lamp is shown in driving
condition READY.
G WARNING
The brake system is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be
affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X If the multifunction display shows a display message, please observe this.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J
N The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Hybrid vehicles: the red brake system warning lamp is shown in driving condition READY.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics
may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
Z
353
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
354
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Hybrid vehicles: the red brake system warning lamp is shown in driving condition READY.
A warning tone also sounds.
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Hybrid vehicles: the yellow ABS warning lamp is shown in driving condition
READY.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) has been deactivated due to a fault. Therefore
BAS (Brake Assist System), BAS PLUS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS,
PRE‑SAFE® Brake, HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation,
Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights, STEER CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist are also deactivated.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions
listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The
braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other systems,
such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Z
355
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
356
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning
tone also sounds.
Hybrid vehicles: the yellow ABS warning lamp is shown in driving condition
READY.
EBD is unavailable due to a malfunction. Therefore ABS, BAS, BAS PLUS,
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation,
Crosswind Assist, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, HOLD
function, hill start assist, adaptive brake lights, STEER CONTROL, Active Lane
Keeping Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions
listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock, for example, if you
brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The
braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J÷
å!
N The red brake warning lamp, the yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamp
and the yellow ABS warning lamp are lit while the engine is running.
Hybrid vehicle: The red brake warning lamp, the yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF
warning lamp and the yellow ABS warning lamp are shown in driving condition
READY.
ABS and ESP® are unavailable due to a fault. Therefore BAS, BAS PLUS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® PLUS,
PRE‑SAFE® Brake, HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation,
crosswind driving assistance, adaptive brake lights, STEER CONTROL, Active
Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions
listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock, for example, if you
brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The
braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
÷
N The yellow ESP® warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of skidding or
at least one wheel has started to spin.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 81), it may be best to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 80).
Z
357
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
358
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
N The yellow ESP® warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Hybrid vehicles: the yellow ESP® warning lamp is shown in driving condition
READY.
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, PRE‑SAFE®,
PRE‑SAFE® PLUS, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, HOLD function, hill start assist,
ESP® trailer stabilisation, Crosswind Assist, adaptive brake lights, STEER
CONTROL, Active Lane Keeping Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist are
unavailable due to a malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions
listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
å
N The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running or the
ECO start/stop function is activated.
Hybrid vehicles: the yellow ESP® warning lamp is shown in driving condition
READY.
ESP® is deactivated.
G WARNING
If ESP® is deactivated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
Reactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 81), it may be best to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 80).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The red indicator lamp for the electric parking brake flashes or is lit and/or
the yellow warning lamp for the electric parking brake is lit.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
6
N The red restraint system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The restraint system is faulty.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the
event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have the restraint system checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the restraint system (Y page 44).
Z
359
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
360
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Engine
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
N The yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp lights up while the engine is
running.
There may be a fault, for example:
Rin
the engine management
the fuel injection system
Rin the exhaust system
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be running in
emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rin
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry (Y page 203).
Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running
mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be checked.
X
8
N The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp is on while the engine is running.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level drops into the
reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running and the
coolant temperature gauge is at the start of the bar display.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a risk of engine
damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
N The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked
or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine
has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the warning notes
(Y page 393).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by
frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is below 120 †.
The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running. A
warning tone also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns, which
can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
Z
361
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
362
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine
has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the warning notes
(Y page 393).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by
frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving to the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
X
Hybrid system
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The yellow RBS (Recuperative Brake System) warning lamp is on. In addition, a warning tone may sound.
G Risk of accident
RBS is malfunctioning. The automatic engine switch-off function may also be
deactivated.
X Observe the messages in the multifunction display (Y page 314).
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The red brake warning lamp is on. A warning tone also sounds.
G Risk of accident
RBS is malfunctioning.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
Driving systems
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected.
X Increase the distance.
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion. A
warning tone also sounds.
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line of travel at
too high a speed.
X Be prepared to brake immediately.
X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to brake or take
evasive action.
Further information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake (Y page 82).
For further information about the distance warning function of COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, see (Y page 77).
Z
363
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
364
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tyres
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction)
is lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at least one of the
tyres.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase
tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair
tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly
impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 207).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat tyre
(Y page 408).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 433).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rthe
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction)
flashes for approximately one minute and then remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to recognise or register low tyre pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
N The red power steering warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified specialist
workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the nearest
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
365
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
366
367
Useful information ............................ 368
Stowage areas ................................... 368
Stowing and features
Features ............................................. 376
368
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Stowage areas
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rnever
exceed the maximum permissible
gross vehicle weight or the permissible axle
loads for the vehicle (including occupants).
Rthe boot is the preferred place to carry
objects.
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
Stowage areas
lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368).
To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to
position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it 90° anticlockwise to position 1.
X
Spectacles compartment
Front stowage compartments
Glove compartment
To open: press marking :.
The spectacles compartment opens downwards.
X To close: press marking : again and the
spectacles compartment returns upwards
and engages.
X
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
Objects in A4 format or an iPad®, for example,
can be stored in the glove compartment. For
vehicles with a perfume atomiser
(Y page 167) the storage space of the glove
compartment is restricted.
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the emergency key element.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment
is always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Stowage compartment in the front centre
console
Illustration: vehicles with DIRECT SELECT
lever
X
Briefly press trim ; in the direction of the
arrow.
Cover : swings upwards.
Z
Stowing and features
RClose
369
Stowage areas
370
Stowage compartment in the doors
Rear stowage compartments
Stowing and features
Stowage compartment in the rear seat
armrest
You can store items such as a rolled-up fluorescent jacket (driver's door) and the vehicle
document wallet (front-passenger door) in
stowage compartment : in the doors.
Bottles with a capacity of up to 1.0 l may be
stored in doors ;.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
X
X
To open: fold down the seat armrest.
Press on the front of release catch : and
fold the cover of the armrest upwards.
Additional stowage space
Depending on the equipment, the following
additional stowage areas are available in the
vehicle:
Rcard
X
To open: press button : at the front.
The stowage space opens.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
following may be in the stowage space:
Ra multimedia connector unit with 2 USB
ports and an SD card slot, e.g. for use with
an iPod®, iPhone® or MP3 player, see the
separate operating instructions
Ra mobile phone bracket
Ra small stowage space in the upper front
section
and coin holder in the dashboard
above the light switch (not suitable for holding thin objects such as shopping tokens)
Rthe open stowage compartment in the
centre console
Rstowage net in the front-passenger footwell
Rthe map pockets on the back of the driver's
and front-passenger seat
Rthe luggage nets on the left and right-hand
side in the boot
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368)
and the safety notes regarding stowage
spaces (Y page 368).
Stowage areas
Important safety notes
X
X
G WARNING
The skibag in conjunction with the lashing
straps cannot restrain any objects other than
skis.
Vehicle occupants could be struck in the
event of sudden braking or an accident, for
instance, if you:
other heavy or sharp-edged
objects in the skibag
Rdo not secure the skibag with the lashing
straps
There is a risk of accident and injury.
Store only skis in the skibag. Always secure
the skibag with the lashing straps so that it
cannot move around.
Close the ski/snowboard bag.
Pull tensioning strap ; tight by the loose
end until the skis or snowboards are held
firmly inside the ski/snowboard bag.
Rtransport
A maximum of four pairs of skis or two snowboards can be transported in the ski/snowboard bag.
Securing the ski/snowboard bag in the
boot
Fold the middle rear seat backrest forwards
(Y page 372).
X Slide the ski/snowboard bag between the
two outside rear seat backrests. Ensure
that the wheels of the ski/snowboard bag
are in the boot.
X Open the ski/snowboard bag with zip :
and place the skis or snowboards inside it.
X
X
Engage tensioning strap = in a diagonal
pattern on hooks ? in lashing eyelets A
as shown.
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot cannot be
restrained by the seat backrest.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368).
The outside and the middle rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the boot capacity. The division ratio
is 40% to 20% to 40%.
Z
Stowing and features
Ski/snowboard bag
371
Stowage areas
372
Folding the rear seat backrest forward
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Vehicles with memory function: when one
or both parts of the rear seat backrest are
folded forwards, the respective front seat
moves forward slightly, when necessary, in
order to avoid contact.
X Open the boot.
X Fully insert the rear seat backrest head
restraints.
Stowing and features
X
Fold corresponding rear seat backrest ;
forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Folding the rear seat backrest back
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
Left and right seat backrest
X
Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
Left and right seat backrest
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged and
locked, this will be shown in the multifunction display in the instrument cluster. A
warning tone also sounds.
X
Middle rear seat backrest
X
Pull release lever ; forwards.
Rear seat backrest : is released.
Stowage areas
To lock: fold the left and centre seat backrests forward. Make sure that the centre and
left seat backrests are engaged and joined
together.
X Slide catch : upwards.
The release mechanism of the centre seat
backrest is locked.
X To unlock: fold back the left and centre
seat backrests.
X Slide catch : downwards from inside the
boot.
373
Middle rear seat backrest
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
Red lock status indicator ; is no longer
visible.
X
Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 121).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
If you do not need the through-loading feature, you should always engage the rear seat
backrests. This will prevent unauthorised
access to the boot from the vehicle interior.
Locking the centre rear seat backrest
Securing a load
Lashing eyelets
General notes
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
RObserve
the loading guidelines
(Y page 368).
RSecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
RDistribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
RDo not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load. These are only intended as an antislip protection for light loads.
RDo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
RPad sharp edges for protection.
Boot
In order to prevent the boot from being
accessed by unauthorised persons, the
centre seat backrest can be locked using a
catch. The centre seat backrest can only be
folded forward together with the left seat
backrest.
Saloon with through-loading feature in the rear
bench seat
Z
Stowing and features
X
Stowage areas
374
X
Fold up the lashing eyelets next to the rear
seat backrest and put them through the
slots in the carpet.
Stowing and features
Bag hook
G WARNING
The bag hooks cannot restrain heavy objects
or items of luggage. Objects or items of luggage could be flung around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants when braking or abruptly
changing directions. There is a risk of injury.
Only hang light objects on the bag hooks.
Never hang hard, sharp-edged or fragile
objects on the bag hooks.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load of
3 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
: Bag hook
frame of the box or pushed onto the frame
from above. Otherwise, the box could be
damaged.
! Sharp-edged, pointed or fragile objects
can damage the EASY-PACK boot box and
then be thrown out. There is a risk of injury.
Do not transport sharp-edged, pointed or
fragile objects in the EASY-PACK boot box.
Always store and secure these or similar
objects in the boot outside of the EASYPACK boot box.
! If you exceed the maximum permitted
load of the EASY-PACK boot box, objects
can be thrown out of the EASY-PACK boot
box and strike vehicle occupants. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of
sudden braking or a sudden change in
direction.
Always observe the maximum permitted
load of the EASY-PACK boot box. Always
store and secure heavy objects in the boot
outside of the EASY-PACK boot box.
The maximum permitted load of the EASYPACK boot box is 10 kg. With a load of above
approximately 5 kg, the bottom of the box
moves downward until it rests on the mat of
the boot floor. Thus, overloading of the box is
avoided.
Adjusting the height to any position
EASY-PACK boot box
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the load surface moves up, your hands
may become trapped on the frame of the
EASY-PACK boot box. There is a risk of injury.
When the load surface moves up, make sure
that your hands are not within the sweep of
the load surface. If someone becomes trapped, carefully push the centre of the load surface downward.
! When the EASY-PACK convenience box is
pulled out, no objects may be placed on the
Example
Stowage areas
To remove: turn left-hand rotating catch
B clockwise and right-hand rotating catch
B anti-clockwise by 90°.
X Move box : downwards and pull it out
from anchorages ?.
X
Store the EASY-PACK boot box on a flat surface after removal, e.g. on a suitable shelf.
Stowage well under the boot floor
! Remove the handle again before closing
the boot lid and snap it in tightly to prevent
the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise,
you could damage the handle.
Removing and fitting
Example
X
To install: insert retainer ; of box : into
slots =
Raise box : and press hooks A into
anchorage ? as far as they will go.
X Turn left-hand rotating catch B anti-clockwise and right-hand rotating catch B
clockwise by 90°.
X
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
X
To open: pull handle : up.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
Z
Stowing and features
Pull the box out by handle : in the direction of the arrow all the way to the stop.
X To lower the load surface: push the
centre of load surface ; down by hand in
the direction of the arrow until load surface ; has reached the desired position
and the box is the desired size.
X To raise the load surface: press switch
=.
Load surface ; of the box moves up automatically.
X To stow the box: push the box in by handle : all the way to the stop.
X
375
376
Features
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
Stowing and features
G WARNING
sunroof, the sunroof will lower slightly but
remain raised in the rear.
Attaching the roof carrier
When a load is transported on the roof, the
vehicle's centre of gravity rises and the handling changes. If you exceed the maximum
roof load, the handling as well as steering and
braking characteristics are severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always observe the maximum roof load and
adapt your driving style.
The maximum roof load can be found in the
"Technical data" (Y page 476).
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that when the roof carrier is fitted
you can:
Rraise
the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof fully
Ropen the boot lid fully
! To avoid damaging or scratching the covers, do not use metallic or hard objects to
open them.
An incorrectly secured roof carrier or roof
load may become detached from the vehicle.
You must therefore ensure that you observe
the roof carrier manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Vehicles with panorama sliding sunroof: if
a roof carrier is fitted, the panorama sliding
sunroof cannot be opened. In order to allow
ventilation of the vehicle interior, you can
raise the panorama sliding sunroof.
If a roof carrier approved by Mercedes-Benz
makes contact with the panorama sliding
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The cup holder cannot secure a drinks container in place during a journey. If you use a
cup holder during a journey, the drinks container could be flung around and liquid could
be spilt. Vehicle occupants could come into
contact with the liquid and, in particular, be
scalded by hot liquid. You could be distracted
from the traffic situation and lose control of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident and
injury.
Only use the cup holder when the vehicle is
stationary. Only place containers of a suitable
size in the cup holder. Seal the container, in
particular when it contains hot liquid.
Features
377
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
RClose lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 368).
Cup holders in the front centre console
If you remove the cup holder insert, you can
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
To remove: slide upper cup holder sections : on the driver's and frontpassenger sides inwards until they release.
X Slide the cup holder forwards slightly and
then pull it upwards ;.
X
To fit: insert the cup holder at the front and
then slide it backwards until it reaches
edge = of the underside of the stowage
compartment. Insert the cup holder so that
the wedge of the upper section of the cup
holder faces forwards.
X Slide upper cup holder sections : on the
driver's and front-passenger sides outwards, until both left and right sides ;
engage.
X
You can remove the rubber mat of the cup
holder to clean it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
If you remove the cup holder insert, you can
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X To remove: slide catch = forwards and
pull out cup holder ;.
X
Z
Stowing and features
G WARNING
Features
378
To insert: insert cup holder ; and slide
back catch =.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
X
Sun visors
Overview
Stowing and features
You can remove the rubber mat of the cup
holder to clean it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight
on the rear seat armrest when it is folded
down, as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the
rear seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup
holder could be damaged.
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
Glare from the side
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
X To open: press the front of cup holder :
or ;.
Cup holder : or ; extends automatically.
X To fold out: place a container in the cup
holder.
The cup holder folds down automatically.
X To fold in: remove the container.
The cup holder folds in automatically.
X To close: slide cup holder : or ; back
until it engages.
X
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X
X
Roller sunblinds in the rear side windows
! Always guide the roller sunblind by hand.
Do not let it snap back suddenly as this
would damage the automatic roller mechanism.
! Do not drive the vehicle with the roller
sunblind hooked in and the side windows
opened simultaneously. The roller sunblind
can jump out of the retainers and spring
back suddenly when driving at high speeds,
e.g. when driving on the motorway. This
could damage the inertia reel. Therefore,
Features
X
To extend: pull the roller sunblind out by
tab : and hook it onto retainers ; at the
top of the window.
Rear window roller sunblind
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could be trapped in the
sweep of the roller sunblind when the roller
sunblind is extended or retracted. There is a
risk of injury.
When extending or retracting make sure that
no parts of the body are in the sweep of the
roller sunblind. Briefly press the button again
if someone becomes trapped. The opening/
closing process is stopped.
Extending/retracting the roller sunblind
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To extend or retract: briefly press button :.
The roller sunblind fully extends or fully
retracts.
X To stop: briefly press button : again.
The roller sunblind stops briefly and
retracts into the out-of-use position.
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
! Make sure that the roller sunblind can
move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind
or other objects could be damaged.
Z
Stowing and features
either close the side window or retract the
roller sunblind before driving at high
speeds.
379
Features
380
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Rear-compartment ashtray
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X To remove the insert: hold the sides of
insert =, push it forward and lift it up ;
and out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
Stowing and features
X
To open: pull cover ; out by its top edge.
To remove the insert: push ribbing =
from the left side and pull insert :
upwards.
X To fit the insert: fit insert : into the
holder from above and press down into the
holder until it engages.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X Push the cover of the ashtray upwards at its
right side =.
X To remove the insert: hold the sides of
insert ?, push it forward and lift it up ;
and out.
X To refit the insert: press insert ? into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: close the cover of the ashtray.
X Push cover : of the stowage compartment closed.
X
i You can remove the ashtray insert and
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Rthe
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
Features
381
12 V sockets
General notes
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
X
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as bulbs or chargers
for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
An emergency cut-off ensures that the onboard voltage does not drop too low. If the onboard voltage is too low, the power to the
sockets is automatically cut. This ensures
that there is sufficient power to start the
engine.
If you have connected a device to the 12 V
socket, leave the cover of the stowage compartment open. This prevents the cover from
being blocked.
Socket in the front centre console
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
X
Z
Stowing and features
X
Features
382
RUse only connector cables that are dry and
free of damage.
RWhen the ignition is off, make sure that the
230 V power socket is dry.
have the 230 V power socket
checked or replaced at a qualified specialised workshop if it is damaged or has been
pulled out of the trim.
RNever plug the connector cable into a 230 V
power socket that is damaged or has been
pulled out of the trim.
Stowing and features
RImmediately
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 369).
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: push cover : of the stowage
compartment closed.
X
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
G DANGER
If you reach into the power socket or plug
inappropriate devices into the power socket,
you could receive an electric shock. There is a
risk of fatal injury.
Only attach appropriate objects to the power
socket.
! Note that work and repairs on the 230 V
power socket should only be carried out by
qualified specialist personnel.
General notes
X
X
Pull cover ; out by its top edge.
Lift up the cover of socket :.
230 V socket
Important safety notes
G DANGER
When a suitable device is connected, the
230 V power socket will be carrying a high
voltage. You could receive an electric shock if
the connector cable or the 230 V power
socket is pulled out of the trim or is damaged
or wet. There is a risk of fatal injury.
The 230 V power socket provides an alternating voltage of 230 V so that small electronic devices can be connected. These devices, such as games consoles, chargers and
laptops, must not consume more than a maximum of 150 watts altogether.
Do not connect any multiple socket outlets to
the 230 V power socket.
Requirements for operating these devices:
Rthe
electronic device that you connect has
a suitable connector and conforms to
standards specific to the country you are in.
Rthe electronic device connector is plugged
into the 230 V power socket.
Rthe maximum wattage of the device to be
connected must not exceed 150 watts.
Rthe on-board voltage is within a permissible
voltage range.
Rthe 12 V socket in the front centre console
is working properly (Y page 381).
Features
383
Stowing and features
Using the 230 V power socket
To switch on: switch the ignition on.
Open flap =.
X Insert the electronic device connector into
230 V power socket :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
X To switch off: remove the connector from
230 V power socket :.
Make sure that you do not pull on the cable.
X
X
Z
384
Features
Problems with the 230 V power socket
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Stowing and features
The warning lamp on
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak.
the 230 V power socket X Start the engine.
is not lit.
or
X Charge the battery (Y page 416).
If the indicator lamp still does not light up:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The temperature of the DC/AC converter is temporarily too high.
X Remove the electronic device connector from the 230 V socket.
X Let the DC/AC converter cool down.
If the indicator lamp still does not light up after the converter cools
down:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
You have connected an electronic device that has a constant
nominal power of less than 150 watts, but has a very high switchon current. This device will not work. If you connect such a device,
the 230 V power socket will not supply it with power.
X Connect a suitable electronic device.
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Information on these requirements can be
found in the separate COMAND Online operating instructions.
To open: press cover : briefly.
X To make an emergency call: press SOS
button ; briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button ;
flashes until the emergency call is concluded.
X Wait for a voice connection to the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre.
X After the emergency call, close cover :.
You will see a message if:
X
Ra
connection to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre cannot be made
Ra call has not been automatically forwarded to the public emergency call centre
In this case, dial the 112 emergency number on your mobile phone.
You can find more information on the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system in the
separate COMAND Online operating instructions.
Mercedes-Benz Contact
General notes
Mercedes-Benz Contact offers fast assistance at the touch of a button – around the
clock. For any queries about the vehicle,
Mercedes-Benz Contact offers a fast and easy
connecting call to the Mercedes-Benz Customer Centre. You can, for example, request
an appointment or call for help in the event of
a breakdown.
The Audio 20/COMAND Online display indicates that a call is active. During the call you
change to the navigation menu by pressing
the NAVI button in Audio 20/COMAND
Online, for example.
Voice output is not available in this case.
You can find more information about
Mercedes-Benz Contact in the separate
Audio 20/COMAND Online operating instructions.
Breakdown assistance call button
X
To call breakdown assistance: press button : for breakdown assistance.
The breakdown assistance call is initiated.
The Connecting call
callmessage appears in
the multifunction display. The audio system
is muted.
Only in certain countries: a voice message
prompts you to confirm the data transmis-
sion. After confirmation, the required vehicle data is transmitted. During data transmission, you will see a corresponding symbol in the display. This may take a moment.
You are then connected to an employee.
X To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X Press the corresponding Audio 20/
COMAND Online button to end a call.
Info call button
This function is not available in all countries.
To call: press info call button :.
The breakdown assistance call is initiated.
The Connecting call
callmessage appears in
the multifunction display. The audio system
is muted.
Only in certain countries: a voice message
prompts you to confirm the data transmission. After confirmation, the required vehicle data is transmitted. During data transmission, you will see a corresponding symbol in the display. This may take a moment.
You are then connected to an employee.
X To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X Press the corresponding Audio 20/
COMAND Online button to end a call.
X
Z
385
Stowing and features
Features
386
Features
Mobile phone
Stowing and features
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating mobile communications
equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios
and mobile phones (RF transmitters)
(Y page 466).
Rthe
General notes
Depending on the vehicle equipment, there
are various mobile phone brackets that may
be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases, these
are country-specific.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones to
COMAND Online/Audio 20 can be obtained:
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Ron
Using a mobile phone
To connect a mobile phone to the exterior
aerial and charge it, insert it into the mobile
phone bracket.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 370).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed fitting; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
i The mobile phone can also be operated
without being in the bracket. However, the
charging function and aerial function are
not available.
In order to use Bluetooth® (SAP profile) on
your telephone module, you must first insert
the telephone module into the pre-installed
fitting. This connects it to the exterior aerial.
If you wish to charge the mobile phone, then
you must connect it to a USB port.
Further information on the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) can be found in
the Digital Owner's Manual.
Features
Operating the mobile phone
X
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 304).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone is disconnected from
the vehicle. You can then no longer make calls
using the hands-free system.
If a call is active and you remove the key from
the ignition lock, the conversation is transferred over to the mobile telephone. It is then
possible to continue the conversation on the
mobile phone.
X
Press studs : onto retainers ;.
To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
X
Slide the relevant seat back.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
Z
Stowing and features
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Floormats
X
387
388
389
Useful information ............................ 390
Engine compartment ........................ 390
ASSYST PLUS .................................... 395
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 396
390
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Maintenance and care
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open while driving
and block your view. There is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet while driving.
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Rremove jewellery and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
G WARNING
The ignition system and the fuel injection system operate with a high voltage. If you touch
the live components, you could receive an
electric shock. There is a danger of injury.
Never touch components of the ignition system or the fuel injection system when the
ignition is switched on.
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional
pedestrian protection provided by the
active bonnet will then be restored.
The active bonnet is only available in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury
to pedestrians in certain accident situations.
Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge
by approximately 85 mm. The active bonnet is
triggered by pyrotechnics.
Engine compartment
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Example
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
X
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on
both sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly in
the area around the hinges, it is not engaged
correctly. Repeat the step.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately
40 cm, the bonnet is opened and held open
automatically by the gas-filled strut.
Z
Maintenance and care
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active
bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection may be limited.
391
Engine compartment
392
Closing the bonnet
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
Maintenance and care
X
Radiator
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Do not cover up the radiator. Do not use thermal mats, insect protection covers or anything similar. Doing so can cause the Onboard
Diagnostics System to display inaccurate values. Some of these values are legally required
and must always be correct.
Engine oil
General notes
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly, wait approximately
30 minutes before carrying out the measurement.
Rthe
Example
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark =
or below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
Adding engine oil
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Engine compartment
393
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with
too much engine oil can result in damage to
the engine or to the catalytic converter.
Have excess engine oil siphoned off.
Example
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine
oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 392).
X
X
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 473).
Other service products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
The engine cooling system is under pressure,
particularly if the engine is warm. You could
be scalded by hot coolant spraying out when
opening the cap. There is a danger of injury.
Z
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
Engine compartment
394
Allow the engine to cool before opening the
cap. Wear gloves and protective eyewear
when opening. Slowly turn the cap half a turn
to allow pressure to escape.
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
Maintenance and care
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 475).
Topping up the windscreen washer system
G WARNING
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
or
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 181).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
70 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 181) in
the ignition lock.
or
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, pull the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 181).
X Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
X
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
ASSYST PLUS
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum of 1 litre, a message
appears in the multifunction display prompting you to top up the washer fluid
(Y page 349).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 476).
will receive a statement on the associated
costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date shown in
the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
ASSYST PLUS
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Service message
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 392).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
RService
A in .. days
A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after
the letter A or B indicates any necessary additional maintenance work. If you notify a qualified specialist workshop of this display, you
RService
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu and
press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the ASSYST PLUS submenu and press a to confirm.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service
interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval dis-
play has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Maintenance and care
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab
and open.
X Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
395
396
Care
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
Maintenance and care
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on
normal operation of the vehicle. Service work
will need to be performed more often if the
vehicle is operated under arduous conditions
or increased loads, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
ate stops
Rif the vehicle is primarily used for travelling
short distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
In these or similar operating conditions, have
the air filter, engine oil and oil filter, for example, changed more frequently. The tyres must
be checked more frequently if the vehicle is
operated under increased loads. Further
information can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
Rabrasive
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
Care
Do not open the driver's door when the
engine is switched off or at very low
speeds. Otherwise, when in transmission
position D or R the automatic transmission will automatically switch to park
position P and block the wheels.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Make sure:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0
Rthe 360° camera or reversing camera is
switched off.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
! If the key is within the rear detection
range of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for example, could lead to the boot lid
opening unintentionally:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 3 m away
from the vehicle.
Rusing
! Make sure that the automatic transmis-
sion is in neutral position N when washing
your vehicle in a tow-through car wash. The
vehicle may otherwise be damaged.
ROperating with the key:
Do not remove the key from the ignition
lock. Do not open the driver's door when
the engine is switched off or at very low
speeds. Otherwise, when in transmission
position D or R the automatic transmission will automatically switch to park
position P and block the wheels.
ROperating with the Start/Stop button:
Observe the following to make sure that the
automatic transmission stays in position N
neutral:
Operating with the key:
Make sure the ignition is switched on.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Select neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake, if necessary.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
Operating with the Start/Stop button:
Make sure the ignition is switched on.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Select park position P.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Remove Start/Stop button from ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X Switch on the ignition.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Select neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake, if necessary.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
Z
Maintenance and care
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
397
398
Care
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
Maintenance and care
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
! If the key is within the rear detection
range of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for example, could lead to the boot lid
opening unintentionally:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 3 m away
from the vehicle.
Rusing
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
Cleaning the paintwork
High-pressure cleaning equipment
! Do not affix:
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
Care
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
The vehicle should preferably be washed by
hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of water.
Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of approved Mercedes-Benz
care products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
Z
Maintenance and care
Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resins,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
X
399
Care
400
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
Maintenance and care
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
Cleaning the mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning AIRPANEL
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pres-
sure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
Vehicles with AIRPANEL have shutters in the
radiator trim. If the vehicle is very dusty, the
adjustment range of the shutters may be
restricted. The actuation mechanics of the
radiator trim must then be cleaned with a
high-pressure cleaner.
Care
401
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Shutters : open automatically after
approximately 120 seconds.
X Clean the location points of shutters ; in
the radiator trim with a high-pressure
cleaner.
X
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pres-
sure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open the cover of the reversing camera: with COMAND Online or Audio 20 activated, call up the vehicle menu: press the
Ñ button.
X To switch to the menu bar: slide ¬ the
controller.
X To select System settings:
settings turn and
press the controller.
X To select Rear view camera:
camera turn and
press the controller.
X To select Open camera cover:
cover turn and
press the controller.
The reversing camera cover opens.
X To clean the reversing camera: use clear
water and a soft cloth to clean camera
lens :.
X
Cleaning the 360° camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the 360° camera with a high-pressure cleaner.360
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Z
Maintenance and care
Cleaning the sensors
Care
402
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open the cover of the 360° camera:
with COMAND Online or Audio 20 activated, call up the vehicle menu: press the
Ñ button.
X To switch to the menu bar: slide ¬ the
controller.
X To select System settings:
settings turn and
press the controller.
X To select the 360° camera
camera: turn and press
the controller.
X To select Open camera cover:
cover turn and
press the controller.
The cover of the 360° camera opens.
X To clean the 360° camera: clean camera
lens : with clear water and a soft cloth.
Maintenance and care
X
If you drive at speeds above 30 km/h or with
the key in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock,
the cover of the 360° camera closes automatically.
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents such as sanitary
cleansers or wheel cleaners.
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing.
X
Clean the exhaust pipe with a care product
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Please note the care instructions in the
trailer coupling manufacturer's operating
instructions.
The ball coupling must be cleaned if it
becomes dirty or corroded.
Remove rust on the ball, e.g. with a wire
brush.
X Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or a
brush.
X After cleaning, lightly oil or grease the ball
coupling.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
i You can also have the maintenance work
on the ball coupling and the trailer tow hitch
carried out by a qualified specialist workshop.
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
Care
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
Note that regular care is essential to make
sure that the appearance and comfort of the
covers are retained over time.
Genuine leather seat covers
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
Z
Maintenance and care
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
403
Care
404
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Maintenance and care
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully, and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
RClean DINAMICA covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
405
Useful information ............................ 406
Where will I find...? ........................... 406
Flat tyre ............................................. 408
Battery (vehicle) ................................ 412
Jump-starting .................................... 418
Towing away and tow-starting ........ 420
Breakdown assistance
Electrical fuses ................................. 424
Where will I find...?
406
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Breakdown assistance
ist workshops: (Y page 27).
Where will I find...?
Warning triangle
Removing/replacing the warning triangle
To remove: open the boot lid.
Push warning triangle holder : on both
sides in the direction of the arrow and open
it.
X Remove warning triangle ;.
X To replace: place warning triangle ; back
into warning triangle holder :.
X Close warning triangle holder :.
X
X
X
X
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
press stud :.
First-aid kit
The first-aid kit : is in the boot in the lefthand stowage net.
X Open the boot lid.
X Remove first-aid kit :.
Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit at
least once a year :. Replace the contents if
necessary, and replace any missing items.
Where will I find...?
Fire extinguisher
Rratchet
407
ring spanner
pin
Rcentring
X
X
Pull tab : upwards.
Remove fire extinguisher ;.
Have fire extinguisher ; refilled after each
use and checked every one or two years. It
may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
The towing eye is located in the stowage well
under the boot floor.
In vehicles with MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics) and in hybrid vehicles, the towing eye is located in a bracket
under the parcel shelf.
Apart from some country-specific variants,
vehicles are not equipped with tyre-changing
tools. If the vehicle is equipped with tyrechanging tools, these are kept in the stowage
well under the boot floor. Some tools for
changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle.
For more information on which tyre changing
tools are required and approved to perform a
wheel change on your vehicle, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary tyre-changing tools can include,
for example:
Rjack
Rwheel
chock
Rwheel wrench
(Example)
: Tyre inflation compressor
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
= Towing eye
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 375).
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 409).
X
X
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit
(Example)
: Tyre inflation compressor
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
= Wheel wrench
? Folding wheel chock
A Jack
B Towing eye
The tyre-change tool kit is kept in a tray in the
stowage well under the boot floor.
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
Flat tyre
408
X
X
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 375).
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics) and hybrid
vehicles
: Towing eye
To remove the towing eye: open the boot
lid.
X Pull towing eye : to the left and remove it.
X To replace the towing eye: slide towing
eye : with the thread into the rear end of
the bracket.
X Push towing eye : on the eyelet towards
the right until it engages in the bracket.
X
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
acteristics) (Y page 408)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 407)
Ran emergency spare wheel (only for certain
countries) (Y page 461)
Vehicles with an Mercedes-Benz emergency
call system which are not equipped with a
TIREFIT kit: in the event of a flat tyre, contact
the Customer Assistance Centre for the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
(Y page 384).
Information on changing/fitting a wheel
(Y page 437).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 207).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or, in vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Open the driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock (Y page 181).
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle at a suitable distance (Y page 406). Observe legal requirements.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres. The affected
Flat tyre
sure that you use the proper size and type
(summer or winter tyre).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
sages (Y page 343)
the tyre for damage
Rif driving on, observe the following notes
The maximum driving distance is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially
laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Rspeed
Ryou
Robserve the instructions in the display mesRcheck
Rroad
condition
Routside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
When replacing one or all tyres, make sure
that you use only:
Rthe
tyre size specified for the vehicle and
Rtyre(s) marked "MOExtended"
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tyre, a standard tyre
may be used as a temporary measure. Make
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
Z
Breakdown assistance
tyre must not show any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the
tyre wall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an active tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitoring
system.
If the pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
409
410
Flat tyre
G WARNING
Using the TIREFIT kit
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
Rthere
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Comply with the manufacturer’s safety
instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage space
under the boot floor (Y page 407).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker within
the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Pull plug ? with the cable and hose A out
of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
Flat tyre
411
Tyre pressure not reached
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been attained after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of five minutes the tyre
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
X
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X
Insert plug ? into a 12 V socket
(Y page 381) in your vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 181).
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure may briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X Let the tyre inflation compressor run for
five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
X
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been attained after five minutes, see "Tyre
pressure reached" (Y page 411).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has not been attained after five minutes, see
"Tyre pressure not reached" (Y page 411).
If the tyre sealant leaks out, allow it to dry. It
can then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with
tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of the
TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the instrument cluster where it will be easily seen by
the driver.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
Z
Breakdown assistance
X
Battery (vehicle)
412
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been attained after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
X
Breakdown assistance
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the fuel filler
flap for values.
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button E next to pressure gauge F.
When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of
the sealed tyre.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as
soon as possible at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Battery (vehicle)
12 V battery - important safety notes
Hybrid vehicles are equipped with a 12 V battery and a high-voltage battery. The following
notes refer to the 12 V battery. Notes on the
high-voltage battery can be obtained in the
"High-voltage battery – important safety
notes" section (Y page 415).
Battery (vehicle)
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
may lead to a malfunction, e.g. a short circuit.
This, in turn, may restrict the functions of the
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) or ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may then be compromised. You could then lose control of the vehicle, e.g.:
Rwhen
braking
making sudden steering movements
and/or travelling at an inappropriate
speed.
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or similar situation, inform a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. You
should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rwhen
i For further information about ABS and
ESP®, see (Y page 74) and (Y page 80).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic charge is created, for example:
Rby
wearing synthetic fibre clothing
to friction between clothing and the
seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
Rdue
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected sepZ
Breakdown assistance
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
413
414
Battery (vehicle)
arately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Breakdown assistance
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
! Always have work on the batteries carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Should it, in exceptional circumstances, be
absolutely necessary to disconnect the 12volt battery yourself, please observe the
following:
Rsecure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away.
Rswitch off the engine and remove the
key. Make sure the ignition is switched
off. Check that all the indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
you may damage electronic components
such as the alternator, for example.
Rfirst, disconnect the negative terminal
clamp, followed by the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
The vehicle electronics may otherwise be
damaged.
Rthe transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The batteries and the covers of the positive
terminal clamps must always be fitted
securely during operation.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
WARNING
Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when handling the
battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing,
in particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes
off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event of
an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
The vehicle battery, like other batteries, can
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Battery (vehicle)
High-voltage battery - important
safety notes
Only hybrid vehicles are equipped with a highvoltage battery.
G DANGER
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage. If you modify components
in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
or touch damaged components, you may be
electrocuted. The components in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may be
damaged in an accident, although the damage
is not visible. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Do not touch any high-voltage components
after an accident and never modify the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system. Have the
vehicle towed away after an accident and the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
In the event of a vehicle fire, the internal pressure of the high-voltage battery could exceed
a critical value. In this case, flammable gas
escapes through a vent valve in the vehicle's
underbody. The gas can ignite. There is a risk
of injury.
Leave the danger area immediately. Secure
the danger area at a suitable distance, whilst
observing legal requirements.
G WARNING
If the housing of the high-voltage battery has
been damaged, electrolyte and gases may
leak out. These are poisonous and caustic.
There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Immediately rinse electrolyte splashes off
with water and seek medical attention
straight away.
! Only charge the high-voltage battery in
the "Charging when stationary" operating
mode. Do not connect a battery charger to
the high-voltage battery. Otherwise, the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
could be damaged.
! Exhaustive discharge caused by the vehicle standing idle for lengthy periods can
damage the high-voltage battery.
If the vehicle is idle for lengthy periods, run
it for a few minutes once every six weeks to
charge up the high-voltage battery.
During the charging process, switch off all
electrical consumers, e.g. the automatic
climate control or the seat heating.
If you wish to park your vehicle for several
weeks, ensure that the battery is at least 30%
charged. If necessary, charge the high-voltage battery while stationary before parking
the vehicle (Y page 416).
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre if
you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for a
long period of time.
Z
Breakdown assistance
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
When you park the vehicle, remove the key if
you do not require any electrical consumers.
The vehicle will then use very little energy,
thus conserving battery power.
Hybrid vehicles: if the battery charge is sufficient, the high-voltage battery can also supply the 12 V battery with energy. This only
happens if the battery charge of the 12 V battery requires this, e.g. after using electrical
consumers for an extended period with the
engine switched off. As the on-board voltage
is continuously monitored this can also be
performed when the engine is switched off.
The battery charge of the 12 V battery and the
on-board voltage are thereby kept stable for a
longer period.
415
416
Battery (vehicle)
Charging the 12 V battery
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
is available as an accessory. This device permits charging of the battery in position. Contact a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for
information and availability. Read the battery
charger's operating instructions before
charging the battery.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up
at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case
you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor
charge the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced.
The starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Hybrid vehicles: if the battery charge is sufficient, the high-voltage battery can also supply the 12 V battery with energy. This only
happens if the battery charge of the 12 V battery requires this, e.g. after using electrical
consumers for an extended period with the
engine switched off. As the on-board voltage
is continuously monitored this can also be
performed when the engine is switched off.
The battery charge of the 12 V battery and the
on-board voltage are thereby kept stable for a
longer period.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 418).
X Open the bonnet.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure (Y page 418).
Never charge the battery if it is still fitted to
the vehicle, unless you use a battery charger
which has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. A battery charger unit specially adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles
and tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
Charging the high-voltage battery
when stationary
Only hybrid vehicles are equipped with a highvoltage battery.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
! Only charge the high-voltage battery in
the "Charging when stationary" operating
mode. Do not connect a battery charger to
the high-voltage battery. Otherwise, the
Battery (vehicle)
417
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
could be damaged.
X
Stop the vehicle if the internal combustion
engine is running.
The internal combustion engine drives the
electric motor. The electric motor is operating as an alternator. The high-voltage battery is charging.
Breakdown assistance
If the high-voltage battery is too heavily discharged, recharge the high-voltage battery to
at least 60% of its capacity. In the "Charging
when stationary" operating mode, you can
observe the charge status of the high-voltage
battery up to a maximum of 70% in the
COMAND display and in the multifunction display (Y page 274).
Z
418
Jump-starting
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the
battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek
medical attention.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise,
the non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge
the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced. The starting
characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures. Have the thawed battery
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Jump-starting
419
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RVehicles with a petrol engine: only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust
system are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may only be performed using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
RThe
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts
while the jump leads are connected to the battery.
jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is
running, such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position P.
X Manual transmission: depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to neutral.
X Make sure the ignition is switched off (Y page 181). All indicator lamps in the instrument
cluster must be off. When using the key, turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock and
remove it (Y page 181).
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
RThe
Z
Breakdown assistance
RThe
Breakdown assistance
420
Towing away and tow-starting
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
X Slide cover A of positive terminal : in the direction of the arrow.
X Connect positive terminal : on your vehicle to positive terminal ; of donor battery B
using the jump lead. Always begin with positive terminal : on your own vehicle first.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal = of donor battery B to earth point ? of your vehicle using the
jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point ? and negative terminal =, then from positive clamp : and positive terminal ;. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle
first.
X Close cover A of positive clamp : after removing the jump leads.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Hybrid vehicles: if your vehicle has been jump-started, it may not be possible to use the
electric drive for approximately 30 minutes.
Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Towing away and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Safety relevant functions are restricted or no
longer available if:
Rthe
engine is not running
Rthe brake system or power steering is malfunctioning
Rthere is a malfunction in the voltage supply
or the vehicle's electrical system
When your vehicle is towed away or towed
started, you may require considerably more
effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such cases use a rigid towing bar. Before
being towed away or tow started, make sure
the steering moves freely.
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
G WARNING
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle
and its weight is greater than the permissible
gross weight of your vehicle, the:
Rtowing
eye may be torn off
Rcar/trailer combination may swerve or
even overturn
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Towing away and tow-starting
PLUS, DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To avoid
damage to the vehicle, deactivate these
systems in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing away
a car wash
! Make sure that the electric parking brake
is released. If the electric parking brake is
faulty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to
the towing eyes or, if available, to the trailer
tow hitch. You could otherwise damage the
vehicle.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
Rsecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
Rmake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope
in the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This makes other road
users aware that a vehicle is being
towed.
Ronly secure the tow rope to the towing
eye.
Robserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance so that the tow rope does not
sag.
Rdo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery
purposes as this could damage the vehicle.
If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power
is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! Shift the automatic transmission to N and
er's door during towing. The automatic
transmission may otherwise shift to position P, which could damage the transmission.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
Details on the permissible gross vehicle
weight of your vehicle can be found on the
vehicle identification plate (Y page 468).
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
If the vehicle has suffered transmission damage, have it transported on a transporter or
trailer.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
when towing a vehicle, the automatic transmission must be in position N. If the automatic transmission cannot be shifted to position N, have the vehicle transported on a
transporter or trailer.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot release the electric parking brake
Rcannot shift the transmission to position N
on vehicles with automatic transmission
Deactivate the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed (Y page 98). You
could otherwise be locked out when pushing
or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection (Y page 86)
before the vehicle is towed.
do not open the driver's or front passeng-
Z
Breakdown assistance
! When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
421
Towing away and tow-starting
422
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
Towing the vehicle away with the rear
axle raised
Hybrid vehicles: towing the vehicle with the
rear axle raised should only be carried out by
professional recovery companies.
Only vehicles without 4MATIC can be
towed with the rear axle raised.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
Breakdown assistance
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may either be towed
away with both axles on the ground or be loaded up and transported.
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
The brackets for the screw-in towing eyes are
located in the bumpers. They are at the rear
and at the front, under covers :.
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit/stowage tray (Y page 407).
X Press the mark on cover : inwards and
remove.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 137).
X Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X If necessary, turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 0 and remove the key from
the ignition lock.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the key with
you.
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch do not have a
bracket at the back for the screw-in towing
eye. Connect the towbar to the trailer tow
hitch (Y page 284).
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 420).
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Attach cover : to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit/
stowage tray.
X
X
X
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
Hybrid vehicles: hybrid vehicles may not be
towed away with both axles on the ground if:
Rthe
multifunction display is not working or
multifunction display shows the ~
Malfunction or
Rd Malfunction is displayed
If the vehicle is in a dangerous location it may
be towed from the danger zone with both
axles on the ground. In this case, the towing
distance may not be greater than 50 m and
Rthe
Towing away and tow-starting
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
X
Vehicles with manual or automatic transmission:
Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 137).
X
In order to signal a change of direction when
towing the vehicle with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual. In this case, only the turn
signals for the desired direction flash. When
you reset the combination switch, the hazard
warning lamps start flashing again.
Transporting the vehicle
Hybrid vehicles: transportation of the vehicle should only be carried out by professional
recovery companies.
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
The towing eyes or trailer tow hitch can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may either be towed
away with both axles on the ground or be loaded up and transported.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or
damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported on a transporter or trailer.
Z
Breakdown assistance
the towing speed must not exceed 10 km/h.
For longer distances, have the vehicle loaded
and transported or towed with the rear axle
raised.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
automatic transmission automatically shifts
to position P when you open the driver's or
front-passenger door or when you remove the
key from the ignition lock. In order to ensure
that the automatic transmission stays in position N when towing the vehicle, you must
observe the following points:
423
424
Electrical fuses
In the event of damage to the electrical
system: if the battery is defective, the automatic transmission will be locked in position
P. To shift the automatic transmission to position N, you must provide power to the vehicle's electrical system in the same way as
when jump-starting (Y page 418).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter
or trailer.
Breakdown assistance
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
i You can find information on "Jump-start-
ing" under (Y page 418).
Before tow-starting, the following conditions
must be fulfilled:
Rthe
battery is connected
engine has cooled down
Rthe exhaust system has cooled down
When tow-starting, it is important that you
observe the safety notes (Y page 420) and the
legal requirements in each respective country.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 137).
X Fit the towing eye (Y page 422).
X Secure the rigid towing bar or the towing
rope.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully, engage second gear and continue to keep the clutch
pedal fully depressed.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly; do not
depress the accelerator pedal while doing
so.
Rthe
When the engine has been started, immediately depress the clutch pedal fully and
shift to neutral.
X Pull over at a suitable place and stop the
vehicle safely, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Use the electric parking brake to secure the
vehicle and prevent it from rolling away.
X Remove the rigid towing bar or towing rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 422).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
X
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle disconnect faulty
circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on
the circuit and their functions will fail.
Electrical fuses
425
Before replacing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 207).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Make sure that the ignition is switched off
(Y page 181).
or
X When using the key, turn the key to position
0 in the ignition lock and remove it
(Y page 181).
X
Rfuse
box on the driver's side of the dashboard
Rfuse box in the front-passenger footwell
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
driver's side
Rfuse box under the boot floor on the righthand side of the vehicle, when viewed in the
direction of travel
The fuse allocation chart is on the fuse box in
the boot (Y page 426).
Open the driver's door.
To open: pull out cover : slightly at the
bottom in the direction of arrow =.
X Fold cover : outwards in the direction of
arrow ;.
X
X
X
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Dashboard fuse box
! Do not use a pointed object such as a
To close: fold in cover : until it engages.
X
Open the front-passenger door.
X
Open the front-passenger door.
To open: fold cover : out towards the rear
and remove it.
screwdriver to open the cover in the dashboard. You could damage the dashboard or
the cover.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
X
X
X
To close: clip in cover : at the rear.
Fold cover : forwards until it engages.
Z
Breakdown assistance
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Electrical fuses
426
Fuse box in the engine compartment
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
Breakdown assistance
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Open the bonnet.
To open: press safety clips : on the cover
together.
X Remove fuse box cover ; upwards.
To close: check whether the seal is positioned correctly in lid ?.
X Insert lid ? into the bracket at the rear of
the fuse box.
X Fold down lid ? of the fuse box and tighten
screws =.
X
Fuse box in the boot
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
X
X
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 375).
X To open: swing cover : upwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X
X
X
To close: fold down cover : in the opposite direction to the arrow.
Make sure that the cover is in the recess
provided for it.
i The fuse allocation chart is in a recess on
the side of the fuse box. You can find the
corresponding fuse rating and fuse type on
the fuse allocation chart.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X Loosen screws =, fold up fuse box lid ?
and remove it.
X
427
Useful information ............................ 428
Important safety notes ..................... 428
Operation ........................................... 428
Winter operation ............................... 430
Tyre pressure .................................... 432
Changing a wheel .............................. 437
Wheel and tyre combinations .......... 444
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel ................... 461
428
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being
used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rtype
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on the dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 444).
Information on air pressure for the tyres on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
the tyre pressure label on the fuel filler
flap (Y page 202)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 432)
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of wheel
spacers or brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating
permit for the vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressures when the vehicle is
heavily laden and, if necessary, adjust.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics,
e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that
the wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that a tyre is defective, reduce your
speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon
Operation
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 432).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 461).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rmileage
Rtyre
Important safety notes on the tyre
tread
G WARNING
Rpunctures
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rtears
Rsummer
Regularly check the wheels and tyres of your
vehicle for damage at least once a month, as
well as after driving off-road or on rough
roads. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of
tyre pressure. Pay particular attention to
damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
in the tyres
on the tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 429). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any
Rbulges
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Z
Wheels and tyres
as possible to check the wheels and tyres for
damage. Hidden tyre damage could also be
causing the unusual handling characteristics.
If you find no signs of damage, have the tyres
and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb or
other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over
kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try
to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the sidewalls,
may be damaged.
429
Wheels and tyres
430
Winter operation
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
sure monitor and on wheels specifically tested by Mercedes-Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 408).
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These
requirements can stipulate a specific tyre
type for your vehicle. Furthermore, the use of
certain tyre types in certain regions and areas
of operation can be highly beneficial. You can
find further information regarding tyres at
specialist tyre retailers, at qualified specialist
workshops or at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
ROnly fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 408).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 461).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or with an activated tyre pres-
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 438).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
Winter operation
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tyres will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter. These tyres have
been developed specifically for driving in
snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 221).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 432).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 437).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 435).
X
X
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 461).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If you have fitted snow chains to the front
wheels, they may scrape against the vehicle
body or chassis components. This could
cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres.
There is a risk of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
Rfit
fit snow chains on the front wheels
snow chains to the rear wheels in pairs.
! Vehicles with steel wheels: if you fit
snow chains on steel wheels, you may damage the hub caps. Remove the hub caps
from the relevant wheels before fitting the
snow chains.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 444).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the
snow chains as soon as possible when you
come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Ron vehicles with AIRMATIC, you must drive
at raised vehicle level if snow chains have
been fitted (Y page 234).
You may wish to deactivate ESP® (Y page 81)
when pulling away with snow chains fitted.
This way you can allow the wheels to spin in a
controlled manner, achieving an increased
driving force (cutting action).
Z
Wheels and tyres
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
431
432
Tyre pressure
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 461).
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
Wheels and tyres
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
Operation with an emergency spare
wheel (Y page 461).
Operation with a trailer: the applicable
value for the rear tyres is the maximum tyre
pressure value stated in the table inside the
fuel filler flap.
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary;
for more information, please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure information
label apply for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Tyre pressure
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed at which you are driving and the load on
the tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the
tyre pressure changes by approximately
10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres. Only correct the tyre pressure if it
is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
The tyre pressure values given for low loads
are minimum values which offer you good ride
comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
Rcause
For Saloons at speeds of up to 210 km/h
(does not apply to AMG vehicles, AMG
Sport models): despite what is stated on the
tyre pressure information label (fuel filler
flap), at speeds of up to 210 km/h the values
stated can be reduced as follows, without a
reduction in safety:
RSaloons
(except Eco models): Ò30 kPa
(Ò0.3 bar/Ò4 psi)
RSaloons (Eco models with 16 or 17 in
tyres on both axles): Ò60 kPa (Ò0.6 bar/
Ò9 psi)
This does not apply to vehicles towing a
trailer.
This improves the ride comfort of your vehicle; however, fuel consumption may increase
slightly.
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre
is shown in the Service menu of the multifunction display, see illustration (example).
Z
Wheels and tyres
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
433
434
Tyre pressure
For further information on displaying this
message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically" section (Y page 434).
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 432). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting to the cold tyre pressure
(Y page 435). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 432).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending
on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up,
a tyre pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tyre pressure on one or more tyres is significantly too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
In addition to the warning lamp, a message
appears in the multifunction display. Further
information can be found under (Y page 343).
If the tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning,
it may take more than ten minutes for the tyre
pressure warning lamp to inform you of the
malfunction by flashing for approximately one
minute and then remaining lit. When the fault
has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning
lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2
(Y page 181) in the ignition lock.
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the a button.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for over
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message appears.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically detects new wheels or
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display and
the yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp comes on.
RIf
the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in at least one tyre is
too low and must be corrected at the next
opportunity.
RIf the Check tyre(s) message appears in
the multifunction display, the tyre pressure
in one or more tyres has dropped significantly and the tyres must be checked.
RIf the Warning, tyre defect appears in
the multifunction display, the tyre pressure
in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly
and the tyres must be checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 343).
If the wheel positions on the vehicle are interchanged, the tyre pressures may be displayed
for the wrong positions for a short time. After
a few minutes of driving, this is rectified and
the tyre pressures are displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
you can also define reference values manually as described here. The tyre pressure
monitor then monitors the new tyre pressure
values.
X Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 432).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 181).
X Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the a button.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for the individual tyres or
the Tyre pressures will be dis‐
played after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressures as new
reference values message appears in
the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
Z
Wheels and tyres
new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of
the tyre pressure values to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tyre pressure
monitor active display message is shown
instead of the tyre pressure display. The tyre
pressures are already being monitored.
If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, for a
few minutes the system may continue to
show the tyre pressure of the wheel that has
been removed. If this occurs, note that the
value displayed for the position where the
spare wheel is fitted is not the same as the
current tyre pressure of the emergency spare
wheel.
435
Tyre pressure
436
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Wheels and tyres
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
2770-12-8001
Model: MW2433A
0381-13-8001
Model: GG4
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
ER0092100/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0099792/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer-NO: DA0047074/10
Jordan
Model: Gen Alpha Wal 2 TPMS
transmitter
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/114
Model: Gen Gamma Gen 4
433.92 Mhz.
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/190
Model: Corax 3 MRXMC34MA4
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2011/158
Type Number: LPD
Morocco
MR7319 ANRT 2012/
11/07/2012
MR7672 ANRT 2012/
23/11/2012
MR6706 ANRT 2011
Country
Radio type approval number
Moldova
1024
Philippines
No: ESD-1206394C
No: ESD-1306995C
Serbia
И 011 12
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
DA- 103365
South
Africa
TA-2012/719
TA-2012/1540
TA-2011/1370
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a
loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss
warning by the Run Flat Indicator
active Restart with OK message which
appears in the Service menu of the multifunction display. Information on the message
display can be found in the "Restarting the
tyre pressure loss warning system" section
(Y page 437).
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 432).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressures. An even loss of pressure on sev-
Changing a wheel
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer.
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
for the respective operating conditions.
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the table on the fuel filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect
tyre pressure is set, these incorrect values
will be monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 432).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 181).
Use ò on the steering wheel to call up
the list of menus.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the a button.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre pressure now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
If the Tyre pressure now OK? message
appears, use the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 408). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of
a flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown
assistance" (Y page 408).
Z
Wheels and tyres
eral tyres at the same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
437
438
Changing a wheel
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel:
in the event of a flat tyre, the emergency
spare wheel is fitted according to the description under "Fitting a wheel" (Y page 438).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Wheels and tyres
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of
differing dimensions can render the general
operating permit invalid.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 438).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure the direction of
rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system (Y page 437) or the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 435).
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Storing wheels
Store wheels in a cool, dry and preferably
dark place if they are not being used. Protect
the tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
X Make sure that in vehicles with AIRMATIC,
the vehicle level is set to "Normal"
(Y page 234).
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's
door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X
Changing a wheel
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/
Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 181).
X If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
X
439
Fold both plates upwards :.
Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
X
X
i Apart from some country-specific var-
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
Rjack
Rwheel
chock
wrench
Rcentring pin
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Rwheel
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 407).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
On slight downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
Z
Wheels and tyres
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tools are required to
perform a wheel change on your vehicle,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary wheel-changing tools may
include, for example:
440
Changing a wheel
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
Observe the following when raising the
vehicle:
Rto
Wheels and tyres
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suitable for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and positioning wheel chocks. Do not
release the parking brake while the vehicle
is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, flat load-bearing underlay must be
used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip
underlay must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the boot lid
when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Vehicles with steel wheels and wheel
trim: the wheel trim covers the wheel bolts.
Before you can unscrew the wheel bolts, you
must remove the hub cap.
Steel wheel with wheel trim
X
Using both hands, carefully reach into two
wheel trim openings and remove the wheel
trim.
Vehicles with light-alloy wheels and hub
caps: the wheel bolts are covered by a hub
cap. Before you can unscrew the wheel bolts,
you must remove the hub cap. Two different
variants can be fitted.
Light-alloy wheel with plastic hub cap
Vehicles with plastic hub cap:
To remove: turn the centre cover of hub
cap : anti-clockwise and remove.
X To fit: before fitting, ensure that hub cap :
is in the open position. To do so, turn the
centre cover anti-clockwise.
X
Changing a wheel
441
Put hub cap : in position and turn the
centre cover clockwise until you feel and
hear hub cap : engage.
X Make sure that hub cap : is fitted
securely.
X
X
Using wheel wrench =, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Light-alloy wheel with aluminium hub cap
To remove: take socket ; and wheel
wrench = from the vehicle tool kit
(Y page 407).
X Position socket ; on hub cap :.
X Attach wheel wrench = to socket ; and
loosen hub cap : anti-clockwise.
X Remove hub cap :.
X To fit: before fitting, check hub cap : and
the wheel area for soiling and clean if necessary.
X Put hub cap : in position and turn until it is
in the right position.
X Position socket ; on hub cap :.
X Attach wheel wrench = to socket ; and
tighten hub cap :.
The tightening torque must be 25 Nm.
X
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
Vehicles with AMG equipment: to protect
the vehicle body, the vehicle has covers fitted
next to the jacking points on the outer sills.
i Note that the hub cap should be tight-
ened to the specified torque of 25 Nm.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the hub cap fitted at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X
Vehicles with AMG equipment: fold
cover ? upwards.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Vehicles with aluminium hub cap:
Changing a wheel
442
Wheels and tyres
X
Position jack B at jacking point A.
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread
instead of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X Remove the wheel.
X
Fitting a new wheel
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Turn crank C clockwise until jack B sits
completely on jacking point A and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank C until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm off the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
When fitting/removing wheels, and for as
long as the wheels are removed, avoid applying any external force on the brake discs. This
could impair the level of comfort when braking.
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Observe the instructions and safety notes on
"Changing a wheel" (Y page 438).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
Changing a wheel
443
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the tyrechange tool kit in the boot again.
X Vehicles with AMG equipment: insert the
cover into the outer sill.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 432).
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the
centring pin and push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel (Y page 462).
Only then lower the vehicle.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
! Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel using the tyre inflation
compressor before lowering the vehicle.
The rim could otherwise be damaged.
If you are driving with the collapsible emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre pressure
loss warning system or the tyre pressure
monitor cannot function reliably. Only restart
the tyre pressure loss warning system/tyre
pressure monitor when the defective wheel
has been replaced with a new wheel.
Vehicles with a tyre pressure control system: all fitted wheels must be equipped with
functioning sensors.
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning
system cannot function reliably. Only restart
the tyre pressure loss warning system when
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Z
Wheels and tyres
X
444
Wheel and tyre combinations
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
Wheels and tyres
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not fit
used tyres if you have no information about
their previous usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
You will find a table with recommended tyre
pressures for various operating conditions on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. For
further information on tyre pressure, see
(Y page 432). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
RFA:
Rwith
tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics" section
(Y page 408).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
fitted at the factory in all countries.
Wheel and tyre combinations
445
Tyres
C 180
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Wheels and tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
1
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
446
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V M+S i1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL
Wheels
M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
1 Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
447
C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
R 17
Tyres
BA: 225/50 R17 94
Wheels
W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 16
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
C 180 BlueTEC
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
1
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
448
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V M+S i1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
1 Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
449
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
C 200
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
3
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
450
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
C 200 BlueTEC
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
1 Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
451
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V M+S i1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36.5
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
1 Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
452
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Wheels and tyres
C 220 BlueTEC BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R16 92 V1
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 36
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
1 Not in conjunction with Avantgarde exterior package (code P15), Exclusive exterior package (code P23), AMG
Line Exterior package (code P31), dynamic handling package (code 483/489), suspension for greater ground
clearance (code 482) and sports suspension (code 486).
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
453
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
C 220 BlueTEC
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Wheels and tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
3
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
454
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
C 220 CDI
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 V2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
455
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3
4
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
456
C 250
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 W2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
457
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Wheels and tyres
R 18
C 250 BlueTEC
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 W2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
458
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
2 Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
459
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H
Wheels
M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
R 18
3
4
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
460
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 W2
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 V3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
FA: 225/50 R17 94 W3
RA: 245/45 R17 95 W3
FA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
RA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 54
BA: 225/50 R17 94
Wheels and tyres
Wheels
W3
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 56
FA: 225/45 R18 95 Y XL3
RA: 245/40 R18 97 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 49
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 245/35 R19 93 Y XL3
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 56.5
FA: 225/40 R19 93 Y XL3
RA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL3, 4
FA: 7.5 J x 19 H2 ET 44
RA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 Additional measures necessary (additional wheel-arch extension on rear wheel arch).
2
Emergency spare wheel
461
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/60 R16 92 H M+Si2
BA: 6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 38
BA: 225/55 R16 95 H M+Si3, 2
BA: 7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 48
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/50 R17 94 H M+Si3
BA: 7.0 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R18 95 H XL M+Si3
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
General notes
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 432).
The value on the wheel is valid. In addition, the
emergency spare wheel tyre pressure can be
found under "Technical data" (Y page 464).
Not in conjunction with AMG Line exterior package (code P31), suspension for greater ground clearance (code
482) and sports suspension (code 486).
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
2
Z
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Wheels and tyres
462
Emergency spare wheel
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
If you are driving with the collapsible emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre pressure
loss warning system or the tyre pressure
monitor cannot function reliably. Only restart
the tyre pressure loss warning system/tyre
pressure monitor when the defective wheel
has been replaced with a new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: after
mounting an emergency spare wheel, the system may still display the tyre pressure of the
removed wheel for a few minutes. The value
displayed for the mounted emergency spare
wheel is not the same as the current tyre
pressure of the emergency spare wheel.
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning
system cannot function reliably. Only restart
the tyre pressure loss warning system when
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Removing the emergency spare wheel
The emergency spare wheel is secured in the
emergency spare wheel bag in the boot.
X Open the boot.
X Detach the fastening straps.
X Unhook retaining spring hooks of fastening
straps from the retainers.
X Remove the emergency spare wheel bag
with the emergency spare wheel.
X Open the bag and remove the emergency
spare wheel.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 438).
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
! Inflate the collapsible emergency spare
wheel using the tyre inflation compressor
before lowering the vehicle. The wheel rim
could otherwise be damaged.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Mount the collapsible emergency spare
wheel as described (Y page 437).
The collapsible emergency spare wheel
must be mounted before it is inflated.
X Pull connector ? and the air hose out of
the housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : of the air hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre
inflation compressor is set to 0.
X Insert plug ? into the cigarette lighter
socket or into a 12 V socket in your vehicle.
X Press the Start/Stop button once.
or
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock.
X
Emergency spare wheel
Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is
shown on pressure gauge =.
X Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on
the yellow label of the emergency spare
wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the
electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press pressure release valve
button ; until the correct tyre pressure
has been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the air hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
X Stow plug ? and the air hose in the lower
section of the blower housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the
vehicle.
463
Wheels and tyres
X
Z
Emergency spare wheel
464
Technical data
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel5
Light-alloy wheels
T 135/80 R17 103 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 17 H2 ET 19.5
Wheels and tyres
Tyres
5
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
465
Useful information ............................ 466
Information on technical data ......... 466
Vehicle electronics ........................... 466
Identification plates ......................... 468
Service products and capacities ..... 468
Vehicle data ....................................... 476
Technical data
Trailer tow hitch ................................ 477
466
Vehicle electronics
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 27).
Information on technical data
You can find current technical data on the
Internet on our Mercedes‑Benz homepage.
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors, actuating components and connector leads, at a qualified
specialist workshop. Vehicle components
may otherwise wear more quickly and the
vehicle's operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you use the RF transmitter in the vehicle in
an improper way, its electromagnetic radiation can disrupt vehicle electronics, e.g. if:
Rthe
RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial is fitted incorrectly or is
not a low-reflection aerial
This can jeopardise the operating safety of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating in the vehicle, always connect the RF
transmitter to the low-reflection exterior aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
the maximum permissible output in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Robserve
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discus-
Vehicle electronics
Approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing
? Boot lid
i On vehicles with panorama sliding sun-
roof, fitting an aerial to the front or rear roof
area is not permitted.
On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the
vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters. Comply with the legal
requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 78 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
GSM/UMTS/LTE
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
Rmobile phones (GSM/DCS/PCS/UMTS/
LTE)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
Rtrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
RGSM/UMTS/LTE
R70
Z
Technical data
sion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
467
Service products and capacities
468
from the data shown here. You can find the
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
VIN
Technical data
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering ; upwards.
The VIN is visible :.
X
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 468).
Only for certain countries: the VIN can also be
found at the lower edge of the windscreen.
Example: vehicles with a trailer tow hitch
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
Engine number
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
countries)
? VIN
A Maximum permissible gross vehicle
Service products and capacities
B
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
C
D
E
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible gross weight of
vehicle/trailer combination (kg) (only for
specific countries)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is example data. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate
Important safety notes
Service products and capacities
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
Rexhaust
gas aftertreatment additives, e.g.
AdBlue®
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake fluid
Rwindscreen washer fluid
Rclimate control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. Only use products recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Damage which is caused
by the use of products which have not been
recommended is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz warranty or goodwill gestures. They are listed in this Mercedes-Benz
Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Other identifications, for example:
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
R0
W-30
W-30
R5 W-40
Further information can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
R5
Z
Technical data
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
469
470
Service products and capacities
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Technical data
Model
Total capacity
C 180 (only for certain
countries)
C 200 (only for certain
countries)
C 250 (only for certain
countries)
C 220 BlueTEC BlueEFFICIENCY Edition (only
for certain countries)
66.0 l
C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY
Edition
41.0 l
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
50.0 l
All other models
41.0 l
or
66.0 l
Fuel of this specification can contain up to
10 % ethanol.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or
E DIN 51626–1 can lead to increased wear
and damage the engine and exhaust system.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operat-
ing the vehicle with other fuels can lead to
engine failure.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
(100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
Rpetrol with additives containing metal
RDiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle. Do not use additives. Otherwise, engine damage may
occur. This does not include cleaning additives for the removal and prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must only be mixed
with additives recommended by MercedesBenz; see "Additives". You can obtain further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
RE100
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
All models
Approx. 7.0 l
Petrol
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel
system. Even small amounts of the wrong
fuel can result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Only refuel using premium-grade unlea-
ded petrol with at least 95 ROZ/85 MOZ,
that conforms to European standard
EN 228 or E DIN 51626–1 or an equivalent
specification.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
C 180, C 250: as a temporary measure, if the
recommended fuel is not available, you may
also use regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 93 RON/83 MON.
All other models: as a temporary measure, if
the recommended fuel is not available, you
may also use regular unleaded petrol with an
Service products and capacities
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 201).
C 200, C 250
! Only refuel using unleaded, sulphur-free
unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Additives
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do
not mix fuel additives with fuel. This does
not include additives for the removal and
prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must
only be mixed with additives recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for use in the product description.
More information about recommended
additives can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
fuel brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up in the injection system as a result. In
this case, in consultation with a MercedesBenz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Always observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Diesel
Fuel grade
G WARNING
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does
not conform to EN 590 can lead to
increased wear as well as damage to the
engine and exhaust system.
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and
do not use any special additives. Otherwise, engine damage may occur.
Rheating
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuel with
a high sulphur content is available, you will
need to carry out your vehicle's oil change
Z
Technical data
octane rating of 91 RON/82 MON. This may
reduce engine performance and increase fuel
consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle and
sudden acceleration. Never refuel using fuel
with a lower RON/MON.
471
472
Service products and capacities
at shorter intervals. More information
about the interval for oil change can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
Technical data
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 201).
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low
outside temperatures, it is possible that the
flow characteristics of the diesel fuel could be
insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from
warmer areas may not be suitable for operation in colder climatic conditions.
i Further information on country-specific
fuel properties and fuel types with low-temperature resistance can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or
traffic flow
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the
following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
Rwhen towing a trailer
Rin
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures were, in each
case, based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the Euro 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
AdBlue®
Important safety notes
AdBlue® is a water-soluble fluid for the
exhaust gas aftertreatment of diesel engines.
It is:
Rnon-toxic
Rcolourless
and odourless
Rnon-flammable
If you open the AdBlue® tank, small amounts
of ammonia vapour may be released.
Ammonia vapours have a pungent odour and
are particularly irritating to the skin, to
mucous membranes and to the eyes. You may
experience a burning sensation in your eyes,
nose and throat. You may also experience
coughing and watery eyes.
Service products and capacities
Capacities
The total capacity of the AdBlue® tank may
vary, depending on the vehicle equipment.
Low outside temperatures
Model
AdBlue®
All models
freezes at a temperature of approximately -11 †. The vehicle is delivered from
the factory equipped with an AdBlue® preheating system. Winter operation can thus be
guaranteed even at temperatures below
-11 †.
Total capacity
8.5 l
or
24.5 l
Engine oil
Additives
General notes
! Only use AdBlue® in accordance with ISO
When handling engine oil, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 468).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz approval is indicated on the oil container by the inscription "MB
Approval" and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
22241. Do not use additives with AdBlue®
and do not dilute AdBlue® with water. This
may destroy the BlueTEC exhaust gas aftertreatment system.
Purity
! Impurities in AdBlue® (e.g. due to other
service products, cleaning agents or dust)
lead to:
Rincreased
emission values
to the catalytic converter
Rengine damage
Rmalfunctions in the BlueTEC® exhaust
gas aftertreatment system
Rdamage
Assuring the purity of AdBlue® is particularly
important with respect to avoiding malfunctions in the BlueTEC exhaust gas aftertreatment system.
If AdBlue® is pumped out of the AdBlue® tank,
e.g. during repair work, do not use this fluid to
refill the tank. The purity of the fluid can no
longer be guaranteed.
Z
Technical data
Do not inhale any ammonia vapours that may
be released. Only fill the AdBlue® tank in wellventilated areas.
473
474
Service products and capacities
Petrol engines: in certain countries, different engine oils can be used, provided that the
maintenance intervals are reduced. For more
information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Petrol engines
All models
Technical data
Diesel engines with a
diesel particle filter
MB Approval
229.5
MB Approval
C 180 BlueTEC
C 200 BlueTEC
226.51,
229.31,
229.51, 229.52
All other models
228.51,
229.31,
229.51, 229.52
Diesel engines without
a diesel particle filter
MB Approval
All models
228.3, 228.5,
228.51, 229.3,
229.31, 229.5,
229.51
Petrol engines
All models
Replacement
amount
7.0 l
Diesel engines
Replacement
amount
C 180 BlueTEC
C 200 BlueTEC
6.5 l
All other models
6.0 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
Rvehicles
with a petrol engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
Rvehicles with a diesel engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3, 229.5 or ACEA
C3
This must only be added once and the
amount must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
Service products and capacities
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
When handling brake fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 468).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
a qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible
for the following:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rantifreeze
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance with
MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1
.
The coolant is checked at every maintenance
interval at a qualified specialist workshop.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
Z
Technical data
Brake fluid
475
Vehicle data
476
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every maintenance interval at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Windscreen and headlamp cleaning
system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
Technical data
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
For the correct mixing ratio refer to the
information on the antifreeze reservoir.
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Rthe
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 468)
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle
Dimensions and weights
Trailer tow hitch
Model
:
Opening height
C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
1763 mm
C 250 BlueTEC
4MATIC
1774 mm
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
1768 mm
All other models
1763 mm
477
The retrofitting of a trailer tow hitch is only
permissible if a towing weight is specified in
your vehicle documents. If this is not the case,
then the vehicle is not approved for the towing of a trailer.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
Vehicle length
4686 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2020 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1810 mm
Wheelbase
2840 mm
Maximum roof load
75 kg
Maximum boot load
100 kg
Model
Vehicle
height
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
1452 mm
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
1447 mm
All other models
1442 mm
: Anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
For trailer tow hitches fitted at the factory, the
overhang dimension including the protective
covering is 1,158 mm.
Trailer tow hitch
Mounting dimensions
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle
type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis.
Z
Technical data
All models
478
Trailer tow hitch
Trailer loads
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 8%
from a standstill).
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 180
1400 kg
1800 kg
C 200
1600 kg
1800 kg
C 220 BlueTEC
1800 kg
1800 kg
Technical data
Automatic transmission
C 180 BlueTEC
1800 kg
C 250
1800 kg
C 220 CDI
1800 kg
C 250 BlueTEC
1800 kg
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
1800 kg
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
1800 kg
Manual transmission
C 200 BlueTEC
1600 kg
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12%
from a standstill).
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 180
1400 kg
1800 kg
C 200
1600 kg
1800 kg
C 220 BlueTEC
1800 kg
1800 kg
Automatic transmission
C 180 BlueTEC
1800 kg
C 250
1800 kg
C 220 CDI
1800 kg
Trailer tow hitch
479
Automatic transmission
C 250 BlueTEC
1800 kg
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
1800 kg
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
1800 kg
Manual transmission
C 200 BlueTEC
1600 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 180
700 kg
715 kg
C 200
725 kg
735 kg
C 220 BlueTEC
750 kg
750 kg
C 180 BlueTEC
750 kg
C 250
735 kg
C 220 CDI
750 kg
C 250 BlueTEC
750 kg
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
750 kg
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
750 kg
Technical data
Automatic transmission
Manual transmission
C 200 BlueTEC
740 kg
Maximum drawbar noseweight
! Use a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum permissible noseweight.
Do not use a noseweight of less than 50kg, otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Note that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual payload.
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
The drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load.
Z
480
Trailer tow hitch
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 180
75 kg
75 kg
C 200
75 kg
75 kg
C 220 BlueTEC
75 kg
75 kg
Automatic transmission
C 180 BlueTEC
75 kg
C 250
75 kg
C 220 CDI
75 kg
C 250 BlueTEC
75 kg
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
75 kg
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
75 kg
Manual transmission
Technical data
C 200 BlueTEC
75 kg
However, the actual noseweight must not exceed the value given on the trailer tow hitch
identification plate. In addition, a distinction should be made between towing a trailer and
using a carrier system on the ball coupling of the trailer tow hitch.
Note also that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual noseweight.
You can attach carrier systems, e.g. bicycle racks or load-bearing implements, on the ball
coupling. The maximum noseweight of 75 kg applies when using carrier systems on the ball
coupling.
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 284).
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 180
1170 kg
1170 kg
C 200
1190 kg
1185 kg
C 220 BlueTEC
1215 kg
1210 kg
Automatic transmission
C 180 BlueTEC
1190 kg
C 250
1180 kg
Trailer tow hitch
481
Automatic transmission
C 220 CDI
1145 kg
C 250 BlueTEC
1205 kg
C 250 BlueTEC 4MATIC
1220 kg
C 300 BlueTEC Hybrid
1290 kg
Manual transmission
1170 kg
Technical data
C 200 BlueTEC
Z
482
483
484